Home
Cadillac XLR-V Automobile User Manual
Contents
1. oo 15 Hold the top in the front and side and lift the 16 Hold the top in the front and the rear and lift top out of the stored position the top until it is almost closed Be careful not to pinch your fingers between the rear of the top and the rear window 131 17 Place your hands on the top and guide the 18 While sitting in the drivers seat pull down on top into the closed position the rear of the top 132 20 19 While holding the rear of the top down insert the wrench into the bolt in the plug opening in the headliner Turn the wrench counterclockwise until it stops to fully open the latch jaws around the pins Pull down on the roof with the latch turned open Turn the wrench clockwise until it stops to lock the top into position Push up on the roof If it moves away from the windshield header it is not latched and you will need to repeat the previous steps 21 22 23 From outside the vehicle push down on both rear corners of the top to make sure it is completely locked into place From inside the vehicle reach behind the headrest and gently pull the wings out a small amount Then fold the front tonneau to the closed position Manually close the trunk 133 4 NOTES 134 Section 3 Instrument Panel Instrument Panel Overview 2 05 138 Exterior Lighting Battery Saver 169 Hazard
2. 068 166 Speedometer and Odameter eas 187 Headlamps on Reminder 166 ae Odometer aS 187 Daytime Running Lamps DRL 166 LY Aeka aidan E vane ye Adaptive Forward Lighting System 167 Safety Belt Reminder Light 187 FOG LAMPS sanana a 168 Airbaa Readi Licht 188 Twilight Sentinel ooo 168 MOA PSI IJAN srs ssisi iistri 135 Section 3 Instrument Panel Passenger Airbag Status Indicator 189 Driver Information Center DIC 203 Charging System Light eeeee 191 DIC Controls and Displays 06cee 204 Voltmeter Gage cceececeeeseteeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeas 192 DIC Warnings and Messages 00 206 Brake System Warning Light 0 192 Other Messages seieren 219 Anti Lock Brake System Warning Light 193 DIC Vehicle Personalization 0 000 220 Traction Control System TCS Trip Computer o n 224 2 a cee saan e Le Oil Life Indicator sescqcdscszencedsseseecanncasecaioceeess 224 Sears a AAR aa Audio System s 225 Tire Pressure Light orisni insasi 196 Theft Det t Featur 226 Malfunction Indicator Lamp seeen 196 A a St ee Wik ef ain Tenet eeseneseessess 227 Engine Oil Pressure Gage oec 200 Joo o Seung PESOS anis S e Radio ROCOptiOi asisrssiriierisnriciinsne 228 gc rity LIJI oeccanancnicsrorciimsnisms 201 F f Care of Your CDS urrenin iain 229 Og Lamp Light cc ceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeneeeeeees 201 Li Care of t
3. 26 345 500 Brake Anti Lock Brake System ABS 05 327 EM IQ NCIOS seieren 329 Paknio 97 System Warning Light eee 192 Brak S socecrars sirena 399 ae E E E E E 326 Braking in Emergencies s eeeeneeeeees 329 Break In New Vehicle ccccceeeeeeeeeeeeeees 87 Bulb Replacement eeccseeeeeeeeeeeeees 412 Headlamp Aiming cceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 408 Buying New Tires speccen osa 428 C California Fuel ccceceeeeeeeeeeetteeeeeeeeeeeees 367 California Proposition 65 Warning 364 Canadian OWNnelrs cccceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 3 Capacities and Specifications 0 00 458 Carbon Monoxide 77 102 349 359 Care of Safety Belts swiss eevee tiicenviess 445 Your CD Player n 230 Your CDS orreri raii eed 229 CD Six Disc Changer pessas decas unian 302 CD DVD Player ssaicesscsaussezetcieieicataassendeimess 305 Center Console Storage Area aeee 122 Chains TIE scisaksieninaass cacsmaassacenamtvarcanncessannes 435 Charging System Light aeaee 191 Check Engine Light siseses 196 Checking Things Under the Hood 372 Chemical Paint Spotting ceee 450 Child Restraints Child Restraint Systems eeeeeeeeeeeeee 35 Infants and Young Children 200 31 Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children 39 Older Children ceccecceeeeee
4. cccceececeeeteeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 391 Courtesy Lamps nsira 170 Cruise Control jesscteve ccccsusedeanedsxeeastausebacenseestes 147 Cruise Control Adaptive cccceeeeeeeeeees 150 Cupholder S ivsiscrisiiieses a Gveeetiniescs nein tee 122 Customer Assistance Information Courtesy Transportation o 488 Customer Assistance for Text Telephone TTY USES oiir ion eaa eee 485 Customer Assistance Offices 2 485 Customer Assistance Information cont Customer Satisfaction Procedure 482 GM Mobility Reimbursement Program 486 Reporting Safety Defects to General Motors cc ceeeceeeeeeeeeeeeaeeees 497 Reporting Safety Defects to the Canadian Government 0 ccceeeeees 496 Reporting Safety Defects to the United States Government 05 496 Roadside Service cceceeeeeeeeeeeeees 487 Service Publications Ordering Information saosin oa 497 D Database Coverage Explanations 284 Daytime Running Lamps ecceeceeee 166 Defensive Driving sesssessssressrrrrssrrrreserrrenes 322 Diversity Antenna System eeeeeeeeeeees 230 Doing Your Own Service Work 4 364 Door Automatic Door Lock cceeeeeeeeeeeeeee 76 LOCKS ae e a Ea aan 73 Power Door LOCKS ccceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 75 Programmable Automatic Door Unlock 76 502 Driver Position Safety Belt ccccceeeeeeeeeee
5. 68 Doors and LOCKS oiana iainko 73 Door Locks sani eiipenishividiniiaviiecsebieeandiniesies 73 Power Door LOCKS 0 eceeeeeeeeeeeeeaeeees 75 Automatic Door LOCK 0 ceeeeeeeeeeeee ees 76 Programmable Automatic Door Unlock 76 Lockout Protection ccceceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 77 TENK aaaea a S 77 WINGOWS assesta enda t aana 81 Power WINdOWS c0eceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaeeees 82 SUN VISOMS secerni uinen AUANT 84 Theft Deterrent Systems ceee 84 Theft Deterrent System ceeeeeeeeeee 84 Valet Lockout Switch cccceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 86 Starting and Operating Your Vehicle 87 New Vehicle Break In cceeeeeeeeeeeeeee 87 Ignition POSitiONS 0 0 0 eeeeeeeeeeeeneeeeeeenaeees 88 Retained Accessory Power RAP 89 Starting the Engine cceceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 89 Automatic Transmission Operation 92 Parking Brake esien na 97 Shifting Into Park P 00 ceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees Shifting Out of Park P Parking Over Things That Burn Engine Exhaust Running the Engine While Parked MPMONS eacad ons diriana Erda Rieda Automatic Dimming Rearview Mirror with OnStar seiri oar E aie ie Outside Power Heated Mirrors 0 Outside Automatic Dimming Mirror Outside Curb View Assist Mirror Outside Convex Mirror ccccceeeeeeeeeeeaee O
6. Doing Your Own Service Work A CAUTION You can be injured and your vehicle could be damaged if you try to do service work on a vehicle without knowing enough about it e Be sure you have sufficient knowledge experience the proper replacement parts and tools before you attempt any vehicle maintenance task Be sure to use the proper nuts bolts and other fasteners English and metric fasteners can be easily confused If you use the wrong fasteners parts can later break or fall off You could be hurt If you want to do some of your own service work you will want to use the proper service manual It tells you much more about how to service your vehicle than this manual can To order the proper service manual see Service Publications Ordering Information on page 497 Your vehicle has an airbag system Before attempting to do your own service work see Servicing Your Airbag Equipped Vehicle on page 58 You should keep a record with all parts receipts and list the mileage and the date of any service work you perform See Maintenance Record on page 477 Adding Equipment to the Outside of Your Vehicle Things you might add to the outside of your vehicle can affect the airflow around it This may cause wind noise and affect windshield washer performance Check with your dealer before adding equipment to the outside of your vehicle Fuel Use of the recommended fuel is an important part of the proper maintenance of yo
7. X Brightness Press this button to change the brightness of the instrument panel lights Press the DIMMER button until PANEL DIMMING appears on the Driver Information Center DIC Then use the brightness button to adjust the instrument panel brightness Press the top of the button to brighten the lights or the bottom of the button to dim the lights See Head Up Display HUD on page 171 for more information Be sure not to have the brightness turned all the way down with the lamps on during the day Your DIC may not be visible 170 Courtesy Lamps When any door or the trunk lid is opened the interior lamps will go on unless it is bright outside Press the interior lamp button on the right side of the instrument panel to turn the courtesy lamps on or off Entry Exit Lighting With entry lighting the interior lamps will come on when entering the vehicle The interior lamps will come on for about 20 seconds when the engine is turned off You can turn exit and entry lighting off by quickly turning the courtesy lamps on and off Reading Lamps Your inside rearview mirror includes two reading lamps The lamps will go on when a door is opened When the doors are closed each lamp can be turned on individually by pressing the button for that lamp Battery Run Down Protection Your vehicle has a feature to help prevent the battery from being drained in case the underhood lamp vanity mirror lamps cargo lamps r
8. 159 Passing a Vehicle If you need to increase speed to pass a vehicle use the accelerator pedal While your foot is on the accelerator pedal the system will not automatically apply the brakes Once you pass the vehicle and remove your foot from the accelerator pedal Adaptive Cruise Control will return to normal operation and be able to apply the brakes if needed A CAUTION If you rest your foot on the accelerator pedal the system will not automatically apply the brakes You could crash into a vehicle ahead of you Do not rest your foot on the accelerator pedal when using Adaptive Cruise Control 160 Curves in the Road A CAUTION Due to Adaptive Cruise Control limitations in curves it may respond to a vehicle in another lane or may not have time to react to a vehicle in your lane You could crash into a vehicle ahead of you or lose control of your vehicle Give extra attention in curves and be ready to use the brakes if necessary Select an appropriate speed while driving in curves Adaptive Cruise Control may operate differently in a sharp curve The system may reduce your speed in a curve if the curve is too sharp The TIGHT CURVE message will also display on the HUD See Head Up Display HUD on page 171 for more information When following a vehicle and entering a curve Adaptive Cruise Control could lose track of the vehicle in your lane and accelerate your vehicle When this happens
9. 173 As light shines out from the HUD it is possible for light to shine back in In rare occurrences when the sun is at a specific angle and position the sun s rays can shine back into the HUD When this occurs the display device within the HUD will be temporarily illuminated The event will end when the vehicle s angle to the sun changes Clean the inside of the windshield as needed to remove any dirt or film that reduces the sharpness or clarity of the HUD image To clean the HUD spray household glass cleaner on a soft clean cloth Wipe the HUD lens gently then dry it Do not spray cleaner directly on the lens because the cleaner could leak into the unit If the ignition is on and you cannot see the HUD image check to see if e Something is covering the HUD unit e The brightness is adjusted properly e The HUD image is adjusted to the proper height e Ambient light in the direction your vehicle is facing is low e A fuse is blown See Fuses and Circuit Breakers on page 453 174 Keep in mind that your windshield is part of the HUD system See Windshield Replacement on page 412 The following Adaptive Cruise Control ACC messages may appear in the HUD CRUISE SPEED LIMITED This message indicates that your vehicle speed has been reduced below your set speed due to ACC limitations Your set speed is too high and ACC cannot detect other vehicles at far enough distances for the system to operate prop
10. According to accident statistics children are safer when properly restrained in the rear seating positions than in the front seating positions In a crash children who are not buckled up can strike other people who are buckled up or can be thrown out of the vehicle Older children need to use safety belts properly A CAUTION Never do this Here two children are wearing the same belt The belt can not properly spread the impact forces In a crash the two children can be crushed together and seriously injured A belt must be used by only one person at a time 29 Q What if a child is wearing a lap shoulder belt but the child is so small that the Z CAUTION shoulder belt is very close to the child s face or neck Never do this Here a child is sitting in a seat that has a lap shoulder belt but the shoulder part is A Move the child toward the center of the vehicle but be sure that the shoulder belt still is on the child s shoulder so that in a crash the child s upper body would have the restraint that belts provide behind the child If the child wears the belt in this way in a crash the child might slide under the belt The belt s force would then be applied right on the child s abdomen That could cause serious or fatal injuries The lap portion of the belt should be worn low and snug on the hips just touching the child s thighs This applies belt force to the child s pelvic bones
11. Not all OnStar features are available on all vehicles To check if your vehicle is equipped to provide the services described below or for a full description of OnStar services and system limitations see the OnStar Owner s Guide in your glove box or visit onstar com OnStar Services For new vehicles with OnStar the Safe amp Sound Plan or the Directions amp Connections Plan is included for one year from the date of purchase You can extend this plan beyond the first year or upgrade to the Directions amp Connections Plan For more information press the OnStar button to speak with an advisor Some OnStar services such as Remote Door Unlock or Stolen Vehicle Location Assistance may not be available until you register with OnStar 107 Available Services with Safe amp Sound Plan 108 Automatic Notification of Airbag Deployment Advanced Automatic Crash Notification AACN If equipped Link to Emergency Services Roadside Assistance Stolen Vehicle Location Assistance AccidentAssist Remote Door Unlock Vehicle Alert OnStar Vehicle Diagnostics GM Goodwrench On Demand Diagnostics OnStar Hands Free Calling with 30 complimentary minutes OnStar Virtual Advisor U S Only Available Services included with Directions amp Connections Plan e All Safe and Sound Plan Services e Driving Directions Advisor delivered or OnStar Turn by Turn Navigation If equipped
12. To clean use the following instructions 1 Saturate a lint free clean white cloth with water or club soda 2 Wring the cloth to remove excess moisture 3 Start on the outside edge of the soil and gently rub toward the center Continue cleaning using a clean area of the cloth each time it becomes soiled 4 Continue to gently rub the soiled area until the cleaning cloth remains clean 5 If the soil is not completely removed use a mild soap solution and repeat the cleaning process that was used with plain water If any of the soil remains a commercial fabric cleaner or spot lifter may be necessary When a commercial upholstery cleaner or spot lifter is to be used test a small hidden area for colorfastness first If the locally cleaned area gives any impression that a ring formation may result clean the entire surface After the cleaning process has been completed a paper towel can be used to blot excess moisture from the fabric or carpet 443 Leather A soft cloth dampened with water may be used to remove dust If a more thorough cleaning is necessary a soft cloth dampened with a mild soap solution can be used Allow the leather to dry naturally Do not use heat to dry Never use steam to clean leather Never use spot lifters or spot removers on leather Many commercial leather cleaners and coatings that are sold to preserve and protect leather may permanently change the appearance and feel of your leather
13. If all 60 stored points are entered the system will notify you that there is no available storage left in memory points A memory point must be removed before storing additional memory points Registering Memory Points To store a memory point do the following 1 Select a category from the EDIT MEMORY POINT menu 2 Touch REGISTER 3 Select a method for entering a destination A map will appear displaying the memory point s location 4 If available touch INFO to view the address information for the memory point 5 Touch Enter to store the point Editing Memory Points This feature allows you to edit the contents stored in memory The following options are available Icon Editing of a Memory Point Each memory point is displayed with a default icon To edit an icon do the following 1 Select the category of the memory point 2 Select the item you want to edit 3 Touch the icon The EDIT MEMORY POINT icon screen will appear 4 Touch the icon you would like to use The system will then return to the EDIT MEMORY POINT menu 5 Touch Return to go back to the previous screen You will see the new memory point icon on the map When selecting an icon you can choose from 18 different icons three of which are sound icons The same icon may be used for other memory points as well Name Editing of a Memory Point To modify the name of a stored memory point do the following 1 Select the category of
14. Lighter colored interiors may require more frequent cleaning Use care because newspapers and garments that transfer color to your home furnishings may also transfer color to your vehicle s interior 441 When cleaning your vehicle s interior only use cleaners specifically designed for the surfaces being cleaned Permanent damage may result from using cleaners on surfaces for which they were not intended Use glass cleaner only on glass Remove any accidental over spray from other surfaces immediately To prevent over spray apply cleaner directly to the cleaning cloth Notice If you use abrasive cleaners when cleaning glass surfaces on your vehicle you could scratch the glass and or cause damage to the integrated radio antenna and the rear window defogger When cleaning the glass on your vehicle use only a soft cloth and glass cleaner Many cleaners contain solvents that may become concentrated in your vehicle s breathing space Before using cleaners read and adhere to all safety instructions on the label While cleaning your vehicle s interior maintain adequate ventilation by opening your vehicle s doors and windows Dust may be removed from small buttons and knobs using a small brush with soft bristles 442 Your dealer has a product for cleaning your vehicle s glass Should it become necessary you can also obtain a product from your dealer to remove odors from your vehicle s upholstery Do not clea
15. Usage Fluid Lubricant The engine requires a special engine oil meeting GM Standard GM4718M Oils meeting this standard may be identified as synthetic and should also be identified with the American Petroleum Institute API Certified for Gasoline Engines starburst symbol However not all synthetic API oils with the starburst symbol will meet this GM standard You should look for and use only an oil that meets GM Standard GM4718M GM Goodwrench oil meets all the requirements for your vehicle For the proper viscosity see Engine Oil on page 377 50 50 mixture of clean drinkable Engine Cooling water and use only DEX COOL System Coolant See Engine Coolant on page 385 Engine Oil 473 Usage Fluid Lubricant Usage Fluid Lubricant Intercooler SAE 75W 90 Synthetic System 50 50 mixture of clean drinkable Axle Lubricant 4 4L V8 water and use only DEX COOL GM Part No U S 89021677 in Supercharged Coolant Canada 89021678 meeting GM engine Rear Axle Specification 9986115 With a H lic Brake Delco 11 Brake Flui Limited Slip complete drain and refill add Ko i Cauivalent DOTS Drake a r Differential 4 ounces 118 ml of Limited Slip Windshield Axle Lubricant Additive GM Optikleen Washer Solvent GM Part No U S 1052358 in asner Canada 992694 where required GM Power Steering Fluid See Rear Axle on page 407 Power Steering GM Part No U S 89021184 in ERIE pag ystem Canada 8
16. e Use tires of the same brand and tread type on all four wheel positions e Use only radial ply tires of the same size load range and speed rating as the original equipment tires Winter tires with the same speed rating as your original equipment tires may not be available for H V W Y and ZR speed rated tires If you choose winter tires with a lower speed rating never exceed the tire s maximum speed capability Tire Sidewall Labeling Useful information about a tire is molded into its sidewall The example below shows a typical passenger p metric tire sidewall ES 4109 MS S K lt 2si60R 16 9 gt s gS DOT MALIARo Q R y S Z LL oc AT X A g7 KPA RS et p Passenger P Metric Tire Example A Tire Size The tire size is a combination of letters and numbers used to define a particular tire s width height aspect ratio construction type and service description See the Tire Size illustration later in this section for more detail B TPC Spec Tire Performance Criteria Specification Original equipment tires designed to GM s specific tire performance criteria have a TPC specification code molded onto the sidewall GM s TPC specifications meet or exceed all federal safety guidelines C DOT Department of Transportation The Department of Transportation DOT code indicates that the tire is in compliance with the U S Department of Transportation Motor Vehicle Safety Standar
17. on and when a switch is in the down position write off If a switch is set between the up and down position write middle 3 Enter these positions into the Universal Home Remote System as follows Press and release all three buttons at the same time to put the device into programming mode 5 After entering the switch settings press and Wa release all three buttons at the same time Number The indicator lights will turn on itch Posion 6 Press and hold the button you would like to Xo An l le use to control the garage door until the utton garage door moves The indicator light above the selected button should slowly blink You may need to hold the button from five to 55 seconds 7 Immediately release the button when the garage door moves The indicator light will EE blink rapidly until programming is complete 8 Press and release the button again The 4 The indicator light will blink slowly In order garage door should move confirming that from left to right and within two and one half programming is successful and complete minutes enter each switch setting into the Universal Home Remote System Push f garage door opener a security device or ome PURO NAO pals swiian 33 follows home lighting repeat Steps 1 8 choosing a e Left button on switch position different function button in Step 7 than what you e Right button off switch position used for the garage door
18. this light will come on when your engine is started and may stay on for several seconds That is normal If the light stays on turn the ignition off or if the light comes on when you are driving stop as soon as possible and turn the ignition off Then start the engine again to reset the system If the light still stays on or comes on again while you are driving your vehicle needs service If the regular brake system warning light is not on you still have brakes but you do not have anti lock brakes If the regular brake system warning light is also on you do not have anti lock brakes and there is a problem with your regular brakes See Service ABS under DIC Warnings and Messages on page 206 The ABS warning light will come on briefly when you turn the ignition on This is normal If the light does not come on then have it fixed so it will be ready to warn you if there is a problem 193 Traction Control System TCS Warning Light This light should come on briefly as you start the engine If the light does not come on then have it fixed so it will be ready to warn you if there is a problem The light will also come on while the StabiliTrak system warms up and the STABILITRAK WARMING message will be displayed in the Driver Information Center DIC If it stays on or comes on and the DIC shows a SERVICE TRACTION SYS message when you are driving there is a problem with your Traction Control System TCS and
19. 2 Once the desired category is displayed touch SCAN The radio will begin scanning within the chosen category 3 Touch SCAN again to stop scanning To scan through your preset stations touch and hold SCAN Touch SCAN again to stop scanning 299 XM Radio Messages Radio Display Message Action Required XM Updating Updating encryption code The encryption code in your receiver is being updated and no action is required This process should take no longer than 30 seconds No XM Signal Loss of signal Your system is functioning correctly but you are ina location that is blocking the XM signal When you move into an open area the signal should return Loading XM Acquiring channel audio Your radio system is acquiring and processing audio and after 4 second delay text data No action is needed This message should disappear shortly Channel Off Air Channel not in service This channel is not currently in service Tune in to another channel Channel Unavail Channel no longer This previously assigned channel is no longer assigned available Tune to another station If this station was one of your presets you may need to choose another station for that preset button No Info Artist Name Feature Artist song title and or category information may not be Song Title CAT not available at this time on this channel Your system is available working properly 300 Radio Display Message Action Required Not Found No channel
20. airbag for the driver and a side impact airbag for A CAUTION the passenger Airbags are designed to supplement the protection You can be severely injured or killed in a provided by safety belts Even though today s crash if you are not wearing your safety airbags are also designed to help reduce the risk belt even if you have airbags Wearing of injury from the force of an inflating bag all your safety belt during a crash helps airbags must inflate very quickly to do their job reduce your chance of hitting things inside the vehicle or being ejected from it Airbags are supplemental restraints to the safety belts All airbags are designed to work with safety belts but do not replace them 44 A CAUTION Frontal airbags for the driver and passenger are designed to deploy in moderate to severe frontal and near frontal crashes They are not designed to inflate in rollover rear crashes or in many side crashes And for some unrestrained occupants frontal airbags may provide less protection in frontal crashes than more forceful airbags have provided in the past Side impact airbags for the driver and passenger are designed to inflate in moderate to severe crashes where something hits the side of your vehicle They are not designed to inflate in frontal in rollover or in rear crashes Everyone in your vehicle should wear a safety belt properly whether or not there is an airbag for that person A CAUTI
21. 00 0 171 Heated Seats cccccccccceccecceececceeseeeeeeeeeeeeaeees 9 FIG ALS insanin ia ban E 178 Highbeam On Light sssi sseseiissonsinssisadss 202 Highway Hypnosis ceeeeeeeneeeeeeeeeeeees 346 Hill and Mountain Roads n e 347 Hood Checking Things Under aeee 372 Release ssissdovecetiwsavsadiecsecavebstciecivedendeedes 373 FIOM AETA PEE E E 140 How to Use This Manual ecce 4 How to Wear Safety Belts Properly 18 I Ignition POSItIONS sssiicorisisisssssnsinoaricisas 88 Infants and Young Children Restraints 31 Inflation Tire Pressure ccecce 422 Instrument Panel OVGEIVIOW aisses tutira inonib nne 138 Instrument Panel I P BriQhtM SS aessseitaain i eiidt senaiak 170 GIUSION kerran naa E EE NESE 186 J JUMP Starting svecvesaieatecdnt eaves 403 Keyless Access System 00cceseeeees 67 280 Keyless Access System Operation 68 IRC YS cessor cc E ace ines E vane eaters 65 L Labeling Tire Sidewall ccecceceeeeeeeeees 415 Lamps Battery Run Down Protection 171 COUMCSY sccuseccersiuoecttencidanetetuceesttneateansacndex 170 EXIENOT wesizevsdsavenvce ervaveresavenee ond as 164 Exterior Lighting Battery Saver 169 FOQ E neon 168 Reading 2 cccceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeenteeeseeateeeeenens 171 Twilight Sentinel cccccceeseeeeeeees 168 LATCH System Child Restraints sssisarsssse ineens 39 Lifting Your Veh
22. Anti Lock Brake System ACTIVE This message displays when the Anti lock Brake System ABS is adjusting brake pressure to help avoid a braking skid Slippery road conditions may exist if this message displays so adjust your driving accordingly The message may stay on for a few seconds after the system stops adjusting brake pressure BUCKLE PASSENGER This message reminds you to buckle the passenger s safety belt This message displays and a chime sounds when the ignition is on the driver s safety belt is buckled the passenger s safety belt is unbuckled with the passenger airbag enabled and the vehicle is in motion You should have the passenger buckle their safety belt The reminder will be repeated if the ignition is on the vehicle is in motion the driver is buckled and the passenger is still unbuckled and the passenger airbag is enabled If the passenger s safety belt is already buckled this message and chime will not come on BUCKLE SEAT BELT This message reminds you to buckle the drivers safety belt This message displays and a chime sounds when the ignition is on the driver s safety belt is unbuckled and the vehicle is in motion You should buckle your safety belt If the driver remains unbuckled when the ignition is on and the vehicle is in motion the reminder will be repeated If the drivers safety belt is already buckled this message and chime will not come on This message is an additiona
23. Each of the four information types may have multiple pages of text To reach a category touch INFO repeatedly until the desired type is displayed If there are multiple pages of text for the information selected type the radio will automatically display all the pages for that type at a rate of about one page every three seconds before timing out and returning to the default display You may override this feature by touching INFO to review all of the pages at your own pace XL Explicit Language Channels XL on the radio display after the channel name indicates content with explicit language These channels or any others can be blocked at a customer s request by calling in the U S 1 800 852 XMXM 9696 or in Canada 1 877 GET XMSR 438 9677 Setting Program Type PTY Preset Stations lt CAT gt Category Press the arrows to select a category Once the desired category is displayed press TUNE SEEK to select the category and take you to the category s first station If you want to go to another station within that category press TUNE SEEK once Touch and hold one of the desired P1 P6 presets to store the selected station as a preset If PTY times out and is no longer on the display start again SCAN Use this button to scan through the channels within a category or scan through the preset stations To scan through the channels in a category do the following 1 Select a category by using the category arrows
24. In most cases the parts being recycled are from undamaged sections of the vehicle A recycled original equipment GM part may be an acceptable choice to maintain your vehicle s originally designed appearance and safety performance however the history of these parts is not known Such parts are not covered by your GM New Vehicle Limited Warranty and any related failures are not covered by that warranty Aftermarket collision parts are also available These are made by companies other than GM and may not have been tested for your vehicle As a result these parts may fit poorly exhibit premature durability corrosion problems and may not perform properly in subsequent collisions Aftermarket parts are not covered by your GM New Vehicle Limited Warranty and any vehicle failure related to such parts are not covered by that warranty Repair Facility GM also recommends that you choose a collision repair facility that meets your needs before you ever need collision repairs Your GM dealer may have a collision repair center with GM trained technicians and state of the art equipment or be able to recommend a collision repair center that has GM trained technicians and comparable equipment Insuring Your Vehicle Protect your investment in your GM vehicle with comprehensive and collision insurance coverage There are significant differences in the quality of coverage afforded by various insurance policy terms Many insurance poli
25. Passive Locking This feature allows you to select whether the doors automatically lock during normal vehicle exit When the ignition is turned off and all doors become closed the vehicle will determine how many keyless access transmitters remain in the vehicle interior If at least one keyless access transmitter has been removed from the interior of the vehicle the doors will lock after eight seconds For example if there are two keyless access transmitters in the vehicle and one is removed the other will be locked in The keyless access transmitter locked in the vehicle can still be used to start the vehicle or unlock the doors if needed A person approaching the outside of the locked vehicle without an authorized keyless access transmitter however will not be able to open the door even with a transmitter in the vehicle You may temporarily disable the passive door locking feature by pressing the door unlock switch for three seconds on an open door Passive door locking will then remain disabled until a door lock switch is pressed or until the power mode transitions from the off power mode You can select to not have the horn sound when the passive lock occurs If you choose this setting the doors will automatically lock eight seconds after you turn the ignition off remove a keyless access transmitter from the interior of the vehicle and close both doors You can also select to have the horn sound once when the passive
26. Q Is there anything might add to the front or sides of the vehicle that could keep the airbags from working properly A Yes If you add things that change your vehicle s frame bumper system height front end or side sheet metal they may keep the airbag system from working properly Also the airbag system may not work properly if you relocate any of the airbag sensors If you have any questions about this you should contact Customer Assistance before you modify your vehicle The phone numbers and addresses for Customer Assistance are in Step Two of the Customer Satisfaction Procedure in this manual See Customer Satisfaction Procedure on page 482 Q Because have a disability have to get my vehicle modified How can I find out whether this will affect my advanced airbag system Changing or moving any parts of the front seats safety belts the airbag sensing and diagnostic module steering wheel instrument panel the inside review mirror or airbag wiring can affect the operation of the airbag system If you have questions call Customer Assistance The phone numbers and addresses for Customer Assistance are in Step Two of the Customer Satisfaction Procedure in this manual See Customer Satisfaction Procedure on page 482 59 Restraint System Check Checking the Restraint Systems Now and then make sure the safety belt reminder light and all your belts buckles latch plates retractors and anchorages ar
27. See Edit Memory Point on page 250 for more information am 102 5MHz PERSONAL BUSINESS MARKED POINT You must have destinations stored as memory points to select from PERSONAL BUSINESS ENTERTAINMENT or MARKED POINT If you have renamed the memory point category name s the name s will appear as you changed them 263 To select a destination using this entry method do the following 102 5MHz 3 04AM 85 F 1 Touch the Memory Points symbol PREVIOUS DESTINATION 2 Select a category 3 Select a destination Use the arrows to scroll through the memory points They can be sorted by date name distance and icon 4 Touch Enter to plan your route Previous Destination This destination entry method allows you to select a destination by choosing from a list of the last 10 destinations entered into the system To select a previous destination do the following 1 Touch the Previous Destination symbol 2 Touch the screen button next to the desired destination to select it Use the arrows if necessary to view the entire list of previous destinations 3 Touch Enter to plan your route 264 Previous Starting Point This destination entry method allows you to select the last start point as your destination To select the previous start point as your destination do the following 1 Touch Previous Destination 2 Touch the Previous starting point screen button 3 Touch Enter to pla
28. These commands will cause the system to display other types of restaurant POI icons Shopping Shopping Mall These commands will cause the system to display mall POI icons Grocery Store This command will cause the system to display grocery store POI icons Gas Station Gas These commands will cause the system to display gas station POI icons Parking Garage This command will cause the system to display parking garage POI icons Parking Lot This command will cause the system to display parking lot POI icons Rental Car Agency This command will cause the system to display rental car POI icons Automobile Club Triple A These commands will cause the system to display auto club POI icons Auto Service And Maintenance Auto Service Maintenance These commands will cause the system to display auto service POI icons Hotel This command will cause the system to display hotel POI icons Golf Course This command will cause the system to display golf course POI icons Ski Resort Skiing These commands will cause the system to display ski resort POI icons Amusement Park This command will cause the system to display amusement park POI icons Sport Complex Stadium These commands will cause the system to display sports complex POI icons Casino This command will cause the system to display casino POI icons Marina This command will cause the system to display marina POI icons Tourist Attraction This co
29. To access the WAYPOINT menu do the following 1 Press the ROUTE key 2 Touch Edit Waypoint Adding a Waypoint To add a waypoint to your route do the following 1 Touch Add Waypoint 2 Enter a destination See Enter Destination on page 259 A map will appear showing the location of the waypoint 3 Touch Enter to add your waypoint 4 Touch the ADD screen button to insert the waypoint in the desired order 5 The system will display the ROUTE INFORMATION screen From this screen several options are available ee ROUTE INFORMATION 1 59AM 85 F Stored W points 5 Passed Waypoints 0 am 3 Co Co List Touch List to view the waypoint on the map or to change the order of the waypoints and final destination To change the order touch CHG ORDER then touch the blank screen button next to the destination to select the order of the waypoints and final destination Press the MAP key to view the destination and waypoints on the map screen Delete Touch Delete to delete a waypoint or the final destination A confirmation window will appear Touch YES to delete the point or NO to return to the previous screen 255 Delete All Touch Delete All to delete all of the waypoints and the final destination A confirmation window will appear Touch YES to delete all waypoints or NO to return to the previous screen Change Touch Change to change the final destination Enter a destination See Enter Destin
30. acknowledge a message and read another message that may have come on at the same time press the RESET button ACCESSORY MODE ON CHANGE OIL SOON See Engine Oil on page 377 and Engine Oil Life System on page 380 FOB BATTERY LOW HIGH TIRE PRESS LF HIGH TIRE PRESS RF HIGH TIRE PRESS LR HIGH TIRE PRESS RR INTRUSION SENSOR OFF INTRUSION SENSOR ON KNOWN FOB LEFT FRONT TIRE FLAT MAX SPD 55 REDUCED HNDLG LEFT REAR TIRE FLAT MAX SPD 55 REDUCED HNDLG LOW TIRE PRESS LF LOW TIRE PRESS RF LOW TIRE PRESS LR LOW TIRE PRESS RR MAX FOBS LEARNED OFF ACC TO LEARN READY FOR FOB X RIGHT FRT TIRE FLAT MAX SPD 55 REDUCED HNDLG RIGHT REAR TIRE FLAT MAX SPD 55 REDUCED HNDLG WAIT XX MINUTES 219 DIC Vehicle Personalization Your vehicle has personalization capabilities that allow you to program certain features to a preferred setting for up to two drivers The back of the keyless access transmitters are labelled 1 or 2 The current driver s preferences are recalled when one of the following occurs e The lock or unlock button on the keyless access transmitter programmed as 1 or 2 is pressed e The appropriate memory button 1 or 2 located on the driver s seat is pressed See Memory Seat Mirrors and Steering Wheel on page 10 for more information e A valid keyless access transmitter is detected upon opening the drivers door If more than one valid keyless access transmitter is detected upon opening the
31. button to exit from the ELAPSED TIME display 205 FRONT Lxx Rxx PSI This feature shows the tire pressure for the front left and right tires REAR Lxx Rxx PSI This feature shows the tire pressure for the rear left and right tires OIL LIFE This feature shows the estimated oil life remaining See Oil Life Indicator on page 224 for more information To reset the engine oil life system see Engine Oil Life System on page 380 This only needs to be reset after you have had the oil changed In addition to the engine oil life system monitoring oil life additional maintenance is recommended in the Maintenance Schedule in this manual See Scheduled Maintenance on page 465 and Engine Oil on page 377 for more information ENG METRIC English Metric This feature allows you to switch the DIC displays between English and Metric Press the RESET button to switch the display between English and Metric There will be an arrow next to the option that is selected 206 DIC Warnings and Messages These messages appear if there is a problem detected in one of your vehicle s systems You must then press RESET to clear the display screen for further use However be sure to take any message that appears on the display screen seriously and remember that pressing the RESET button will only make the message disappear not the problem DIC messages can also be displayed in English French German Italian Japanese and Spanish ABS
32. deck cayeeevidesusitatousiaccctiaxtennennnwcias 359 Service and Appearance Care 361 Vehicle Identification oo eee 451 Service oeeeeccccceccecccesscecsceceecesscecsueesseenecs 363 El ctrical System cpiisdennaddusacdiecaverian 452 e EA E a A E 365 Capacities and Specifications 458 ee ee Sos Maintenance Schedule 461 Headlamp Aiming eeeccceceeeceeeeeeeeees 408 MIRE MaMOe ONGAME saactinietimehas qpa Bulb Replacement ooo ecccecceceeceeeeeeeeeees 412 Customer Assistance Information 481 Windshield Replacement _ 0 6008 412 Customer Assistance and Windshield Wiper Blade INFOrmation oi eeeecceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 482 Replacement asiasiacsaaassicaadersanaidntiasenianns 412 Reporting Safety Defects ow 496 WINES aran a 413 Appearance Care E EE EE EEA 441 Index RAELA TETTI EITT ET E TT 499 GENERAL MOTORS GM the GM Emblem CADILLAC the CADILLAC Crest amp Wreath and the name XLR are registered trademarks of General Motors Corporation This manual includes the latest information at the time it was printed We reserve the right to make changes after that time to the product without notice For vehicles first sold in Canada substitute the name General Motors of Canada Limited for Cadillac Motor Car Division whenever it appears in this manual Litho in U S A Part No 15865979 A First Printing This manual describes features that may be available in this model bu
33. indicates that the oil has been certified by the American Petroleum Institute API You should look for this on the oil container and use only those oils that are identified as meeting GM Standard GM4718M and have the starburst symbol on the front of the oil container 379 Your vehicle s engine is filled at the factory with a Mobil 1 synthetic oil which meets all requirements for your vehicle Substitute Engine Oil When adding oil to maintain engine oil level oil meeting GM Standard GM4718M may not be available You can add substitute oil designated SAE 5W 30 with the starburst symbol at all temperatures Substitute oil not meeting GM Standard GM4718M should not be used for an oil change Engine Oil Additives Do not add anything to the oil The recommended oils with the starburst symbol that meet GM Standard GM4718M are all you will need for good performance and engine protection 380 Engine Oil Life System When to Change Engine Oil Your vehicle has a computer system that lets you know when to change the engine oil and filter This is based on engine revolutions and engine temperature and not on mileage Based on driving conditions the mileage at which an oil change will be indicated can vary considerably For the oil life system to work properly you must reset the system every time the oil is changed Notice If your vehicle is an XLR V model the engine uses a special oil filter The use of any othe
34. minus controls the driver manual gear selection is activated A plus symbol appears on the shift console above the DRIVE D indicator and minus symbol appears below the indicator The Head Up Display HUD also displays the requested gear though the actual upshift or downshift could be delayed until the engine speed is correct for that gear The requested gear displays on the HUD until the next time you upshift or downshift The gear selected and shown in the HUD is one of a number of gears available The vehicle does not upshift beyond the chosen gear The actual gear that the vehicle shifts to depends on a combination of the driver requested gear range vehicle speed and throttle position Notice lf you drive your vehicle at high RPMs without upshifting while using Driver Shift Control DSC you could damage your vehicle Always upshift when necessary while using DSC If you do not upshift as the engine approaches the red line on the engine RPM Revolutions Per Minute gage the engine speed is controlled to limit the engine RPM 95 Not all manual downshift requests will be allowed by the transmission To prevent excessive engine RPMs each gear has a maximum vehicle speed associated with it Any downshift request above this speed is not allowed by the transmission If shifting is prevented for any reason the current gear flashes multiple times in the Driver Information Center DIC indicating that the transmis
35. the vehicle ahead symbol will not appear on the HUD Adaptive Cruise Control may detect a vehicle that is not in your lane and apply the brakes Adaptive Cruise Control may occasionally provide a driver alert and or braking that you consider unnecessary It could respond to signs guardrails and other stationary objects when entering or exiting a curve This is normal operation Your vehicle does not need service 161 Highway Exit Ramps A CAUTION Adaptive Cruise Control may lose track of the vehicle ahead and accelerate up to your set speed while entering or on highway exit ramps You could be startled by this acceleration and even lose control of the vehicle Disengage Adaptive Cruise Control before entering a highway exit ramp Do not use Adaptive Cruise Control while entering or on exit ramps 162 Other Vehicle Lane Changes If another vehicle enters the same lane as you Adaptive Cruise Control will not detect the vehicle until it is completely in the lane Be ready to take action and apply the brakes yourself Using Adaptive Cruise Control on Hills How well Adaptive Cruise Control will work on hills depends on your speed vehicle load traffic conditions and the steepness of the hills It may not detect a vehicle in your lane while driving on hills When going up steep hills you may want to use the accelerator pedal to maintain your speed When going downhill you may have to brake to ke
36. the vehicle will turn off STABILITRAK ACTIVE You may see this message on the DIC It means that an advanced computer controlled system has come on to help your vehicle continue to go in the direction in which you are steering This stability enhancement system activates when the computer senses that your vehicle is just starting to spin as it might if you hit a patch of ice or other slippery spot on the road When the system is on you may hear a noise or feel a vibration in the brake pedal This is normal When this message is on continue to steer in the direction you want to go The system is designed to help you in bad weather or other difficult driving situations by making the most of whatever road 216 conditions will permit If this message comes on you will know that something has caused your vehicle to start to spin so consider slowing down A single chime also sounds when this message is displayed STABILITRAK READY If this message displays and a chime sounds the system has completed the functional check of the StabiliTrak System STABILITRAK WARMING When you first start your vehicle and drive away especially during cold winter weather this message may display along with a chime and the traction control warning light This is normal You can acknowledge this message by pressing the RESET button The StabiliTrak System performance is affected until the STABILITRAK READY message is displayed in the
37. this ever happens have the vehicle operates A CAUTION serviced promptly because an adult size person sitting in the right front passenger s seat may not have the protection of an airbag See Airbag Readiness Light on page 188 for more on this including important safety information Stowing of articles under the passenger s seat or between the passenger s seat cushion and seatback may interfere with the proper operation of the passenger sensing system 57 Servicing Your Airbag Equipped Vehicle Airbags affect how your vehicle should be serviced There are parts of the airbag system in several places around your vehicle You do not want the system to inflate while someone is working on your vehicle Your dealer and the service manual have information about servicing your vehicle and the airbag system To purchase a service manual see Service Publications Ordering Information on page 497 58 A CAUTION For up to 10 seconds after the ignition is turned off and the battery is disconnected an airbag can still inflate during improper service You can be injured if you are close to an airbag when it inflates Avoid yellow connectors They are probably part of the airbag system Be sure to follow proper service procedures and make sure the person performing work for you is qualified to do so The airbag system does not need regular maintenance Adding Equipment to Your Airbag Equipped Vehicle
38. to display the screen adjust menu See Screen Adjust Menu later in this section for more information SOUND Touch this screen button to access the Sound menu See Sound Menu later in this section for more information DSP Digital Signal Processing Touch this screen button to access the DSP menu See Adjusting the Speakers later in this section for more information Clock Adjust Menu 8 50PM 85 F 87 9 MHz _ 8 50 PM Display Type GPS TIME TIME ZONE The following options are available from this menu HOUR MIN Touch the up or down arrows to increase or decrease the hour or minutes If you touch and hold one of the arrows the numbers will advance quickly 12H 24H Touch 12H to set the clock in standard time or 24H to set the clock in military time 287 GPS TIME The current GPS time will be displayed to the right of this screen button Touch GPS TIME to set the navigation system time to match current GPS time If the seconds for the present minute are greater than thirty when GPS TIME is selected the clock will round up to the next minute Daylight Saving Time Touch this screen button to increase the time setting by one hour Then touch GPS TIME to save the new setting If the screen button is light blue the daylight savings time feature is on If the button is dark blue the daylight savings time feature is off TIME ZONE The selected time zone will appear to the r
39. using a safety belt properly Your vehicle has a light that comes on as a reminder to buckle up See Safety Belt Reminder Light on page 187 In most states and in all Canadian provinces the law says to wear safety belts Here is why They work 13 You never know if you will be in a crash If you do have a crash you do not know if it will be a bad one A few crashes are mild and some crashes can be so serious that even buckled up a person would not survive But most crashes are in between In many of them people who buckle up can survive and sometimes walk away Without belts they could have been badly hurt or killed After more than 40 years of safety belts in vehicles the facts are clear In most crashes buckling up does matter a lot Why Safety Belts Work When you ride in or on anything you go as fast as it goes Take the simplest vehicle Suppose it is just a seat on wheels Put someone on it Get it up to speed Then stop the vehicle The rider does not stop 15 The person keeps going until stopped by something In a real vehicle it could be the windshield or the instrument panel or the safety belts With safety belts you slow down as the vehicle does You get more time to stop You stop over more distance and your strongest bones take the forces That is why safety belts make such good sense Questions and Answers About Safety Belts Q A Will
40. want to avoid You can use REDUCE or ENLARGE to edit the avoided point Touch Reroute or press the MAP key to calculate your new route Touch Return to view your current position and to turn the turn list screen off Touch REROUTE or press the MAP key to calculate a new route Auto Reroute When your destination is set and you travel off of the planned route the system will automatically begin to reroute you You will see the new route highlighted on the screen 279 Traveling Across Regions If you plan to drive across several states you may have to change the selected region to represent the area you are traveling to There are two ways you can plan a destination when traveling across regions The following method is suggested and provides the most route guidance and map display functions 1 Change the selected search area region when you get closer to the area you are traveling to See Setting the Search Area under Maps on page 271 2 Enter your destination and route settings See Enter Destination on page 259 for more information If you do not want to use the first method keep your currently selected search area region and enter your destination This method allows you only to select a destination from the easy planning route method or from the All Points of Interest POI categories with the All Search Areas comment for US Only For example Tourist 280 is a category that features this c
41. your concern will likely be resolved at a dealer s facility That is why we suggest you follow Step One first if you have a concern STEP THREE Both General Motors and your dealer are committed to making sure you are completely satisfied with your new vehicle However if you continue to remain unsatisfied after following the procedure outlined in Steps One and Two you should file with the BBB Auto Line Program to enforce any additional rights you may have Canadian owners refer to your Warranty and Owner Assistance Information booklet for information on the Canadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan CAMVAP The BBB Auto Line Program is an out of court program administered by the Council of Better Business Bureaus to settle automotive disputes regarding vehicle repairs or the interpretation of the New Vehicle Limited Warranty Although you may be required to resort to this informal dispute resolution program prior to filing a court action use of the program is free of charge and your case will generally be heard within 40 days If you do not agree with the decision given in your case you may reject it and proceed with any other venue for relief available to you You may contact the BBB Auto Line Program using the toll free telephone number or write them at the following address BBB Auto Line Program Council of Better Business Bureaus Inc 4200 Wilson Boulevard Suite 800 Arlington VA 22203 1838 Telephone 1 800 955 5
42. 109 Grades B and A represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by law Warning The temperature grade for this tire is established for a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded Excessive speed underinflation or excessive loading either separately or in combination can cause heat buildup and possible tire failure 432 Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance The tires and wheels on your vehicle were aligned and balanced carefully at the factory to give you the longest tire life and best overall performance Adjustments to wheel alignment and tire balancing will not be necessary on a regular basis However if you notice unusual tire wear or your vehicle pulling to one side or the other the alignment may need to be checked If you notice your vehicle vibrating when driving on a smooth road your tires and wheels may need to be rebalanced See your dealer for proper diagnosis Wheel Replacement Replace any wheel that is bent cracked or badly rusted or corroded If wheel nuts keep coming loose the wheel wheel bolts and wheel nuts should be replaced If the wheel leaks air replace it except some aluminum wheels which can sometimes be repaired See your dealer if any of these conditions exist Your dealer will know the kind of wheel you need Each new wheel should have the same load carrying capacity diameter width offset and be mounted the same way as the o
43. 377 When the oil is changed you will need to reset the system See Engine Oil Life System on page 380 Always keep a written record of the mileage and date when you changed your oil Audio System s Determine which radio your vehicle has and then read the pages following to familiarize yourself with its features Driving without distraction is a necessity for a safer driving experience See Defensive Driving on page 322 By taking a few moments to read this manual and get familiar with your vehicle s audio system you can use it with less effort as well as take advantage of its features While your vehicle is parked set up your audio system by presetting your favorite radio stations setting the tone and adjusting the speakers Then when driving conditions permit you can tune to your favorite stations using the presets and steering wheel controls if the vehicle has them A CAUTION This system provides you with a far greater access to audio stations and song listings Giving extended attention to entertainment tasks while driving can cause a crash and you or others can be injured or killed Always keep your eyes on the road and your mind on the drive avoid engaging in extended searching while driving Keeping your mind on the drive is important for safe driving For more information see Defensive Driving on page 322 225 Here are some ways in which you can help avoid distraction while driving While
44. 467 At Each Fuel Fill cc cee ee eee 470 At Least Once a Month ccccceeeee ees 471 At Least Once a Year cccccecceeeeeeeeeees 471 INtFOGUCTION oo cece cece nnna aana asas 462 Maintenance Footnotes ccccseeeeeeees 469 Maintenance Record cccceceeeeeeeeeeeees 477 Maintenance Requirements 0008 462 Normal Maintenance Replacement Parts ssec 475 Owner Checks and Services 065 470 Recommended Fluids and Lubricants 473 Scheduled Maintenance n se 465 USING cennara denned 463 Your Vehicle and the Environment 462 Malfunction Indicator Light eee 196 Map Pocket cccccseeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaeeeeeeeaaeeeees 122 MAPS EE E E E 271 Memory Point Edit aaaeeeeeneeerrerrre ennn 250 Memory Seat Mirrors Steering Wheel CONOS e shiz tee cesteen ieee os 10 Menu SEUD uan noaa ute Sens teean esses 243 Message DIC Warnings and Messages 008 206 Mirrors Automatic Dimming Rearview with INNA aanne ieia Naa i 104 Outside Automatic Dimming Mirror 105 Outside Convex Mirror neeese 106 Outside Curb View Assist Mirror 106 Outside Power Heated Mirrors 105 MYGMLINK COM oo setedscescasceassineesentveapertsntnenaes 484 N Navigation eisium sndiri 232 234 Using the System sisisiiisirnn iison 240 New Vehicle Break In ccceeeeeseeeeeeeeneeeees 87 Normal Maintenance Replacement P
45. AJAR This message displays anytime the engine is running the transmission is not in PARK P and the driver s door is open or ajar A chime sounds when the vehicle s speed is greater than 3 mph 5 km h LOW BRAKE FLUID This message displays if the engine is running to inform the driver that the brake fluid level is low Have the brake system serviced by your dealer as soon as possible See Brake Fluid under Brakes on page 399 LOW COOLANT This message displays when there is a low level of engine coolant Have the cooling system serviced by your dealer as soon as possible See Engine Coolant on page 385 LOW FUEL This message displays when the fuel supply is less than 5 gallons 18 9 L and the display is turned off A single chime also sounds when this message is displayed 210 LOW OIL LEVEL For correct operation of the low oil sensing system your vehicle should be on a level surface A false LOW OIL LEVEL message may display if the vehicle is parked on a grade The oil level sensing system does not check for actual oil level if the engine has been off for a short period of time and the oil level is never checked while the engine is running If the LOW OIL LEVEL message displays and your vehicle has been parked on level ground with the engine off for at least 30 minutes the oil level should be checked by observing the oil dipstick Prior to checking the oil level make sure the engine has been off
46. Do not increase engine speed above a normal idle If it does not cool down turn off the engine and have your vehicle serviced by your dealer before driving it 208 again Severe engine damage can result from an overheated engine See Engine Overheating on page 388 CRUISE NOT READY This message indicates that the Adaptive Cruise Control ACC will not activate due to a temporary condition Your vehicle does not require service If this message displays when you attempt to activate the system continue driving for several minutes then try to activate the system again DRIVER NO X 1 OR 2 This message displays when the vehicle is started or when there is a change of driver The message shows which driver is activating the personalization feature It will only stay on for five seconds ENGINE HOT STOP ENGINE This message displays when the engine has overheated Stop and turn the engine off immediately to avoid severe engine damage See Engine Overheating on page 388 A multiple chime also sounds when this message displays ENGINE PROTECTION REDUCE ENGINE RPM If this message displays the control system has determined that continued operation at the existing engine speed may lead to engine overheating Lower the engine speed by upshifting the transmission or drive at a lower speed HEADLAMPS SUGGESTED This message displays if it is dark enough outside and the headlamps and Twilight Sentinel controls are off
47. Drive Oshawa Ontario L1H 8P7 1 888 446 2000 1 800 263 3830 For Text Telephone devices TTYs Roadside Assistance 1 800 882 1112 Overseas Customer Assistance Please contact the local General Motors Business Unit Mexico Central America and Caribbean Islands Countries Except Puerto Rico and U S Virgin Islands Customer Assistance General Motors de Mexico S de R L de C V Customer Assistance Center Paseo de la Reforma 2740 Col Lomas de Bezares C P 11910 Mexico D F 01 800 508 0000 Long Distance 011 52 53 29 0 800 486 GM Mobility Reimbursement Program EIMOBILITY This program available to qualified applicants can reimburse you up to 1 000 of the cost of eligible aftermarket adaptive equipment required for your vehicle such as hand controls or a wheelchair scooter lift The offer is available for a very limited period of time from the date of vehicle purchase lease For more details or to determine your vehicle s eligibility visit gmmobility com or call the GM Mobility Assistance Center at 1 800 323 9935 Text telephone TTY users call 1 800 833 9935 GM of Canada also has a Mobility Program Call 1 800 GM DRIVE 463 7483 for details TTY users call 1 800 263 3830 Roadside Service Cadillac s exceptional Roadside Service is more than an auto club or towing service It provides every Cadillac owner with the advantage of contacting a Cadillac advisor and where avail
48. Enter Destination on page 259 If desired reduce or enlarge the area around the point you want to avoid by using the REDUCE or ENLARGE screen buttons If an avoid point cannot be avoided the system will display Avoid Point and Area Stored Route May Not Avoid the Avoid Point and Areas Touch Enter to set the area as an avoid point area When using the REDUCE or ENLARGE buttons a box will appear to represent the area or an X will appear to represent the area avoided When an avoid point is set the square will appear as green Touch Return to go back to the previous screen 257 Editing an Avoid Point Area To edit an avoid point area do the following 1 Touch Edit Avoid Point Area A list of avoided points will appear 2 Select the avoided point area you want to change A map of the avoided area will appear 3 Use REDUCE or ENLARGE to edit the avoided point 4 Touch Enter to set your new avoided area The system will display Area Adjusted 5 Touch Return to go back to the previous screen 258 Deleting an Avoid Point Area To delete an avoid point area do the following 1 Touch Delete Avoid Point Area A list of avoided points will appear 2 Select the avoided point area you want to delete 3 The system will ask you to confirm your selection Touch Yes to delete the avoid point area or No to cancel If Yes is selected the area will no longer be avoided when traveling o
49. Services on page 470 can be added on the following record pages You should retain all maintenance receipts Maintenance Record Maintenance Record cont d Odometer A Maintenance I or 7 Reading Serviced By Maintenance II Services Performed 478 Maintenance Record cont d Maintenance Record cont d Odometer Maintenance I or 480 Section 8 Customer Assistance Information Customer Assistance and Information 482 Reporting Safety Defects 00000 496 Customer Satisfaction Procedure 482 Reporting Safety Defects to the Online Owner Center aseeseen 484 United States Government 0668 496 Customer Assistance for Text Reporting Safety Defects to the Telephone TTY Users c eeeeeee 485 Canadian Government 0 eeeeee 496 Customer Assistance Offices 00 485 Reporting Safety Defects to GM Mobility Reimbursement Program 486 General Motors cceeeeceeeteeeeeteeeeeees 497 Roadside Service eccerre 487 Service Publications Ordering Courtesy Transportation 0 ccccseeeeeeeee 488 INTOFMATION assein a 497 Vehicle Data Collection and Event Data RECOrderS oo eee eeeeecee cee eeeeeceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeenens 491 Collision Damage Repair 0 0 ee 492 481 Customer Assistance and Information Customer Satisfaction Procedure Your satisfaction and goodwill are important to your dealer and to Cadillac
50. Shifting Into Park P A CAUTION It can be dangerous to get out of your vehicle if the shift lever is not fully in PARK P with the parking brake firmly set Your vehicle can roll If you have left the engine running the vehicle can move suddenly You or others could be injured To be sure your vehicle will not move even when you are on fairly level ground use the steps that follow 1 Hold the brake pedal down with your right foot and set the parking brake 2 Move the shift lever into PARK P by pushing the lever all the way toward the front of the vehicle 3 Turn the ignition off Leaving Your Vehicle With the Engine Running A CAUTION It can be dangerous to leave your vehicle with the engine running Your vehicle could move suddenly if the shift lever is not fully in PARK P with the parking brake firmly set And if you leave the vehicle with the engine running it could overheat and even catch fire You or others could be injured Do not leave your vehicle with the engine running If you have to leave your vehicle with the engine running be sure your vehicle is in PARK P and your parking brake is firmly set before you leave it After you have moved the shift lever into PARK P hold down the regular brake pedal See if you can move the shift lever away from PARK P without first pulling it toward you If you can it means that the shift lever was not fully locked into PARK P 99 To
51. These commands will cause the system to change to Turn List Guidance screen view in the Guidance Menu if a destination has been set Entire Route Entire Route Map Route Overview These commands will cause the system to display the entire route if a destination has been set Reroute This command will cause the system to generate an alternate route to a set destination while on a planned route Detour Detour Entire Route These commands will cause the system to activate the detour feature when driving a planned route Delete Destination Cancel Destination These commands will cancel a destination if one has been set Next Waypoint Map This command will cause the system to display the map view of the next waypoint location if one has been set First Waypoint Map This command will cause the system to display the map view of the first waypoint location if one has been set Second Waypoint Map This command will cause the system to display the map view of the second waypoint location if more than one waypoint has been set Third Waypoint Map This command will cause the system to display the map view of the third waypoint location if more than two waypoints have been set Fourth Waypoint Map This command will cause the system to display the map view of the fourth waypoint location if more than three waypoints have been set Fifth Waypoint Map This command will cause the system to display the map view of the fifth w
52. This message informs the driver that turning on the exterior lamps is recommended It has become dark enough outside to require the headlamps and or other exterior lamps This message also displays if the optional Rainsense wiping feature is on and the Twilight Sentinel is off HIGH TRANS Transmission TEMP Temperature This message displays when the transmission fluid in your vehicle is too hot Stop and allow your vehicle to idle until it cools down or until this message is removed HIGH VOLTAGE This message displays when the electrical charging system is overcharging To avoid being stranded have the electrical system checked by your dealer You can reduce the charging overload by using the accessories Turn on the lamps and radio set the climate control on AUTO and the fan speed on HI and turn the rear window defogger on You can monitor battery voltage on the DIC by pressing the information button The normal range is 11 5 to 15 5 volts when the engine is running HOT ENGINE A C OFF This message displays when the engine coolant becomes hotter than the normal operating temperature You can continue to drive your vehicle If this message continues to display have the system repaired by your dealer as soon as possible to avoid compressor damage ICE POSSIBLE This message displays when the outside air temperature is cold enough to create icy road conditions Adjust your driving accordingly 209 LEFT DOOR
53. To help avoid injury to yourself or others have your vehicle serviced right away if the airbag readiness light stays on after you start your vehicle The airbag readiness light should flash for a few seconds when you turn the vehicle on If the light does not come on then have it fixed so it will be ready to warn you if there is a problem Passenger Airbag Status Indicator Your rearview mirror has a passenger airbag status indicator PASSENGER AIR BAG ogame ON United States Rb Ri Canada When the vehicle is started the passenger airbag status indicator will light ON and OFF or the symbol for on and off for several seconds as a system check Then after several more seconds the status indicator will light either ON or OFF or either the on or off symbol to let you know the status of the passenger s frontal airbag and side impact airbag Your vehicle has a label on the sun visor that says Never put a rear facing child seat in the front This is because the risk to the rear facing child is so great if the airbag deploys 189 Never put a child in a rear facing child restraint in the passenger s seat unless the passenger airbag status indicator shows off and the airbags are off Here is why A CAUTION Even though the passenger sensing system is designed to turn off the passenger s frontal airbag and side impact airbag if equipped if the system detects a rear facing child restrai
54. Vy ay K p 4 Ebb EQ The lap part of the belt should be worn low and snug on the hips just touching the thighs In a crash this applies force to the strong pelvic bones And you would be less likely to slide under the lap belt If you slid under it the belt would apply force at your abdomen This could cause serious or even fatal injuries The shoulder belt should go over the shoulder and across the chest These parts of the body are best able to take belt restraining forces The safety belt locks if there is a sudden stop or crash Q What is wrong with this A CAUTION You can be seriously hurt if your shoulder belt is too loose In a crash you would move forward too much which could increase injury The shoulder belt should fit against your body 4 45 Ms OS f LONE A The shoulder belt is too loose It will not give nearly as much protection this way 21 Q What is wrong with this A The lap belt is too loose It will not give nearly as much protection this way 22 A CAUTION You can be seriously hurt if your lap belt is too loose In a crash you could slide under the lap belt and apply force at your abdomen This could cause serious or even fatal injuries The lap belt should be worn low and snug on the hips just touching the thighs Q What is wrong with
55. Warning Flashers cenena 140 Instrument Panel Brightness 0 170 Other Warning Devices 06 eeeee 140 Courtesy LAMPS osiris ieas 170 FLOM i AEE ap ax dove eat E E T A 140 Entry Exit Lighting 0000ccc eeeeeeeeeeteeeeeees 170 Power Tilt Wheel and Telescopic Reading LAMPS wes c iesnctccds cece eeretteesevesincerere 171 Steering Column ccceeeeeeeeeeeteeeeeeeeees 141 Battery Run Down Protection 0 171 Turn Signal Multifunction Lever 0 141 Head Up Display HUD eee 171 Turn and Lane Change Signals 142 Ultrasonic Rear Parking Headlamp High Low Beam Changer 143 Assist URPA aonane sonnis daade 175 Flash to PaSS seniciscnnarccrsa erori 143 Accessory Power Outlet s e e 177 Windshield Wipers ssec 144 Ashtray s and Cigarette Lighter 178 Rainsense WIPES 2 0 145 Climate Controls ccecceeeeseeereee 178 Windshield Washer c c cc0cc ivencecssncenssviiee 146 Dual Climate Control System ccccceseee 178 Headlamp Washer cceceteeeeeees 146 Outlet Adjustment cccccececeseeesseeeeees 184 Cruise Control PIEI E E E T 147 Passenger Compartment Air Filter 184 Adaptive Cruise Control 0 c cceeeeeeeeeeees 150 Warning Lights Gages and Indicators 185 Exterior Lamps incsxdeeincsisescnostnceetnaveninencutats 164 inistr ment Panel Cluster 186 Wiper Activated Headlamps
56. a DVD is playing touch anywhere on the screen and the menu will appear DVO ci 0 00 04 IMAGE CURSOR SETTING SEARCH IMAGE Touch this button to either start playing a DVD or to remove the DVD menu screen AUDIO PROGRAM Touch this button to change the audio language heard VIEWING ANGLE Touch this button to adjust the viewing angle of the DVD Some DVDs allow you to change the camera angle This may not be available on all DVDs Depending on the type of DVD you are using this button may or may not be available SUBTITLE Touch this button to playback the video with subtitles This may not be available on all DVDs Depending on the type of DVD you are using this button may or may not be available SCREEN ADJUST Touch this button to adjust the brightness contrast and red green color adjustments CURSOR Touch this button to access the left right and up down cursors on the screen The cursors allow you to navigate menu options on the screen MENU Touch this button to access the DVDs menu options Depending on the type of DVD you are using this button may or may not be available Touch the button labeled one two or blank to change the image size displayed on the screen 309 TITLE Touch this button to display the title of the DVD Depending on the type of DVD you are using this button may or may not be available Dvo t c 00 00 00 PEET START MOVIE IAIN MENU END CREDITS ET En
57. a second time or turn on the headlamps to turn off the HEADLAMPS SUGGESTED message in the DIC If the parking lamps or the fog lamps were turned on instead the HEADLAMPS SUGGESTED message continues to display As with any vehicle you should turn on the regular headlamp system when needed Adaptive Forward Lighting System The Adaptive Forward Lighting System AFS swivels the headlamps horizontally to provide greater road illumination while turning AFS will operate when the vehicle speed is greater than 2 mph 3 km h AFS will not operate when the transmission is in REVERSE R AFS is not immediately operable after starting the vehicle driving a short distance is required to calibrate the AFS To enable AFS set the exterior lamp switch on the multifunction lever to the AUTO position Moving the switch out of the AUTO position will deactivate the system See Exterior Lamps on page 164 167 Fog Lamps Use fog lamps for better vision in foggy or misty conditions The fog lamps control is located on the multifunction lever next to the exterior lamp control 40 Fog Lamps Turning the band to this position will turn the fog lamps on When you turn the fog lamps on the fog lamp light will appear on the instrument panel cluster to indicate that the fog lamps and the parking lamps are on If you turn the high beam headlamps on the fog lamps will turn off They will turn on again when you switch to low beam headlam
58. acen 476 R n Flat TES sscscsssacasdtceseasteyenctasorcusasncneenses 420 Running the Engine While Parked 103 Safety Belt Prel NSIONGls reingna 27 Reminder Light eeesseeeeeeeeeeeeereneee 187 Safety Belts Gare Of 2 ba uicvas savy ates staincstadeSu sea tsisedeasisnenai 445 Driver POSITION essesnvsecesanucenseancendonase uieus 18 How to Wear Safety Belts Properly 18 Passenger Position cceseeeeeeeeeeeees 27 Questions and Answers About Safety Bels sees ees EA EAE Sa 17 Safety Belt Extender eee 27 Safety Belt Use During Pregnancy 26 Safety Belts Are for Everyone 0068 13 Safety Warnings and Symbols 000008 4 Scheduled Maintenance cceeereeee 465 Seats Heated and Cooled Seats ceeeeees 9 Memory Mirrors cccceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeneees 10 Power Lumbar 0 0cceceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaeees 9 Power Reclining Seatbacks ee 11 Power Seals cccccceccececceeeaeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaeeeees 8 Securing a Child Restraint Passenger Seat Position ceeeeeeeeees 40 Security Light oz ccasensseeseteessatainesscei tnei 201 509 SONICO oei ona ea aaan 363 Accessories and Modifications 363 Adding Equipment to the Outside of Your E E S E T 365 California Proposition 65 Warning 364 Doing Your Own Work 0 ceeeeeeeeeeee
59. acid on aluminum or chrome plated wheels you could damage the surface of the wheel s The repairs would not be covered by your warranty Use only GM approved cleaners on aluminum or chrome plated wheels The surface of these wheels is similar to the painted surface of your vehicle Do not use strong soaps chemicals abrasive polishes abrasive cleaners cleaners with acid or abrasive cleaning brushes on them because you could damage the surface Do not use chrome polish on aluminum wheels 448 Notice Using chrome polish on aluminum wheels could damage the wheels The repairs would not be covered by your warranty Use chrome polish on chrome wheels only Use chrome polish only on chrome plated wheels but avoid any painted surface of the wheel and buff off immediately after application Notice If you drive your vehicle through an automatic car wash that has silicone carbide tire cleaning brushes you could damage the aluminum or chrome plated wheels The repairs would not be covered by your warranty Never drive a vehicle equipped with aluminum or chrome plated wheels through an automatic car wash that uses silicone carbide tire cleaning brushes Do not take your vehicle through an automatic car wash that has silicone carbide tire cleaning brushes These brushes can also damage the surface of these wheels Tires To clean the tires use a stiff brush with tire cleaner Notice Using petroleum based tire dressin
60. adults the passenger sensing system may or may not turn off the passenger s frontal airbag and side impact airbag depending upon the person s seating posture and body build Everyone in your vehicle who has outgrown child restraints should wear a safety belt properly whether or not there is an airbag for that person If a person of adult size is sitting in the passenger s seat but the off indicator is lit it could be because that person is not sitting properly in the seat If this happens turn the vehicle off and ask the person to place the seatback in the fully upright position then sit upright in the seat centered on the seat cushion with the person s legs comfortably extended 56 Restart the vehicle and have the person remain in this position for about two minutes This will allow the system to detect that person and then enable the passenger s frontal airbag and side impact airbag Aftermarket equipment such as seat covers can affect how well the passenger sensing system A CAUTION operates You may want to consider not using seat covers or other aftermarket equipment if your If the airbag readiness light in the vehicle has the passenger sensing system See instrument panel cluster ever comes on Adding Equipment to Your Airbag Equipped and stays on it means that something Vehicle on page 59 for more information about may be wrong with the airbag system If modifications that can affect how the system
61. air is directed to the upper outlets and warmer air to the floor outlets tp Floor This mode directs most of the air to the floor outlets with some air directed to the side window outlets and some of the air directed to the windshield The mode switch can also be used to select the defog mode Information on defogging and defrosting can be found later in this section A C OFF Air Conditioning Press this button to turn off the air conditioning compressor Press AUTO to return to automatic operation The compressor cannot be turned off in either the defrost or floor defog mode Heated Cooled Seat Press this button to turn the feature on The button on the left controls the drivers seat and the button on the right controls the passenger s seat Each press of the button will take you to a different setting The settings available in order are HI HEAT LO HEAT OFF HI COOL LO COOL and OFF You will be able to feel the temperature change in a few minutes The feature will automatically turn off when the vehicle is turned off lt gt Recirculation Press this button to turn the recirculation mode on or off The air conditioning compressor also comes on This mode keeps outside air from coming in the vehicle It can be used to prevent outside air and odors from entering your vehicle or to help cool the air inside your vehicle more quickly Recirculation is not available in defrost or floor defog modes Using re
62. and displays A CAUTION Special tools and procedures are required to service a run flat tire If these special tools and procedures are not used you or others could be injured and your vehicle could be damaged Always be sure the proper tools and procedures as described in the service manual are used Notice Using liquid sealants can damage the tire valves and tire pressure monitor sensors in your vehicle s run flat tires This damage would not be covered by warranty Do not use liquid sealants in your vehicle s run flat tires To order a service manual see Service Publications Ordering Information on page 497 If a tire goes flat the stability control system will turn on automatically even if it was disabled by the driver When a flat tire condition exists the StabiliTrak system cannot be turned off See StabiliTrak System on page 331 Appearance Care Cleaning the Inside of Your Vehicle Your vehicle s interior will continue to look its best if it is cleaned often Although not always visible dust and dirt can accumulate on your upholstery Dirt can damage carpet fabric leather and plastic surfaces Regular vacuuming is recommended to remove particles from your upholstery It is important to keep your upholstery from becoming and remaining heavily soiled Soils should be removed as quickly as possible Your vehicle s interior may experience extremes of heat that could cause stains to set rapidly
63. and luggage load capacity For example if the XXX amount equals 1400 Ibs and there will be five 150 Ib passengers in your vehicle the amount of available cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 Ibs 1400 750 5 x 150 650 Ibs 5 Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on the vehicle That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in Example 1 Step 4 6 If your vehicle will be towing a trailer the load Item Description Tota from your trailer will be transferred to your i i Vehicle Capacity Weight 400 Ibs 181 k vehicle Consult this manual to determine how Za for Example 1 9 this reduces the available cargo and luggage Subtract Occupant load capacity of your vehicle 68 bo 150 Ibs 150 Ibs 68 kg 68 kg x 1 Your vehicle is neither designed nor intended Available Occupant and to tow a trailer ne Cargo Weight 250 Ibs 113 kg 356 Example 2 Item Description Total A Vehicle Capacity Weight a for Example 2 400 Ibs 181 kg Subtract Occupant 300 Ibs 136 kg Weight 150 Ibs 68 kg x 2 Available Cargo 100 los a5 ko Example 3 Item Description _ Tota Vehicle Capacity Weight for Example 3 400 Ibs 181 kg Subtract Occupant Weight 200 Ibs 400 Ibs 181 kg Available Cargo Weight ia id 91 kg x2 Refer to your vehicle s Tire and Loading Information label fo
64. and take appropriate action Winter Driving SS Here are some tips for winter driving e Have your vehicle in good shape for winter e You may want to put winter emergency supplies in your vehicle Also see Tires on page 413 Include an ice scraper a small brush or broom a supply of windshield washer fluid a rag some winter outer clothing a small shovel a flashlight a red cloth and a couple of reflective warning triangles And if you will be driving under severe conditions include a small bag of sand a piece of old carpet or a couple of burlap bags to help provide traction Be sure you properly secure these items in your vehicle 349 Driving On Snow or Ice Most of the time those places where the tires meet the road probably have good traction However if there is snow or ice between the tires and the road you can have a very slippery situation You will have a lot less traction or grip and will need to be very careful 350 What is the worst time for this Wet ice Very cold snow or ice can be slick and hard to drive on But wet ice can be even more trouble because it may offer the least traction of all You can get wet ice when it is about freezing 32 F 0 C and freezing rain begins to fall Try to avoid driving on wet ice until salt and sand crews can get there Whatever the condition smooth ice packed blowing or loose snow drive with caution Traction control impro
65. available for up to a maximum of five days In addition should you arrange transportation through a friend or relative reimbursement for reasonable fuel expenses may be available up to a five day maximum Claim amounts should reflect actual costs and be supported by original receipts 489 Courtesy Rental Vehicle Your dealer may arrange to provide you with a courtesy rental vehicle or reimburse you for a rental vehicle that you obtain if your vehicle is kept for a warranty repair Reimbursement will be limited to a maximum amount per day and must be supported by receipts This requires that you sign and complete a rental agreement and meet state local and rental vehicle provider requirements Requirements vary and may include minimum age requirements insurance coverage credit card etc You are responsible for fuel usage charges and may also be responsible for taxes levies usage fees excessive mileage or rental usage beyond the completion of the repair Generally it is not possible to provide a like vehicle as a courtesy rental Additional Program Information Courtesy Transportation is available during the Bumper to Bumper warranty coverage period but it is not part of the New Vehicle Limited Warranty A separate booklet entitled Warranty and Owner Assistance Information furnished with each new vehicle provides detailed warranty coverage information 490 Courtesy Transportation is available only at participating
66. available for There are no channels available for the category you the chosen category selected Your system is working properly No Information No Text Informational No text or informational messages are available at this time message available on this channel Your system is working properly XM Theftlocked Theft lock active The XM receiver in your vehicle may have previously been in another vehicle For security purposes XM receivers cannot be swapped between vehicles If you receive this message after having your vehicle serviced check with the servicing facility XM Radio ID Radio ID label channel 0 If you tune to channel 0 you will see this message alternating with your XM Radio 8 digit radio ID label This label is needed to activate your service Unknown Radio ID not known If you receive this message when you tune to channel 0 should only be if you may have a receiver fault Consult with your dealer re failure Check XM Receivr Hardware failure If this message does not clear within a short period of time your receiver may have a fault Consult with your retail location 301 Six Disc CD Changer With the compact disc changer you can play up to six normal size discs continuously When the radio is turned on the changer will begin checking for discs This will continue for up to one and a half minutes depending on the number of discs loaded You may hear noise but this is normal The CD changer is initializin
67. battery to restart the vehicle and possibly for signaling later on with your headlamps Let the heater run for a while Then shut the engine off and close the window almost all the way to preserve the heat Start the engine again and repeat this only when you feel really uncomfortable from the cold But do it as little as possible Preserve the fuel as long as you can To help keep warm you can get out of the vehicle and do some fairly vigorous exercises every half hour or so until help comes If Your Vehicle is Stuck in Sand Mud Ice or Snow In order to free your vehicle when it is stuck you will need to spin the wheels but you do not want to spin your wheels too fast The method known as rocking can help you get out when you are stuck but you must use caution A CAUTION If you let your vehicle s tires spin at high speed they can explode and you or others could be injured And the transmission or other parts of the vehicle can overheat That could cause an engine compartment fire or other damage When you are stuck spin the wheels as little as possible Do not spin the wheels above 35 mph 55 km h as shown on the speedometer Notice Spinning the wheels can destroy parts of your vehicle as well as the tires If you spin the wheels too fast while shifting the transmission back and forth you can destroy the transmission For information about using tire chains on your vehicle see Tire Chains on page 4
68. by other than an authorized service facility could void authorization to use this equipment 67 If you ever notice a decrease in the keyless access transmitter range try doing one of the following e Check the distance You may be too far from your vehicle You may need to stand closer during rainy or snowy weather e Check the location Other vehicles or objects may be blocking the signal Take a few steps to the left or right hold the transmitter higher and try again e Check to determine if battery replacement is necessary See Battery Replacement under Keyless Access System Operation on page 68 e Check to make sure that an electronic device such as a cellular phone or lap top computer is not causing interference e If you are still having trouble see your dealer or a qualified technician for service 68 Keyless Access System Operation Your vehicle has a Keyless Access System that allows you to lock and unlock your doors unlock your trunk lid and disarm or arm your theft deterrent system The range distance is as much as 100 feet 30 m away Your vehicle comes with two transmitters and up to four can be matched to your vehicle See Matching Transmitter s to Your Vehicle later in this section Lock Press this button to lock the doors The indicator light on the door will flash once If this button is pressed twice the doors will lock the light will flash once and the hor
69. cautions If you do not you or others could be hurt You will also find a circle with a slash through it in this book This safety symbol means Do Not Do Not do this or Do Not let this happen Vehicle Damage Warnings Also in this manual you will find these notices Notice These mean there is something that could damage your vehicle A notice tells about something that can damage the vehicle Many times this damage would not be covered by your vehicle s warranty and it could be costly But the notice will tell what to do to help avoid the damage When you read other manuals you might see CAUTION and NOTICE warnings in different colors or in different words There are also warning labels on the vehicle They use the same words CAUTION or NOTICE Vehicle Symbols The vehicle has components and labels that use symbols instead of text Symbols are shown along with the text describing the operation or information relating to a specific component control message gage or indicator If you need help figuring out a specific name of a component gage or indicator reference the following topics e Seats and Restraint Systems in Section 1 e Features and Controls in Section 2 e Instrument Panel Overview in Section 3 e Climate Controls in Section 3 e Warning Lights Gages and Indicators in Section 3 e Audio System s in Section 3 e Engine Compartment Overview in Section 5 These are some ex
70. dealer If the SERVICE ABS message is being displayed the Traction Control System TCS and StabiliTrak System will also be disabled The Driver Information Center will scroll three messages SERVICE ABS SERVICE TRACTION SYS and SERVICE STABILITRAK and the anti lock brake system and traction control warning lights on the instrument panel cluster will be 214 illuminated See Anti Lock Brake System Warning Light on page 193 and Traction Control System TCS Warning Light on page 194 The driver can acknowledge these messages by pressing the RESET button three times When the service message is displayed the computer controlled systems will not assist the driver and you should have the system repaired by your dealer as soon as possible Adjust your driving accordingly SERVICE AFS Adaptive Forward Lighting System LAMPS This message displays when the Adaptive Forward Lighting System AFS is disabled and needs service See your dealer See Adaptive Forward Lighting System on page 167 for more information SERVICE ELECT Electrical SYSTEM This message displays if an electrical problem has occurred within the Powertrain Control Module PCM Have your vehicle serviced by your dealer SERVICE FUEL SYSTEM This message displays when the Powertrain Control Module PCM has detected a problem within the fuel system Have your vehicle serviced by your dealer This message will also be displayed when the cluster is not getti
71. dealer or a private collision repair facility to fix the damage make sure you are comfortable with them Remember you will have to feel comfortable with their work for a long time e Once you have an estimate read it carefully and make sure you understand what work will be performed on your vehicle If you have a question ask for an explanation Reputable shops welcome this opportunity Managing the Vehicle Damage Repair Process In the event that your vehicle requires damage repairs GM recommends that you take an active role in its repair If you have a pre determined repair facility of choice take your vehicle there or have it towed there Specify to the facility that any required replacement collision parts be original equipment parts either new Genuine GM parts or recycled original GM parts Remember recycled parts will not be covered by your GM vehicle warranty Insurance pays the bill for the repair but you must live with the repair Depending on your policy limits your insurance company may initially value the repair using aftermarket parts Discuss this with your repair professional and insist on Genuine GM parts Remember if your vehicle is leased you may be obligated to have the vehicle repaired with Genuine GM parts even if your insurance coverage does not pay the full cost If another party s insurance company is paying for the repairs you are not obligated to accept a repair valuation based on that insur
72. display if any of the navigation hard keys are pressed This feature will not operate unless the vehicle is in PARK P 307 To remove the navigation map DVD and load a video DVD use the following steps 1 With the vehicle in PARK P and the vehicle running press the TILT hard key until a beep is heard The faceplate of the system will open Ifa map DVD or a music CD is loaded the system will automatically eject it Gently remove it from the slot and return it to its case Load the video DVD into the slot The system will pull the DVD into the player Press and release the TILT hard key to close the faceplate Notice Shifting out of PARK P with the system s faceplate open will cause the faceplate to close automatically This could cause damage to a CD DVD or the system if it is partially loaded Before shifting out of PARK P make sure that the DVD or CD is loaded properly The vehicle must be shifted back into PARK P to close the faceplate Once the faceplate is closed and a video DVD is loaded the system will automatically play the DVD 308 Playing a DVD There are three ways to play a DVD depending on which screen you are on They are the following e Once a DVD is inserted the system will automatically play the DVD e f you are on a map screen touch the DVD source button e From the audio screen press the DVD hard key DVD Menu Options To display the menu choices while
73. during warranty repairs Scheduling Service Appointments When your vehicle requires warranty service you should contact your dealer and request an appointment By scheduling a service appointment and advising your service consultant of your transportation needs your dealer can help minimize your inconvenience If your vehicle cannot be scheduled into the service department immediately keep driving it until it can be scheduled for service unless of course the problem is safety related If it is please call your dealership let them know this and ask for instructions If the dealer requests that you simply drop the vehicle off for service you are urged to do so as early in the work day as possible to allow for the same day repair Transportation Options Warranty service can generally be completed while you wait However if you are unable to wait GM helps to minimize your inconvenience by providing several transportation options Depending on the circumstances your dealer can offer you one of the following Shuttle Service Participating dealers can provide you with shuttle service to get you to your destination with minimal interruption of your daily schedule This includes one way or round trip shuttle service to a destination up to 10 miles 16 km from the dealership Public Transportation or Fuel Reimbursement If your vehicle requires warranty repairs reimbursement of public transportation expenses may be
74. e RideAssist e Information and Convenience Services OnStar Hands Free Calling OnStar Hands Free Calling allows eligible OnStar subscribers to make and receive calls using voice commands Hands Free Calling is fully integrated into the vehicle and can be used with OnStar Pre Paid Minute Packages Hands Free Calling may also be linked to a Verizon Wireless service plan in the U S or a Bell Mobility service plan in Canada depending on eligibility To find out more refer to the OnStar Owners Guide in the vehicle s glove box visit www onstar com or www onstar ca or speak with an OnStar advisor by pressing the OnStar button or calling 1 888 4 ONSTAR 1 888 466 7827 OnStar Virtual Advisor OnStar Virtual Advisor is a feature of OnStar Hands Free Calling that uses your minutes to access location based weather local traffic reports and stock quotes By pressing the phone button and giving a few simple voice commands you can browse through the various topics See the OnStar Owners Guide for more information Only available in the continental U S OnStar Steering Wheel Controls Your vehicle may have a Talk Mute button that can be used to interact with OnStar Hands Free Calling See Audio Steering Wheel Controls on page 227 for more information On some vehicles you may have to hold the button for a few seconds and give the command ONSTAR in order to activate the OnStar Hands Free Calling f
75. each side of the divider into the notches A on either side of the trunk There is also a storage compartment located in the trunk on the passenger s side To access the storage compartment unsnap the lid To reinstall the lid line up the opening in the lid over the snap and push down into place Convenience Net Your vehicle is equipped with a convenience net The convenience net attaches to the floor of the trunk Put small loads like grocery bags behind the net The net is not for larger heavier loads Store them in the trunk as far forward as you can When not using the net hook the net to the tabs securing it to the sill plate 123 Retractable Hardtop The following procedures explain the proper operation of the retractable hardtop The retractable hardtop will not operate if the valet lockout switch is on If the retractable hardtop is lowered or raised multiple times the engine should be running while doing so to prevent drain on the vehicle s battery A CAUTION When the retractable hardtop is opened or closed people can be injured by the parts that move the hardtop and its mechanism the trunk lid and the side windows Keep people away from these parts when you are lowering or raising the top 124 Lowering the Retractable Hardtop Notice Leaving the retractable hardtop down and exposing the interior of your vehicle to outdoor conditions may cause damage Always close the retractab
76. edit 252 3 4 Touch PHONE and use the numeric keypad to edit or add the number Touch the RETURN button to take you back to the previous screen when you have finished Deleting Single Memory Points To delete a single memory point do the following iP Press the ROUTE key 2 Touch EDIT MEMORY POINT 3 4 5 Select the category of the memory point Touch DELETE Select the memory point you want to delete A confirmation window will appear Touch YES to delete the memory point or NO to return to the previous menu Touch Return to go back to the previous screen Deleting All Memory Points To delete all of the memory points in a category do the following 1 5 6 Press the ROUTE key 2 Touch EDIT MEMORY POINT 3 4 Touch the DELETE ALL screen button A Select the desired category confirmation window will appear Touch YES to delete the memory points or NO to return to the previous menu Touch Return to go back to the previous screen Edit Category To edit the name of a category do the following 1 2 3 Press the ROUTE key Touch EDIT MEMORY POINT Select the category you want to edit 4 Touch the EDIT CATEGORY screen button and use the alpha keypad to edit the category name The name can consist of up to 15 alpha and or numeric characters 5 Touch Return to go back to the previous screen Marked Point A marked point is a memory poi
77. ee 18 Driver Information Center DIC 00 203 DIC Controls and Displays ee 204 DIC Vehicle Personalization 08 220 DIC Warnings and Messages 008 206 Other Messages n e 219 Driving At Night 0cceceeeeeeee eee eeteeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaeea 339 City ccs cat aa eatrersecantanmeneaietendebaceacetdan ia 343 DGTONSIVE cccisnivesctaiehteented onchannirntensnedtenen tones 322 PPUTIKO MN drasiedi de Seat tivnnntiivendaatenedetacanns 323 FreGWay sorarsan dian EEE AaS 344 Hill and Mountain Roads s 347 In Rain and on Wet Roads i a 340 Rocking Your Vehicle to Get it Out 354 WINTER seirena ainsin a 349 Dual Climate Control System 0 008 178 DYD CD Player wiseiiiacssavsodessetiesasieaavecenaaetes 305 Edit Avoid Poin t Area ccc eeecceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees Memory Point Waypoint eccirni niare Electrical System Add On Equipment ceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeee Fuses and Circuit Breakers 08 Instrument Panel Fuse Block Power Windows and Other Power ODUOINS secs anoeia dean aia EERE Underhood Fuse Block 00 eeeeeeeeeees Windshield Wiper Fuses scce Engine Air Cleaner Filter 0cccccccseeeeeeeneeeeeeees Battery Check and Service Engine Soon Light Coola saree igtccespestaande sigesengeedarescgaderxexesagedas Coolant Temperature Gage Drive Belt Routing cceeeeeeeeeeeee eens Engine Compartment Overvie
78. fuel cap is located behind a hinged fuel door on the drivers side of the vehicle left side of the instrument panel The button only works when the vehicle is in PARK P or NEUTRAL N and the valet lockout button is in OFF pump never let children pump fuel 369 An alternate fuel door release is located inside the trunk behind a panel on the driver s side of the vehicle Pull the handle to release the fuel door To remove the fuel cap turn it slowly counterclockwise The fuel cap has a spring in it if the cap is released too soon it will spring back to the right While refueling hang the tethered fuel cap from the hook on the fuel door 370 A CAUTION If you spill fuel and then something ignites it you could be badly burned Fuel can spray out on you if you open the fuel cap too quickly This spray can happen if your tank is nearly full and is more likely in hot weather Open the fuel cap slowly and wait for any hiss noise to stop Then unscrew the cap all the way Be careful not to spill fuel Do not top off or overfill the tank and wait a few seconds after you have finished pumping before removing the nozzle Clean fuel from painted surfaces as soon as possible See Washing Your Vehicle on page 446 When replacing the fuel cap turn it clockwise until it clicks Make sure the cap is fully installed The diagnostic system can determine if the fuel cap has been left off or improperly
79. has straps that are attached to a wide shelf like shield that swings up or to the side A CAUTION A child can be seriously injured or killed in a crash if the child is not properly secured in the child restraint Make sure the child is properly secured following the instructions that came with that restraint Because there are different systems it is important to refer to the instructions that come with the restraint A child can be endangered in a crash if the child is not properly secured in the child restraint Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children LATCH Some child restraints have a LATCH system As part of the LATCH system your child restraint may have lower attachments and or a top tether The LATCH system can help hold the child restraint in place during driving or in a crash Some vehicles have lower and or top tether anchors designed to secure a child restraint with lower attachments and or a top tether Some child restraints with a top tether are designed to be used whether the top tether is anchored or not Other child restraints require that the top tether be anchored A national or local law may require that the top tether be anchored In Canada the law requires that forward facing child restraints have a top tether and that the tether be attached Your vehicle does not have lower anchors or top tether anchors to secure a child restraint with the LATCH system If a national or local law requires t
80. if the low beam headlamps are aimed properly The headlamp aiming device is under the hood near the headlamps Adjustment screws can be turned with an E8 Torx socket or T15 Torx screwdriver 409 Headlamp Vertical Aiming To properly prepare the vehicle for vertical headlamp aiming see Headlamp Aiming on page 408 for more information To adjust the vertical aim do the following Notice Horizontal aiming must be performed before making any adjustments to the vertical aim Adjusting the vertical aim first will result in an incorrect headlamp aim 1 Open the hood See Hood Release on page 373 for more information 2 Locate the aim dot on the inner projector lens of the low beam headlamp 3 Measure the distance from the ground to the aim dot on each low beam headlamp Record this distance 410 4 At the wall or other flat surface measure from the ground upward A to the recorded distance from Step 3 and mark it Notice Do not cover a headlamp to improve beam cut off when aiming Covering a headlamp may cause excessive heat build up which may cause damage to the headlamp 5 Draw or tape a horizontal line B on the wall or flat surface the width of the vehicle at the height of the mark in Step 4 6 Turn on the low beam headlamps and place a piece of cardboard in front of the headlamp not being aimed This should allow only the beam of light from the headlamp being aimed to be seen on the flat su
81. ignite them and possibly damage your vehicle Never put flammable items in the ashtray Loose objects such as paper clips can lodge behind and beneath the ashtray lid and prevent movement of the lid You should avoid putting small loose objects near the ashtray To use the cigarette lighter push it in all the way and let go When it is ready it will pop back out by itself Notice Holding a cigarette lighter in while it is heating will not allow the lighter to back away from the heating element when it is hot Damage from overheating may occur to the lighter or heating element or a fuse could be blown Do not hold a cigarette lighter in while it is heating 178 Climate Controls Dual Climate Control System With this system you can control the heating cooling and ventilation for the vehicle ana RR ake esc When your vehicle is first started the system will recall the last temperature fan and mode settings for that driver Automatic Operation AUTO Automatic When this button is pressed and the temperature is set the system will automatically control the inside temperature the air delivery mode the air conditioning compressor and the fan speed AUTO will appear on the display 1 Press the AUTO button 2 Adjust the temperature to a comfortable setting between 70 F 21 C and 80 F 27 C An initial setting of 73 F 23 C is suggested Choosing the warmest or coldest temperature setting will
82. in a crash 30 Infants and Young Children Everyone in a vehicle needs protection This includes infants and all other children Neither the distance traveled nor the age and size of the traveler changes the need for everyone to use safety restraints In fact the law in every state in the United States and in every Canadian province says children up to some age must be restrained while in a vehicle A CAUTION Children can be seriously injured or strangled if a shoulder belt is wrapped around their neck and the safety belt continues to tighten Never leave children unattended in a vehicle and never allow children to play with the safety belts Every time infants and young children ride in vehicles they should have the protection provided by appropriate restraints Young children should not use the vehicle s adult safety belts alone unless there is no other choice Instead they need to use a child restraint 31 A CAUTION People should never hold a baby in their arms while riding in a vehicle A baby does not weigh much until a crash During a crash a baby will become so heavy it is not possible to hold it For example in a crash at only 25 mph 40 km h a 12 Ib 5 5 kg baby will suddenly become a 240 Ib 110 kg force on a person s arms A baby should be secured in an appropriate restraint 32 Q What are the different types of add on A CAUTION child restraints A Add on child re
83. installed This would allow fuel to evaporate into the atmosphere See Malfunction Indicator Lamp on page 196 The CHECK GAS CAP message in the Driver Filling a Portable Fuel Container Information Center DIC will be displayed if A CAUTION the fuel cap is not properly installed A CAUTION Never fill a portable fuel container while it is in your vehicle Static electricity discharge from the container can ignite the gasoline vapor You can be badly burned and your vehicle damaged if this occurs To help avoid injury to you and others e Dispense gasoline only into approved If a fire starts while you are refueling do not remove the nozzle Shut off the flow of fuel by shutting off the pump or by notifying the station attendant Leave the area immediately containers Notice f you need a new fuel cap be sure to e Do not fill a container while it is inside a get the right type Your dealer can get one vehicle in a vehicle s trunk pickup for you If you get the wrong type it may not bed or on any surface other than the fit properly This may cause your malfunction ground indicator lamp to light and may damage your fuel tank and emissions system See Malfunction Indicator Lamp on page 196 Bring the fill nozzle in contact with the inside of the fill opening before operating the nozzle Contact should be maintained until the filling is complete e Do not smoke while pumping gasoline 371 Checking Thi
84. keep the proper engine temperature e Let the warning lights and gages work as they should Notice Using coolant other than DEX COOL may cause premature engine heater core or radiator corrosion In addition the engine coolant may require changing sooner at the first maintenance service after each 30 000 miles 50 000 km or 24 months whichever occurs first Any repairs would not be covered by your warranty Always use DEX COOL silicate free coolant in your vehicle 385 What to Use Use a mixture of one half clean drinkable water and one half DEX COOL coolant which will not damage aluminum parts If you use this coolant mixture you do not need to add anything else A CAUTION Adding only plain water to your cooling system can be dangerous Plain water or some other liquid such as alcohol can boil before the proper coolant mixture will Your vehicle s coolant warning system is set for the proper coolant mixture With plain water or the wrong mixture your engine could get too hot but you would not get the overheat warning Your engine could catch fire and you or others could be burned Use a 50 50 mixture of clean drinkable water and DEX COOL coolant 386 Notice If you use an improper coolant mixture your engine could overheat and be badly damaged The repair cost would not be covered by your warranty Too much water in the mixture can freeze and crack the engine radiator heater core an
85. killed if the right front passenger s airbag inflates This is because the back of the rear facing child restraint would be very close to the inflating airbag Be sure the airbag is off before using a rear facing child restraint in the passenger s position Even though the passenger sensing system is designed to turn off the passenger s frontal airbag and side impact airbag if equipped if the system detects a rear facing child restraint CAUTION Continued CAUTION Continued no system is fail safe and no one can guarantee that an airbag will not deploy under some unusual circumstance even though it is turned off We recommend that rear facing child restraints be transported in vehicles with a rear seat that will accommodate a rear facing child restraint whenever possible If you need to secure a forward facing child restraint in the passenger s position move the seat as far back as it will go before securing the forward facing child restraint See Power Seats on page 8 There is no top tether anchor at the passenger s seating position Do not secure a child seat in this position if a national or local law requires that the top tether be anchored or if the instructions that come with the child restraint say that the top tether must be anchored See Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children LATCH on page 39 You will be using the lap shoulder belt to secure the child restraint in this position Be sur
86. levels TPMS sensors are mounted onto each tire and wheel assembly on your vehicle The TPMS sensors monitor the air pressure in your vehicle s tires and transmit the tire pressure readings to a receiver located in the vehicle 423 When a low tire pressure condition is detected the TPMS illuminates the low tire pressure warning light located in the instrument panel cluster and at the same time the LOW TIRE PRESSURE warning message on the Driver Information Center DIC displays The low tire pressure warning light and the DIC warning message appear at each ignition cycle until the tires are inflated to the correct inflation pressure For additional information and details about the DIC operation and displays see DIC Controls and Displays on page 204 and DIC Warnings and Messages on page 206 You may notice during cooler weather conditions that the low tire pressure warning light and the LOW TIRE PRESSURE DIC warning message may come on when the vehicle is first started and then turn off as you start to drive This may be an early indicator that the air pressure in the tire s is getting low and needs to be inflated to the proper pressure Each tire including the spare if provided should be checked monthly when cold and inflated to the inflation pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label If your vehicle has tires of 424 a different size than the size i
87. lock occurs If you choose this setting the doors will automatically lock and the horn will chirp eight seconds after you turn the ignition off remove a keyless access transmitter from the interior of the vehicle and close both doors If you are parking in a quiet area and do not want the horn to sound when the doors lock press the lock button on the keyless access transmitter immediately after removing it from the interior and closing the doors This will lock the doors and cancel the passive locking for this ignition cycle The DIC will display PASSIVE LOCKING OFF SILENT PASSIVE LOCK or HORN AT PASSIVE LOCK Press the OPTIONS button to change the setting Passive Unlocking This feature allows you to select which doors will automatically unlock when you approach and open the driver s door with your keyless access transmitter You can choose to have the driver s door unlock or both doors unlock See Door Locks on page 73 for more information The DIC will display PASSIVE UNLK DRIVER or PASSIVE UNLK BOTH Press the OPTIONS button to change this setting 223 Auto Unlock This feature automatically unlocks either the driver s door or both doors depending on the setting when the shift lever is moved to PARK P The DIC will display AUTO UNLOCK OFF AUTO UNLOCK DRIVER or AUTO UNLOCK BOTH Press the OPTIONS button to change the setting Park Assist This feature tilts the passenger s side mirror downward
88. lower the front part of the seat cushion by moving the front of the horizontal control up or down Raise or lower the rear part of the seat cushion by moving the rear of the horizontal control up or down Raise or lower the entire seat by moving the entire horizontal control up or down Use the vertical control to recline the seatback See Power Reclining Seatbacks on page 11 Power Lumbar Use the power seat controls first to get the proper position then continue with the lumbar adjustment Use the top lumbar switch to adjust support to the middle seatback and the bottom lumbar switch to adjust support to the lower seatback Press the front of the switch to increase support and the rear of the switch to decrease support The drivers and passenger s seatback lumbar support switches are located on the outboard sides of the seats Keep in mind that as your seating position changes as it may during long trips so should the position of your lumbar support Adjust the seat as needed Heated and Cooled Seats The buttons for the heated and cooled seats are located on the climate control system t Heated Cooled Seat Press this button to turn the feature on The button on the left controls the drivers seat and the button on the right controls the passenger s seat Each press of the button will take you to a different setting The settings available in order are HI HEAT LO HEAT OFF HI COOL LO COOL and OFF You wi
89. may interfere with your keyless access transmitter 212 If moving the transmitter to different locations within the vehicle does not help place the transmitter in the glove box transmitter pocket with the buttons facing to the right and then press the START button The vehicle s battery voltage is low The battery voltage must be above 10 volts for the keyless access transmitter to be detected properly NO FOB OFF OR RUN This message displays when a keyless access transmitter is not detected inside the vehicle while you are trying to turn the ignition off Your vehicle may be near a strong radio antenna signal causing the keyless access system to be jammed The vehicle will remain in Acc until off or START has been pressed or five minutes has expired If you turn the ignition off and you cannot find the keyless access transmitter you will not be able to restart the vehicle The keyless access transmitter needs to be inside of the vehicle in order for the vehicle to start See Starting the Engine on page 89 for more information OVER SPEED WARNING This message displays when the vehicle speed exceeds a certain limit as required by some export countries A chime sounds when this message is displayed PRESS BRAKE TO START This message displays to inform you that the brake pedal must be applied to start the vehicle Make sure you are pressing the brake pedal all the way down REDUCED ENGINE POWER This message
90. mph 40 km h Cruise control will not work if the parking brake is set or if the master cylinder brake fluid level is low A CAUTION Cruise control can be dangerous where you cannot drive safely at a steady speed So do not use your cruise control on winding roads or in heavy traffic Cruise control can be dangerous on slippery roads On such roads fast changes in tire traction can cause excessive wheel slip and you could lose control Do not use cruise control on slippery roads If your vehicle has the traction control system and it begins to limit wheel spin while cruise control is on the cruise control will automatically disengage See Traction Control System TCS on page 329 When road conditions allow you to safely use it again you may turn cruise control back on 147 Setting Cruise Control A CAUTION If you leave your cruise control on when you are not using cruise you might hit a button and go into cruise when you do not want to You could be startled and even lose control Keep the cruise control switch off until you want to use cruise control 1 Move the cruise control switch to on 2 Get up to the speed desired 3 Press the set button at the end of the lever and release it 4 Take your foot off the accelerator pedal 148 The cruise symbol on y the instrument panel cluster will be lit when the cruise control is engaged Resuming a Set Speed Suppose you set your cruis
91. needed or every 36 months whichever occurs first See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 473 Owner Checks and Services These owner checks and services should be performed at the intervals specified to help ensure the safety dependability and emission control performance of your vehicle Your GM Goodwrench dealer can assist you with these checks and services 470 Be sure any necessary repairs are completed at once Whenever any fluids or lubricants are added to your vehicle make sure they are the proper ones as shown in Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 473 At Each Fuel Fill It is important to perform these underhood checks at each fuel fill Engine Oil Level Check Check the engine oil level and add the proper oil if necessary See Engine Oil on page 377 for further details Notice It is important to check your oil regularly and keep it at the proper level Failure to keep your engine oil at the proper level can cause damage to your engine not covered by your warranty Engine Coolant Level Check Check the engine coolant level and add DEX COOL coolant mixture if necessary See Engine Coolant on page 385 for further details Intercooler Coolant Level Check 4 4L Supercharged Engine Check the coolant level and add DEX COOL coolant mixture if necessary See Engine Coolant on page 385 for further details Windshield Washer Fluid Level Check Check the windshield washer fluid level i
92. on when the system is operating See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 206 for more information You may also feel or hear the system working This is normal The instrument panel cluster light will come on and a chime will sound to let you know if there is a problem with the system The SERVICE STABILITRAK message will also be displayed See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 206 for more information When this light and the SERVICE STABILITRAK message are on the system is not operational Adjust your driving accordingly The system comes on automatically whenever you start your vehicle To help maintain directional control of the vehicle you should always leave the system on You can turn the system off if you 332 ever need to If you turn the StabiliTrak system off the Traction Control System will also be turned off Adjust your driving accordingly To turn the system off press and hold the front part of the traction control button on the console for five seconds with the vehicle stopped TC You can turn the system back on at any time by pressing the button The DIC will display the appropriate message when you push the button either TRAC STABILITRAK ON or TRAC STABILITRAK OFF Steering Power Steering If you lose power steering assist because the engine stops or the system is not functioning you can steer but it will take much more effort Magnetic Speed Variable Assist Steering Your vehicle
93. on a run flat tire check with an authorized run flat tire service center to determine whether the tire can be repaired or should be replaced To maintain your vehicle s run flat feature all replacement tires must be self supporting tires As soon as possible contact the nearest authorized GM or run flat servicing facility for inspection and repair or replacement To locate the nearest GM or run flat servicing facility call Roadside Assistance For phone numbers and Roadside Service details see Roadside Service on page 487 A CAUTION Run flat tires are constructed differently than other tires and could explode during improper service You or others could be injured or killed if you attempt to repair replace dismount or mount a run flat tire Let only an authorized run flat service center repair replace dismount and mount run flat tires The valve stems on your run flat tires have sensors that are part of the Tire Pressure Monitor System TPMS See Tire Pressure Monitor System on page 423 These sensors contain batteries which are designed to last for 10 years under normal driving conditions See your dealer if you ever need to have a wheel replaced or if the sensors ever need replacement Notice Using liquid sealants can damage the tire valves and tire pressure monitor sensors in your vehicle s run flat tires This damage would not be covered by warranty Do not use liquid sealants in your vehicle s run flat
94. opener e Middle button middle switch position To program another device such as an additional 115 Programming Universal Home Remote Rolling Code Rolling code garage door openers are used for garage doors produced after 1996 and are code protected Rolling code means the coded signal is changed every time your remote control garage door opener is used Programming a rolling code garage door opener involves time sensitive actions so read the entire procedure before you begin If you do not follow these actions the device will time out and you will have to repeat the procedure Follow these steps to program up to three channels 1 Press the two outside buttons at the same time for one to two seconds and immediately release them 116 Go to the garage Locate the garage door motor head and press and release the learn button After pressing the learn button you have 10 to 30 seconds to complete Step 4 depending on your garage control unit If you cannot locate the learn button refer to the owners guide for your garage door opener 3 Press and hold the button you would like to use to control the garage door until the garage door moves The indicator light above the selected button should slowly blink You may need to hold the button from five to 20 seconds 4 Immediately release the button when the garage door moves The indicator light will blink rapidly
95. other parts Use the recommended coolant and the proper coolant mixture A CAUTION You can be burned if you spill coolant on Adding only plain water to your cooling system can be dangerous Plain water or some other liquid such as alcohol can boil before the proper coolant mixture will Your vehicle s coolant warning system is set for the proper coolant mixture With plain water or the wrong mixture your engine could get too hot but you would not get the overheat warning Your engine could catch fire and you or others could be burned Use a 50 50 mixture of clean drinkable water and DEX COOL coolant hot engine parts Coolant contains ethylene glycol and it will burn if the engine parts are hot enough Do not spill coolant on a hot engine 394 1 You can remove the coolant surge tank pressure cap when the cooling system including the coolant surge tank pressure cap and upper radiator hose is no longer hot Turn the pressure cap slowly counterclockwise If you hear a hiss wait for that to stop A hiss means there is still some pressure left 2 Then keep turning the cap and remove it Fill the coolant surge tank with the proper mixture until the level inside the surge tank stabilizes at the FULL COLD mark on the front of the surge tank 395 4 With the coolant surge tank pressure cap off start the engine and let it run until you can feel the upper radiator hose getting hot Watch out for t
96. out of PARK P make sure that the DVD or CD is loaded properly The vehicle must be shifted back into PARK P to close the faceplate Setting the Search Area To determine or change the system s search area do the following 1 Press the ROUTE key 2 Touch the Enter Destination screen button 3 Touch Change under the Search Search Area Area heading The system will display a map with each region represented Select the desired region by touching the appropriate screen button to the left of the U S map The name of the states or the country included in the selected region will be displayed at the bottom of the screen and the region will be highlighted Touch Enter to set the region as the search area Touch Return to go back to the previous screen 273 Map Adjustments The system allows you to adjust the scale of view on the map The map will scroll automatically based on the direction you are traveling Map Scales To view a larger or smaller scale of the map touch the lt gt map scale arrows 1321416 he 14 12 1 2 4 8 163264128 ETE rE E You may also adjust the scale of the map by touching the scale on the bar The scale of a map can range from 1 32 of a mile 0 05 km to 128 miles 256 km 274 Scrolling the Map Touch anywhere on the map screen twice to display the scroll symbol Place your finger on the map screen in any direction ou
97. page 77 for more information on the key cylinder 4 Open the trunk 69 70 Turn the key five times within five seconds The Driver Information Center DIC will display READY FOR FOB X X can be 2 3 or 4 Place the new unrecognized transmitter in the glove box transmitter pocket with the buttons facing to the right Once the transmitter is programmed a beep will sound The DIC will display READY FOR X where X can be 3 or 4 or MAX FOBS LEARNED Press the Acc button The Canadian immobilizer standard requires Canadian owners to see their GM dealer for matching new transmitters when a recognized transmitter is not available United States owners are permitted to match a new transmitter to their vehicle when a recognized transmitter is not available The procedure will require three ten minute cycles to complete the matching process Do the following 1 The vehicle must be off 2 Place the new unrecognized transmitter in the glove box transmitter pocket with the buttons facing to the right 10 11 12 Go to the rear of the vehicle and insert the vehicle key into the key cylinder located on the lower rear fascia on the driver s side of the vehicle See Trunk on page 77 for more information on the key cylinder Open the trunk Turn the key five times within five seconds The DIC message will display OFF ACC TO LEARN Press the Acc button The DIC will
98. passenger s side The driver s frontal airbag is in the middle of the steering wheel 47 The driver s side impact airbag is in the side of the The passenger s side impact airbag is in the side of driver s seatback closest to the door the passenger s seatback closest to the door 48 A CAUTION If something is between an occupant and an airbag the airbag might not inflate properly or it might force the object into that person causing severe injury or even death The path of an inflating airbag must be kept clear Do not put anything between an occupant and an airbag and do not attach or put anything on the steering wheel hub or on or near any other airbag covering Do not let seat covers block the inflation path of a side impact airbag When Should an Airbag Inflate The driver s and right front passenger s frontal airbags are designed to inflate in moderate to severe frontal or near frontal crashes But they are designed to inflate only if the impact exceeds a predetermined deployment threshold Deployment thresholds take into account a variety of desired deployment and non deployment events and are used to predict how severe a crash is likely to be in time for the airbags to inflate and help restrain the occupants Whether your frontal airbags will or should deploy is not based on how fast your vehicle is traveling It depends largely on what you hit the direction of the impact and how quickly yo
99. road to do what the driver has asked In any emergency do not give up Keep trying to steer and constantly seek an escape route or area of less danger Skidding In a skid a driver can lose control of the vehicle Defensive drivers avoid most skids by taking reasonable care suited to existing conditions and by not overdriving those conditions But skids are always possible The three types of skids correspond to your vehicle s three control systems In the braking skid your wheels are not rolling In the steering or cornering skid too much speed or steering in a curve causes tires to slip and lose cornering force And in the acceleration skid too much throttle causes the driving wheels to spin A cornering skid is best handled by easing your foot off the accelerator pedal Remember Any traction control system helps avoid only the acceleration skid If your traction control system is off then an acceleration skid is also best handled by easing your foot off the accelerator pedal 337 If your vehicle starts to slide ease your foot off the accelerator pedal and quickly steer the way you want the vehicle to go If you start steering quickly enough your vehicle may straighten out Always be ready for a second skid if it occurs Of course traction is reduced when water snow ice gravel or other material is on the road For safety you will want to slow down and adjust your driving to these conditions It is im
100. speed according to your speedometer not to your sense of motion After driving for any distance at higher speeds you may tend to think you are going slower than you actually are Before Leaving on a Long Trip Make sure you are ready Try to be well rested If you must start when you are not fresh such as after a day s work do not plan to make too many miles that first part of the journey Wear comfortable clothing and shoes you can easily drive in Is your vehicle ready for a long trip If you keep it serviced and maintained it is ready to go If it needs service have it done before starting out Of course you will find experienced and able service experts in GM dealerships all across North America They will be ready and willing to help if you need it Here are some things you can check before a trip e Windshield Washer Fluid s the reservoir full Are all windows clean inside and outside e Wiper Blades Are they in good shape e Fuel Engine Oil Other Fluids Have you checked all levels e Lamps Are they all working Are the lenses clean 345 e Tires They are vitally important to a safe you sleepy Do not let it happen to you If it does trouble free trip Is the tread good enough your vehicle can leave the road in less than a for long distance driving Are the tires second and you could crash and be injured all inflated to the recommended pressure What can you do about highway hypnosis Firs
101. the system when you exit the vehicle See DIC Vehicle Personalization on page 220 Now if a door or the trunk lid is opened without the keyless access transmitter the alarm will go off Your horn will sound for two minutes then it will go off to save battery power And your vehicle will not start without a keyless transmitter present The theft deterrent system will not arm if you lock the driver s door with the power door lock switch after the doors are closed If your passenger stays in the vehicle when you leave with the keyless access transmitter have the passenger lock the vehicle after the doors are closed This way the alarm will not arm and your passenger will not set it off 85 Testing the Alarm Do the following to test the system 1 Make sure the trunk lid is latched Lower the window on the driver s door Manually arm the system Close the doors and wait 30 seconds Reach through the open window and manually pull the release lever on the floor 6 Turn off the alarm by pressing the unlock button on the transmitter aw WwW PY If the alarm is inoperative check to see if the horn works If not check the horn fuse See Fuses and Circuit Breakers on page 453 If the horn works but the alarm doesn t go off see your dealer Disarming the System Always use your keyless access transmitter to unlock a door either by pressing the unlock button on the transmitter or by squeezing the door ha
102. the accurate position of the vehicle The GPS shows the current position of your vehicle using signals sent by the GPS Satellites of the United States Department of Defense When your vehicle is not receiving signals from the satellites a symbol will appear on the map screen Refer to Symbols on page 275 This system may not be available or interference may occur if the following happens e Signal obstructions caused by tall buildings large trucks tunnels e objects located on top of the instrument panel e satellites will not send signals if they are being repaired or improved e after market glass tinting has been applied to the vehicle s windows Notice Do not apply after market glass tinting to the vehicle s windows Glass tinting will interfere with the system s ability to receive GPS signals and cause the system to malfunction You might have to replace the window to correct the problem This would not be covered by your warranty For more information if you are experiencing a problem see If the System Needs Service on page 283 and Problems with Route Guidance on page 283 281 Vehicle Positioning At times the position of the vehicle on the map may be inaccurate due to one or more of the following reasons 282 The road system has changed The vehicle is driving on slippery road surfaces such as in sand gravel and or snow The vehicle is traveling on winding roads The vehicle is on a lon
103. the high beam headlamps to signal the driver in front of you that you want to pass Pull and hold the turn signal lever toward you to use When you do the following will occur e If the low beam headlamps are on the high beam headlamps will turn on They will stay on as long as you hold the lever there Release the lever to turn them off e If the headlamps are on high beam they will switch to low beam To return to high beam push the lever away from you 143 Windshield Wipers Use the lever located on the right side of the steering column to operate the windshield wipers High Speed Move the lever to this position for steady wiping at high speed HE Low Speed Move the lever to this position for steady wiping at low speed Delay Move the lever to this position to set a delay between wipes 144 lt 2 Delay Adjustment Move the lever to this position to choose a delayed wiping cycle Turn the intermittent adjust band down for a longer delay or up for a shorter delay The wiper speed can only be manually adjusted when the lever is in this position Off Move the lever to this position to turn off the windshield wipers 7 Mist Move the lever all the way down to mist and release for a single wiping cycle The windshield wipers will stop after one wipe If you want more wipes hold the band on mist longer Heavy snow or ice can overload the wipers If this occurs a circuit brea
104. the linkage 127 7 128 Move the rear tonneau rearward and up to the 8 Push both sides of the rear tonneau stored position Pull from the center of the over center link up until they stop to lock the tonneau to keep pressure even The rubber linkage bumper on each corner will fit against 9 Close the h ing j ydraulic pump valve by turning it the underside of the trunk decklid clockwise with your hand until it stops 11 Reach behind the square hole and push the front tonneau over center link up The front four screws holding the storage area in tonneau should pull up easily If it does not push the over center link up more place 10 Remove the upright center storage compartment Use the wrench to remove the 129 12 Manually move the front tonneau to the open position Once the front tonneau is open fold the side wings in by gently pressing them in Do not force the wings If they are hard to move make sure the front tonneau is open all the way 13 14 Reach in from the side of the vehicle and under the top to remove the headliner plug The plug will be located in the center of the top near the front Insert the wrench into the bolt beneath the plug location Turn the wrench about one quarter turn counterclockwise until it stops while gently pulling up on the center of the top to release it
105. the navigation system to your preference using various options You will also need to know how to perform various functions to begin route guidance Reference the following topics for further information e To adjust screen appearance language clock English metric measurements or other options see Main Audio Menu under Navigation Audio System on page 285 e To adjust voice guidance volume or other navigation settings see Setup Menu on page 243 235 Setting Radio Station Presets To set preset radio stations do the following 1 Press the PWR VOL knob to turn the system on 2 Press the audio source screen button AM FM1 FM2 etc and select the desired band AM FM1 FM2 XM1 or XM2 if equipped or WX weather if equipped 3 Use the TUNE SEEK arrows to tune to the desired station 4 Press and hold one of the six preset screen buttons at the bottom of the screen until you hear a beep or see the station displayed on the selected preset button 5 Repeat the steps for each preset See Preset Station Menu under Navigation Audio System on page 285 for more information 236 Setting the Time To set the time do the following 1 Press the PWR VOL knob to turn the system on 2 Press the amp C Audio Adjust hard key 3 Press the clock symbol screen button 4 Select the 12H or 24H screen button to display the time in standard or military time 5 Press and hold the HO
106. the original remote control transmitter for fixed code programming It is also recommended that upon the sale or lease termination of the vehicle the programmed buttons should be erased for security purposes See Erasing your Universal Home Remote Buttons later in this section Be sure that people and objects are clear of the garage door or security device you are programming When programming a garage door it is advised to park outside of the garage If you do not know if your garage door opener is a fixed code or rolling code device open your garage door opener s remote control battery cover Your garage door opener is a fixed code device if there is a panel of switches If not your garage door opener is a rolling code device 113 Programming Universal Home Remote Fixed Code Fixed Code garage door openers are used for garage doors produced prior to 1996 Fixed code uses the same coded signal every time which is manually programmed by setting DIP switches for a unique personal code To program up to three channels 1 Remove the battery cover of the hand held transmitter 114 Switch Number 1 2 3 41 56 7 8 Switch Position On On Off On Off On Off Off Example of Switch Settings 2 Write down the eight to 12 coding switch settings from left to right When the switch is in the up position write
107. those commonly called Event Data Recorders EDR In a crash event computer systems such as the airbag Sensing and Diagnostic Module SDM in your vehicle may record information about the condition of the vehicle and how it was operated such as data related to engine speed brake application throttle position vehicle speed safety belt usage airbag readiness airbag performance and the severity of a collision If your vehicle is equipped with StabiliTrak steering performance including yaw rate steering wheel angle and lateral acceleration is also recorded This information has been used to improve vehicle crash performance and may be used to improve crash performance of future vehicles and driving safety Unlike the data recorders on many airplanes these on board systems do not record sounds such as conversation of vehicle occupants To read this information special equipment is needed and access to the vehicle or the device that stores the data is required GM will not access information about a crash event or share it with others other than e with the consent of the vehicle owner or if the vehicle is leased with the consent of the lessee e in response to an official request of police or similar government office e as part of GM s defense of litigation through the discovery process or e as required by law 491 In addition once GM collects or receives data GM may e use the data for GM rese
108. tires 421 Inflation Tire Pressure Tires need the correct amount of air pressure to operate effectively Notice Do not let anyone tell you that under inflation or over inflation is all right It is not If your tires do not have enough air under inflation you can get the following e Too much flexing e Too much heat e Tire overloading e Premature or irregular wear e Poor handling e Reduced fuel economy If your tires have too much air over inflation you can get the following e Unusual wear e Poor handling e Rough ride e Needless damage from road hazards 422 A Tire and Loading Information label is attached to the center pillar below the driver s door latch This label shows your vehicle s original equipment tires and the correct inflation pressures for your tires when they are cold The recommended cold tire inflation pressure shown on the label is the minimum amount of air pressure needed to support your vehicle s maximum load carrying capacity For additional information regarding how much weight your vehicle can carry and an example of the tire and loading information label see Loading Your Vehicle on page 354 How you load your vehicle affects vehicle handling and ride comfort never load your vehicle with more weight than it was designed to carry When to Check Check your tires once a month or more How to Check Use a good quality pocket type gage to check tire pressure You can
109. to You should turn the system off if your vehicle ever gets stuck in sand mud or snow and rocking the vehicle is required See Rocking Your Vehicle to Get It Out on page 354 and If Your Vehicle is Stuck in Sand Mud Ice or Snow on page 353 for more information 330 To turn the system off press the front part of the traction control button located on the center console TC The TRACTION SYSTEM OFF message will display on the DIC and the traction control system warning light will come on If the system is limiting wheel spin when you press the button the TRACTION SYSTEM OFF message will display but the system will not turn off right away It will wait until there is no longer a current need to limit wheel spin You can turn the system back on at any time by pressing the button again The TRACTION SYSTEM ON message should display briefly on the Driver Information Center See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 206 for more information Adding non GM accessories can affect your vehicle s performance See Accessories and Modifications on page 363 for more information Magnetic Ride Control Magnetic Ride Control automatically adjusts the ride of your vehicle Automatic ride control is achieved through a computer used to control and monitor the suspension system The controller receives input from various sensors to determine the proper system response If the controller detects a problem within the system the DIC wil
110. vehicle drive slowly re adjust or remove the device if it is contacting your vehicle and do not spin your wheels If you do find traction devices that will fit install them on the rear tires Lifting Your Vehicle A CAUTION Lifting a vehicle can cause an injury The vehicle can slip off the jack and roll over you or other people You and they could be badly injured Find a level place to lift your vehicle To help prevent the vehicle from moving 1 Set the parking brake firmly 2 Put an automatic transmission shift lever in PARK P 3 Turn off the engine To be even more certain the vehicle won t move you can put blocks in front of and behind the wheels 435 A CAUTION Getting under a vehicle when it is jacked up is dangerous If the vehicle slips off the jack you could be badly injured or killed Never get under a vehicle when it is supported only by a jack A CAUTION Raising your vehicle with the jack improperly positioned can damage the vehicle and even make the vehicle fall To help avoid personal injury and vehicle damage be sure to place the jack in the proper location before raising the vehicle If you ever use a jack to lift your vehicle follow the instructions that came with the jack and be sure to use the correct lifting points to avoid damaging your vehicle 436 Notice Lifting your vehicle improperly can damage your vehicle and result in costly repairs not covered
111. vehicle power is lost See Trunk on page 77 for more information To remove the key press the button A near the bottom of the keyless access transmitter and pull the key out Never pull the key out without pressing the button Your vehicle has a keyless access system with pushbutton start See Ignition Positions on page 88 for information on starting the vehicle Notice If you ever lose your transmitter s and or key it could be difficult to get into your vehicle You may even have to damage your vehicle to get in Be sure you have a spare transmitter and or key In an emergency contact Cadillac Roadside Assistance See Roadside Service on page 487 Keyless Access System Your vehicle has a Keyless Access System that operates on a radio frequency subject to Federal Communications Commission FCC Rules and with Industry Canada This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules Operation is subject to the following two conditions 1 This device may not cause harmful interference 2 This device must accept any interference received including interference that may cause undesired operation This device complies with RSS 210 of Industry Canada Operation is subject to the following two conditions 1 This device may not cause interference 2 This device must accept any interference received including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device Changes or modifications to this system
112. with misaimed headlamps slow down a little Avoid staring directly into the approaching headlamps 339 Keep the windshield and all the glass on your vehicle clean inside and out Glare at night is made much worse by dirt on the glass Even the inside of the glass can build up a film caused by dust Dirty glass makes lights dazzle and flash more than clean glass would making the pupils of your eyes contract repeatedly Remember that the headlamps light up far less of a roadway when you are in a turn or curve Keep your eyes moving that way it is easier to pick out dimly lighted objects Just as the headlamps should be checked regularly for proper aim so should your eyes be examined regularly Some drivers suffer from night blindness the inability to see in dim light and are not even aware of it 340 Driving in Rain and on Wet Roads LAMM Wa i LY MI i Rain and wet roads can mean driving trouble On a wet road you cannot stop accelerate or turn as well because your tire to road traction is not as good as on dry roads And if your tires do not have much tread left you will get even less traction It is always wise to go slower and be cautious if rain starts to fall while you are driving The surface may get wet suddenly when your reflexes are tuned for driving on dry pavement The heavier the rain the harder it is to see Even if your windshield wiper blades are in good shape a heavy rain
113. you do not your brakes may no longer work properly For example if someone puts in brake linings that are wrong for your vehicle the balance between your front and rear brakes can change for the worse The braking performance you have come to expect can change in many other ways if someone puts in the wrong replacement brake parts 401 Battery Your vehicle has a maintenance free battery When it is time for a new battery get one that has the replacement number shown on the original battery s label We recommend an ACDelco replacement battery For battery replacement see your dealer or the service manual To purchase a service manual see Service and Owner Publications in Service Publications Ordering Information on page 497 Warning Battery posts terminals and related accessories contain lead and lead compounds chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and reproductive harm Wash hands after handling 402 Vehicle Storage If you are not going to drive your vehicle for 25 days or more remove the black negative cable from the battery This will help keep your battery from running down A CAUTION Batteries have acid that can burn you and gas that can explode You can be badly hurt if you are not careful See Jump Starting on page 403 for tips on working around a battery without getting hurt You must close all doors and the trunk before reconnecting the battery After reconnec
114. you drive your vehicle through an automatic car wash that does not have enough clearance for the wide rear tires and wheels you could damage your vehicle Verify with the manager of the car wash that your vehicle will fit before entering the car wash or use a touchless car wash High pressure car washes may cause water to enter the vehicle Cleaning Exterior Lamps Lenses Use only lukewarm or cold water a soft cloth and a car washing soap to clean exterior lamps and lenses Follow instructions under Washing Your Vehicle on page 446 Finish Care Occasional waxing or mild polishing of the vehicle by hand may be necessary to remove residue from the paint finish Approved cleaning products can be obtained from your dealer See Vehicle Care Appearance Materials on page 450 Notice Machine compounding or aggressive polishing on a basecoat clearcoat paint finish may damage it Use only non abrasive waxes and polishes that are made for a basecoat clearcoat paint finish on your vehicle The vehicle has a basecoat clearcoat paint finish The clearcoat gives more depth and gloss to the colored basecoat Always use waxes and polishes that are non abrasive and made for a basecoat clearcoat paint finish Foreign materials such as calcium chloride and other salts ice melting agents road oil and tar tree sap bird droppings chemicals from industrial chimneys etc can damage the vehicle s finish if they remain on painted surfa
115. your vehicle is parked e Familiarize yourself with all of its controls e Familiarize yourself with its operation e Set up your audio system by presetting your favorite radio stations setting the tone and adjusting the speakers Then when driving conditions permit you can tune to your favorite radio stations using the presets and steering wheel controls if the vehicle has them Notice Before adding any sound equipment to your vehicle such as an audio system CD player CB radio mobile telephone or two way radio make sure that it can be added by checking with your dealer Also check federal rules covering mobile radio and telephone units If sound equipment can be added it is very important to do it properly Added sound equipment may interfere with the operation of your vehicle s engine radio or other systems and even damage them Your vehicle s systems may interfere with the operation of sound equipment that has been added 226 Your vehicle has a feature called Retained Accessory Power RAP With RAP the audio system can be played even after the ignition is turned off See Retained Accessory Power RAP on page 89 for more information Theft Deterrent Feature THEFTLOCK is designed to discourage theft of your vehicle s radio The feature works automatically by learning a portion of the Vehicle Identification Number VIN If the radio is moved to a different vehicle it will not operate If the radi
116. your vehicle needs service When this light is on the system will not limit wheel spin Adjust your driving accordingly 194 If the driver turns off TCS by pressing the button on the console the TCS light will come on and the TRACTION SYSTEM OFF message will show on the DIC If the light stays on or comes on while you are driving a chime sounds and a SERVICE STABILITRAK message appears on the DIC there is a problem with your StabiliTrak and the vehicle needs service You can acknowledge this message by pressing the RESET button When the SERVICE STABILITRAK message is displayed the StabiliTrak system will not assist you in controlling the vehicle You should have the system serviced as soon as possible Adjust your driving accordingly When the system is working you will see the STABILITRAK ACTIVE message displayed in the DIC You may also feel of hear the system working This is normal If you turn off the StabiliTrak system by pressing the front part of the button on the console for five seconds the TCS light will come on a chime will sound and the TRAC STABILITRAK OFF message will be displayed in the DIC The TCS will also be turned off See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 206 for more information If the StabiliTrak system and TCS are turned off pressing the console button momentarily will turn both systems on The DIC will display the TRAC STABILITRAK ON message the instrument cluster light will b
117. 100 This program is available in all 50 states and the District of Columbia Eligibility is limited by vehicle age mileage and other factors General Motors reserves the right to change eligibility limitations and or discontinue its participation in this program 483 Online Owner Center Online Owner Center United States only The Owner Center is a resource for your GM ownership needs Specific vehicle information can be found in one place The Online Owner Center allows you to e Get e mail service reminders e Access information about your specific vehicle including tips and videos and an electronic version of this owner manual e Keep track of your vehicle s service history and maintenance schedule e Find GM dealers for service nationwide e Receive special promotions and privileges only available to members Refer to www MyGMLink com on the web for updated information and to register your vehicle 484 My GM Canada Canada only My GM Canada is a password protected section of gmcanada com where you can save information on GM vehicles get personalized offers and use handy tools and forms with greater ease Here are a few of the valuable tools and services you will have access to My Showroom Find and save information on vehicles and current offers in your area My Dealers Retailers Save details such as address and phone number for each of your preferred GM Dealers or Retailers M
118. 2007 Cadillac XLR XLR V Owner Manual M Seats and Restraint Systems oo 7 Instrument Panel oe 135 Front Seats iceiccecccccssssseceeeeeeeeeeeesaeeeeeeees 8 Instrument Panel Overview _ 008 138 Safety Belts oo cecccccceeccceseaeeeceesaeeeeees 13 Climate Controls o ceececccceseeecceeeeeeeees 178 Child Restraints o ceecccceceeeeccesaeeeeees 28 Warning Lights Gages and Airbag System scccsccsssscssceseseeeeseseseeees 44 INGIGATONS aroen e EE 185 Restraint System Check ansen 60 Driver Information Center DIC 203 Trip Computer oo eeeeeeeeeeeeseeeeeeeeeeeeeees 224 Features and Controls oie 63 Audio System S eisereen 225 INCYSi see N EE TA EEEE AE 65 oe Doors and LOCKS ccc ccecacs conttiaaectinpaieatiats 73 Navigation System oie 231 WINdOWS ry rsdaiteceasiiuidastdligconstuvaitadcinddsecs 81 OVEIVIGW _ csdedicstncesdesveceestedeecteresecdstedenss 232 Theft Deterrent Systems oo eeeeeeeeeeeeee 84 Features and Controls ceeecceeeeeeeees 240 Starting and Operating Your Vehicle _ 87 Navigation Audio System ceeeeeee 285 Minors sieo aneren ana a E 104 Voice Recognition lessees 312 OnStar GVSIGM ceciceeticecersssntieedicee esses 107 Driving Your Vehicle 301 Universal Home Remote System 110 Your Driving the Road and Storage Areas o eeeccccceeecccceceecceesaeeees 121 Your Vehicle a 322 Retractable Hardtop sssssssssssssnritssssns 124 TOWING
119. 35 353 Rocking Your Vehicle to Get It Out First turn the steering wheel left and right That will clear the area around the front wheels You should turn the traction control system off See Traction Control System TCS on page 329 Then shift back and forth between REVERSE R and a forward gear spinning the wheels as little as possible Release the accelerator pedal while you shift and press lightly on the accelerator pedal when the transmission is in gear By slowly spinning the wheels in the forward and reverse directions you will cause a rocking motion that may free your vehicle If that does not get your vehicle out after a few tries it may need to be towed out If your vehicle does need to be towed out see Towing Your Vehicle on page 359 354 Loading Your Vehicle It is very important to know how much weight your vehicle can carry This weight is called the vehicle capacity weight and includes the weight of all occupants cargo and all nonfactory installed options Two labels on your vehicle show how much weight it may properly carry the Tire and Loading Information label and the Certification label A CAUTION Do not load your vehicle any heavier than the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating GVWR or either the maximum front or rear Gross Axle Weight Rating GAWR If you do parts on your vehicle can break and it can change the way your vehicle handles These could cause you to lose control and crash Als
120. 8 and Wheel Replacement on page 432 for additional information If your vehicle has P235 50R18 size tires they should be rotated any time you notice unusual wear When rotating P235 50R18 size tires always use the correct rotation pattern shown here After the tires have been rotated adjust the front and rear inflation pressures as shown on the Tire and Loading Information label see Inflation Tire Pressure on page 422 and Loading Your Vehicle on page 354 Vehicles that have the Tire Pressure Monitor TPM system will need to have the sensors reset after a tire rotation is performed A special tool is needed to reset the sensor identification codes See your dealer for service Make certain that all wheel nuts are properly tightened See Wheel Replacement on page 432 and Wheel Nut Torque under Capacities and Specifications on page 458 A CAUTION Rust or dirt on a wheel or on the parts to which it is fastened can make wheel nuts become loose after a time The wheel could come off and cause a crash When you change a wheel remove any rust or dirt from places where the wheel attaches to the vehicle In an emergency you can use a cloth or a paper towel to do this but be sure to use a scraper or wire brush later if you need to to get all the rust or dirt off XLR V Tires Tire rotation is not recommended if your vehicle has P235 45R19 size tires on the front axle and P255 40R19 size tires on the rear axle D
121. 9021186 Seem anada Assembly Lubriplate Lubricant Aerosol Automatic DEXRON VI Automatic Secondary GM Part No U S 12346293 in Transmission Transmission Fluid Latch Pivots Canada 992723 or lubricant Trank Key Leck Multi Purpose Lubricant Superlube Spring meeting requirements of NLGI 2 GM Part No U S 12346241 in Anchor and Category LB or GC LB Cylinder Canada 10953474 Release Pawl Supercharger Oil Hood and Dooi Multi Purpose Lubricant Superlube GM Part No U S 12345982 in Hinges GM Part No U S 12346241 In Supercharger Canada 10953513 See Canada 10953474 Supercharger Oil on page 382 Weatherstrip Lubricant GM Part No U S 3634770 in Weatherstrip Canada 10953518 or Dielectric Conditioning Silicone Grease GM Part No U S 12345579 in Canada 992887 474 Normal Maintenance Replacement Parts Replacement parts identified below by name part number or specification can be obtained from your dealer po Part GM Part Number ACDelco Part Number A2945C A1208C PF26 PFI CFISIC Wiper Blade 19 7 inches OOM mea OOO o S 475 Engine Drive Belt Routing 4 4L V8 Engine 4 6L V8 Engine 476 Maintenance Record After the scheduled services are performed record the date odometer reading who performed the service and the type of services performed in the boxes provided See Maintenance Requirements on page 462 Any additional information from Owner Checks and
122. A misfire condition has been detected A misfire increases vehicle emissions and may damage the emission control system on your vehicle Diagnosis and service may be required e Light On Steady An emission control system malfunction has been detected on your vehicle Diagnosis and service may be required 197 If the Light Is Flashing The following may prevent more serious damage to your vehicle e Reducing vehicle speed e Avoiding hard accelerations e Avoiding steep uphill grades If the light stops flashing and remains on steady see If the Light Is On Steady following If the light continues to flash when it is safe to do so stop the vehicle Find a safe place to park your vehicle Turn the engine off wait at least 10 seconds and restart the engine If the light remains on steady see If the Light Is On Steady following If the light is still flashing follow the previous steps and see your dealer for service as soon as possible 198 If the Light Is On Steady You also may be able to correct the emission system malfunction by considering the following Did you recently put fuel into your vehicle If so reinstall the fuel cap making sure to fully install the cap See Filling the Tank on page 369 The diagnostic system can determine if the fuel cap has been left off or improperly installed A loose or missing fuel cap will allow fuel to evaporate into the atmosphere A few driving trips with th
123. Before you begin to operate the navigation system read this manual thoroughly to become familiar with it and to understand how the system works Keeping your mind on the drive is important for safe driving See Defensive Driving on page 322 for more information Get familiar with your vehicle s navigation system so you can use it with less effort and take full advantage of its features Your navigation system includes not only navigation but also audio functions While your vehicle is parked e Familiarize yourself with all of its controls hard keys on the faceplate and touch sensitive screen buttons e Familiarize yourself with its operation e Setup your audio by presetting your favorite stations setting the tone and adjusting the speakers Then when driving conditions permit you can tune to your favorite stations using the presets and steering wheel controls if equipped e Set up the navigation features that can only be done before you begin driving such as entering an address or a preset destination 234 Entering a destination or alphanumeric text requires many steps so you can only perform these operations when the vehicle is in PARK P You will notice that touch sensitive screen buttons leading to the alphanumeric keyboard are dimmed out while driving Other functions may also be locked out while driving and they too will appear grayed out on the screen but all functions are available when parked Some f
124. DIC which can take up to 15 minutes SVC Service TIRE MONITOR This message displays if a part on the Tire Pressure Monitor TPM is not working properly If you drive your vehicle while any of the four sensors are missing or inoperable the warning comes on in about 30 minutes A sensor would be missing for example if you put different wheels on your vehicle without transferring the sensors If the warning comes on and stays on there may be a problem with the TPM See your dealer TOO COLD TO MOVE TOP This message displays when the retractable hardtop button is pressed and the hardtop pump motor temperature is below 4 F 20 C Wait for the hardtop pump motor to warm up before using the retractable hardtop TOP INOP Inoperative VALET ON This message displays when the retractable hardtop button is pressed and the valet switch is on Turn off the valet switch before using the retractable hardtop TOP INOP Inoperative OUT OF PARK This message displays if the retractable hardtop button is pressed while the vehicle is not in PARK P TOP MOTOR OVER TEMP Temperature This message displays when the retractable hardtop button is pressed and the hardtop pump motor temperature is over 221 F 105 C Wait for the hardtop pump motor to cool down before using the retractable hardtop TOP NOT SECURE This message displays when the retractable hardtop button is released before the top open or close oper
125. DRL are required on all vehicles first sold in Canada The DRL system makes the front turn signal lamps come on when the following conditions are met e Itis still daylight and the ignition is on e The exterior lamp control is in the off position e The transmission is not in PARK P When DRL are on only the front turn signal lamps are on No other exterior lamps such as the parking lamps taillamps etc are on when the DRL are used Your instrument panel will not be lit When it is dark enough outside the front turn signal lamps turn off and normal low beam headlamps turn on When it is bright enough outside the regular lamps go off and the front turn signal lamps take over If you start your vehicle in a dark garage the automatic headlamp system comes on immediately Once you leave the garage it takes about one minute for the automatic headlamp system to change to DRL if it is light outside During that delay the instrument panel cluster might not be as bright as usual Make sure the instrument panel brightness knob is in the full bright position See nstrument Panel Brightness on page 170 for more information If it is dark enough outside and the exterior lamp control is off a HEADLAMPS SUGGESTED message displays on the Driver s Information Center DIC This message informs the driver that turning on the exterior lamps is recommended See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 206 Turn the exterior lamp control off
126. Electrical Equipment 008 452 Air Cleaner Filter Engine ccecceeeeeees 382 Air Conditioning 0 cececeeeseeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaaes 178 Airbag Passenger Status Indicator cee 189 Readiness Light c esseeeeeeneeeeeeeeee 188 Airbag Sensing and Diagnostic Module SDM oraa neoninis 491 Airbag System sneins 44 Adding Equipment to Your Airbag Equipped Vehicle oiccen 59 How Does an Airbag Restrain 0 51 Passenger Sensing System seee 53 Servicing Your Airbag Equipped Vehicle 58 What Makes an Airbag Inflate 0 51 What Will You See After an Airbag ALCS seeessesccvteescweuddannteetedseteuveeesweateedes 52 Airbag System cont When Should an Airbag Inflate 49 Where Are the Airbags ceeeeeeeeees 47 Antenna Diversity Antenna System 230 Antenna XM Satellite Radio Antenna SYSTEM aigres eenaa 230 Anti Lock Brake System ABS 0 327 Anti Lock Brake System Warning Light 193 Appearance Care Aluminum or Chrome Plated Wheels 448 Care of Safety Belts eee 445 Chemical Paint Spotting eee 450 Cleaning Exterior Lamps Lenses 446 Cleaning the Inside of Your Vehicle 441 Fabric Carpet iiiiceie issiria 443 Finish Care cccccceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 447 Finish Damage cececeeeeeeseeeeeeeeeeees 449 Instru
127. MOTOR OVER TEMP or TOP NOT SECURE messages display see DIC Warnings and Messages on page 206 for more information If the retractable hardtop does not operate and there are no messages displayed on the Driver Information Center DIC then perform the Power Window Initialize steps under Power Windows on page 82 Raising the Retractable Hardtop 1 Park on a level surface Shift the transmission into PARK P 2 The vehicle s engine must be on or in Acc 3 Lower both sun visors Notice Raising or lowering the top while the vehicle is in motion can cause damage to the top or top mechanism Make sure the vehicle is in PARK P to lower or raise the top 4 Make sure nothing or no one is on or around the top Make sure the trunk cargo cover is in place with no cargo on top of or in front of the cargo cover See Rear Storage Area on page 123 for more information Also be sure the valet lockout switch is off 125 5 Push and hold the top of the retractable hardtop button a located behind the shift lever The agin windows will automatically lower and the top will raise NZ A chime will sound when the top has raised completely After the top is fully raised release the retractable hardtop button If you press the button again within five seconds the windows will automatically close If your radio is on you may notice a brief mute in sound This is normal and due to a new audio system equalization bein
128. Normally any concerns with the sales transaction or the operation of your vehicle will be resolved by your dealer s sales or service departments Sometimes however despite the best intentions of all concerned misunderstandings can occur If your concern has not been resolved to your satisfaction the following steps should be taken STEP ONE Discuss your concern with a member of dealership management Normally concerns can be quickly resolved at that level If the matter has already been reviewed with the sales service or parts manager contact the owner of the dealership or the general manager 482 STEP TWO If after contacting a member of dealership management it appears your concern cannot be resolved by the dealership without further help contact the Cadillac Customer Assistance Center 24 hours a day by calling 1 800 458 8006 In Canada contact the Canadian Cadillac Customer Communication Centre by calling 1 888 446 2000 We encourage you to call the toll free number in order to give your inquiry prompt attention Please have the following information available to give the Customer Assistance Representative e Vehicle Identification Number VIN This is available from the vehicle registration or title or the plate at the top left of the instrument panel and visible through the windshield e Dealership name and location e Vehicle delivery date and present mileage When contacting Cadillac please remember that
129. Notice Cranking the engine for long periods of time by pressing the START button immediately after cranking has ended can overheat and damage the cranking motor and drain the battery Wait at least 15 seconds between each try to allow the cranking motor to cool down Your vehicle has a Computer Controlled Cranking System This feature assists in starting the engine and protects components Once cranking has been initiated the engine continues cranking for a few seconds or until the vehicle starts If the engine does not start cranking automatically be stops after 15 seconds to prevent cranking motor damage To prevent gear damage this system also prevents cranking if the engine is already running Notice Your engine is designed to work with the electronics in your vehicle If you add electrical parts or accessories you could change the way the engine operates Before adding electrical equipment check with your dealer If you do not your engine might not perform properly Any resulting damage would not be covered by your vehicle s warranty Stopping Your Engine Move the shift lever to PARK P and press the Acc Off Accessory button located on the instrument panel If the shifter is not in PARK P the engine shuts off and the vehicle goes into the Accessory Mode The DIC displays SHIFT TO PARK Once the shifter is moved to PARK P the vehicle turns off If the keyless access transmitter is not detected
130. ON Both frontal and side impact airbags inflate with great force faster than the blink of an eye If you are too close to an inflating airbag as you would be if you were leaning forward it could seriously injure you Safety belts help keep you in position for airbag inflation before and during a crash Always wear your safety belt even with frontal airbags The driver should sit as far back as possible while still maintaining control of the vehicle Occupants should not lean on or sleep against the door 45 A CAUTION Anyone who is up against or very close to any airbag when it inflates can be seriously injured or killed Airbags plus lap shoulder belts offer the best protection for adults but not for young children and infants Neither the vehicle s safety belt system nor its airbag system is designed for them Young children and infants need the protection that a child restraint system can provide Always secure children properly in your vehicle To read how see Older Children on page 28 or Infants and Young Children on page 31 46 There is an airbag readiness light on the o instrument panel which A shows the airbag a N symbol The system checks the airbag electrical system for malfunctions The light tells you if there is an electrical problem See Airbag Readiness Light on page 188 for more information Where Are the Airbags The passenger s frontal airbag is in the instrument panel on the
131. Signal Multifunction Lever on page 141 Power Tilt Wheel and Telescopic Steering Button See Power Tilt Wheel and Telescopic Steering Column on page 141 Horn See Horn on page 140 Audio Steering Wheel Controls See Audio Steering Wheel Controls on page 227 Ignition Switch See Ignition Positions on page 88 Shift Lever See Automatic Transmission Operation on page 92 Traction Control Button See Traction Control System TCS on page 329 139 P Retractable Hardtop Button See Retractable Hardtop on page 124 Q Cupholders See Cupholder s on page 122 R Cigarette Lighter See Ashtray s and Cigarette Lighter on page 178 S Climate Controls See Dual Climate Control System on page 178 T Audio Navigation System See Navigation System Overview on page 232 U Glove Box See Glove Box on page 121 Hazard Warning Flashers Your hazard warning flashers let you warn others They also let police know you have a problem Your front and rear turn signal lamps will flash on and off The hazard warning flasher button is located near the center of the instrument panel 140 Your hazard warning flashers work no matter what mode the ignition is in even if the ignition is turned off Press the button to make the front and rear turn signal lamps flash on and off Press the button again to turn the flashers off When the hazard warning flashers are on your turn signals will not work Oth
132. These commands will cause the system to enter the last available starting point as a destination Guidance Commands Repeat Guidance Repeat Voice These commands will cause the system to repeat the last available voice prompt guidance command if a destination has been set 316 Louder This command will cause the system to increase the volume of the navigation voice prompts if a destination has been set Softer This command will cause the system to decrease the volume of the navigation voice prompts if a destination has been set Voice Guidance Off This command will cause the system to turn off the navigation voice prompts if a destination has been set Voice Guidance On This command will cause the system to turn on the navigation voice prompts if a destination has been set Open Guidance Open Guidance Screen Open Guide Open Guide Screen These commands will cause the system to open the Guidance Appearance menu if a destination has been set Close Guidance Close Guidance Screen Close Guide Close Guide Screen These commands will cause the system to close the Guidance Appearance menu if a destination has been set Arrow Guidance Arrow Guide Change To Arrow Guidance Change To Arrow Guide These commands will cause the system to change to Arrow Guidance screen view in the Guidance Menu if a destination has been set Turn List Guidance Turn List Guide Change to Turn List Guidance Change to Turn List Guide
133. Touch Return to go back to the previous screen 269 Route Setting This feature allows you to display and change the planning methods used each time you plan a route With planning method options you are able to select the fastest route based on time or distance using only major roads toll roads and using ferries based on the navigation system s information and information contained on the map DVD FM1 95 3 MHz 4 23PM 85 F 270 The following options will be available from the ROUTE SETTING menu Minimize Time Distance The system will calculate the fastest route or shortest route possible Choose Time for the fastest route or Dist for the shortest route Use Major Roads Choose Yes to calculate the best route using only major roads unless a route cannot be found without the use of a secondary road This selection will not always offer the shortest distance or time to your destination Use Toll Roads Choose Yes to calculate the best route using toll roads wherever possible This selection will not always offer the shortest distance or time to your destination Use Ferries Choose Yes to calculate the best route using ferries when possible This selection will not always offer the shortest distance or time to your destination Display Whole Route This feature allows you to display your entire planned route Total mileage and time to destination for the planned route will be displayed on the map scre
134. Trunk Latch Auxiliary Power Cigar Lighter Usage OOOO 52 42 43 44 45 6 Underhood Fuse Block The underhood fuse block is located next to the engine on the passenger s side of the vehicle For more information on location see Engine Compartment Overview on page 374 To access the fuses push in the tab located at the end of the fuse block cover Then lift the cover open 455 Bi io q a ca Windshield Washer Adaptive Forward Lighting System AFS Intercooler Pump Headlamp Washer i Right Low Beam Headlamp Anti lock Brake System Electronic 20 Forward Lighting Systom AF Left Low Beam Headlamp Forward Lighting System AFS 2l Left Low Beam Headlamp 22 Fog Lamp Adaptive Cruise Control ACC eS Right High Beam Headlamp Transmission Controls 24 Left High Beam Headlamp Windshield Wipers 25 Cooling Fan Stop Back Up Lamps 26 Oxygen Sensor 27 Anti lock Brakes 28 Climate Controls Parking Lamps 29 sage Relays Usas Diodes Usage Wiper Diode 35 36 37 38 39 457 Capacities and Specifications The following approximate capacities are given in English and metric conversions Please refer to Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 473 for more information Application For the air conditioning system refrigerant charge amount see the refrigerant caution label located under the hood See your dealer for more information Automatic Transmission Pan Removal and Replaceme
135. UD and a information A a Feta Pele e A malfunction is detected in the system See action is required DIC Warnings and Messages on page 206 for more information See Defensive Driving on page 322 for more information Driver action is required when e Adaptive Cruise Control cannot apply sufficient braking because you are approaching a vehicle too rapidly Adaptive Cruise Control has only limited e The vehicle speed drops below about 20 mph braking ability to slow your vehicle In 32 km h some cases Adaptive Cruise Control may not have time to slow your vehicle enough to avoid a collision Be ready to take action and apply the brakes yourself See Defensive Driving on page 322 157 Approaching and Following a Vehicle The vehicle ahead symbol will only appear on the HUD when a vehicle ahead is detected in your path If this symbol does not appear or disappears briefly Adaptive Cruise Control will not respond to vehicles you may see ahead 158 A CAUTION When the Adaptive Cruise Control radar is blocked by snow ice or dirt it may not detect a vehicle ahead Adaptive Cruise Control may not have time to slow your vehicle enough to avoid a collision Do not use Adaptive Cruise Control when the radar is blocked by snow ice or dirt Keep your radar clean See Cleaning the System later in this section Adaptive Cruise Control will automatically slow your vehicle down when approaching a slower m
136. UR and MIN minute arrow buttons to increase or to decrease the time 6 Select the appropriate time zone screen button 7 Select the Daylight Saving Time screen button if necessary The radio will use the GPS satellite to set the time The vehicle needs to be in an open area to receive the signal See Clock Adjust Menu under Navigation Audio System on page 285 for more information Setting the Search Area Entering an Address and Point of Interest Storing a Home Destination and Using Your Home or Previous Destinations Before entering an Address Point of Interest Home or Preset Destination select the appropriate region that contains the final destination Your vehicle must be stopped to perform this operation Setting the Search Area To set the search area do the following 1 Press the PWR VOL knob to turn the system on 2 Insert the DVD map disc See Regional Maps under Maps on page 271 for more information 3 A notice may appear Touch the AGREE screen button to proceed If the radio is already on with a map disc inserted press the ROUTE hard key 4 Press the Enter Destination screen button 5 Press the Change screen button 6 Select the appropriate region numbered screen button that contains your final destination The system will return to the Destination menu See Enter Destination on page 259 for more information Entering an Address To set a destination by entering a
137. When the malfunction indicator is illuminated the system may not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons including the installation of replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS to continue to function properly A Tire and Loading Information label attached to your vehicle shows the size of your vehicle s original equipment tires and the correct inflation pressure for your vehicle s tires when they are cold See Loading Your Vehicle on page 354 for an example of the Tire and Loading Information label and its location on your vehicle Also see Inflation Tire Pressure on page 422 for additional information Your vehicle s TPMS can warn you about a low tire pressure condition but it does not replace normal tire maintenance See Tire Inspection and Rotation on page 426 When It Is Time for New Tires on page 428 and Tires on page 413 Notice Do not use a tire sealant if your vehicle has Tire Pressure Monitors The liquid sealant can damage the tire pressure monitor sensors 425 TPMS Sensor Identification Codes Each TPMS sensor has a unique identification code Any time you replace one or more of the TPMS senso
138. You would not be able to start your vehicle and the bad grounding could damage the electrical systems To avoid the possibility of the vehicles rolling set the parking brake firmly on both vehicles involved in the jump start procedure Put an automatic transmission in PARK P or a manual transmission in NEUTRAL before setting the parking brake 403 Notice If you leave your radio or other accessories on during the jump starting procedure they could be damaged The repairs would not be covered by your warranty Always turn off your radio and other accessories when jump starting your vehicle 3 Turn off the ignition on both vehicles Unplug unnecessary accessories plugged into the cigarette lighter or the accessory power outlet Turn off the radio and all lamps that are not needed This will avoid sparks and help save both batteries And it could save the radio 4 Open the hoods and locate the batteries Find the positive and negative terminal locations on each vehicle See Engine Compartment Overview on page 374 for more information on location A CAUTION An electric fan can start up even when the engine is not running and can injure you Keep hands clothing and tools away from any underhood electric fan 404 A CAUTION Using a match near a battery can cause battery gas to explode People have been hurt doing this and some have been blinded Use a flashlight if you need more light Be sure the b
139. a CHANGE OIL NOW message in the DIC being turned on reset the system After the oil has been changed the CHANGE OIL NOW message and the oil life indicator must be reset To reset the message use the following procedure 1 Press the up or down arrow to scroll the DIC to show OIL LIFE 2 Once the XXX ENGINE OIL LIFE menu item is highlighted press and hold the RESET button until the percentage shows 100 If the percentage does not return to 100 or if the CHANGE OIL NOW message comes back on when you start your vehicle the engine oil life system has not reset Repeat the procedure 381 What to Do with Used Oil Used engine oil contains certain elements that may be unhealthy for your skin and could even cause cancer Do not let used oil stay on your skin for very long Clean your skin and nails with soap and water or a good hand cleaner Wash or properly dispose of clothing or rags containing used engine oil See the manufacturer s warnings about the use and disposal of oil products Used oil can be a threat to the environment If you change your own oil be sure to drain all the oil from the filter before disposal Never dispose of oil by putting it in the trash pouring it on the ground into sewers or into streams or bodies of water Instead recycle it by taking it to a place that collects used oil If you have a problem properly disposing of your used oil ask your dealer a service station or a local recyclin
140. a child a helpless adult or a pet alone in a vehicle especially with the windows closed in warm or hot weather dangerous They can be overcome by the A 81 Power Windows The power window switches are located on each door near the A A armrest x x Press the up or down arrows on the switches to raise or lower the windows Your vehicle has Retained Accessory Power RAP that allows you to use the power windows once the ignition has been turned off For more information see Retained Accessory Power RAP on page 89 82 Power Window Initialize After a power reconnect such as battery replacement the express up and index up features will not function until the system is initialized Once power is restored do the following 1 Close the door 2 Raise the window by holding the up arrow on the power window switch 3 Hold the up arrow for three seconds after the window is closed Release the switch Then hold the up arrow again for three seconds The express up system must be initialized to operate the windows with the door open Express Down Window This feature is on both power windows Press the down arrow on the switch to the second position to activate the express down feature If you want to stop the window as it is lowering press the switch again Express Up Window This feature is on both power windows Press the up arrow on the switch to the second position to activate the express up f
141. able a Cadillac trained dealer technician who can provide on site service Each technician travels with a specially equipped service vehicle complete with the necessary Cadillac parts and tools required to handle most roadside repairs Cadillac Roadside Service can be reached by dialing 1 800 882 1112 24 hours a day 365 days a year This service is provided at no charge for any situation covered by the base warranty coverage and at a nominal charge if the Cadillac is no longer covered by the base warranty Roadside Service is available only in the United States and Canada Cadillac Owner Privileges Roadside Service provides several Cadillac Owner Privileges at no charge throughout your Cadillac Warranty Period 48 months 50 000 miles 80 000 km Emergency Road Service is performed on site for the following situations e Towing Service e Battery Jump Starting e Lock Out Assistance e Fuel Delivery e Flat Tire Change Covers change only e Trip Interruption If your trip is interrupted due to a warranty failure incidental expenses may be reimbursed during the 48 months 50 000 miles 80 000 km warranty period Items covered are hotel meals and rental car 487 Roadside Service Availability Wherever you drive in the United States or Canada an advisor is available to assist you over the phone A dealer technician if available can travel to your location within a 30 mile 50 km radius o
142. aetstein gn E a aiT 202 Gasoline Octane ccccceeccceeeceeeeeeeae sees 366 Gasoline Specifications eee 366 Fuses Fuses and Circuit Breakers 0066 453 Instrument Panel Fuse Block 453 Underhood Fuse Block ccceeeee neces 455 Windshield Wiper eeeeeeeeeeeeeteeeeees 452 Gage Engine Coolant Temperature 0008 195 Engine Oil Pressure aeee 200 PUGH E AE A 202 Speedometer cceeeeeeeeeeeeeeneneeeeeeees 187 Tachometer ceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeenaes 187 Voltmeter Gage ceceeeeeeetteeeeeeeeeeeeeee 192 Garage Door Opener neeese 110 111 504 Gasoline Otahon e a 366 Specifications oiiae eiiiai 366 Getting Started Getting Started Navigation 0 00 234 Global Positioning System GPS 281 GIOVE BOX aici canes oroipena Nen 121 GM Mobility Reimbursement Program 486 H Hazard Warning Flashers aace 140 Headlamp AMIN E E E E 408 Vertical AMIN sssrsenirrinisnrisiirianriarrinncnas 410 Headlamps Adaptive Forward Lighting System 167 Bulb Replacement eeeceseeeeeeneeeeees 412 Daytime Running Lamps ceecee 166 Flas hio Pass onenn 143 High Low Beam Changer eececce 143 On Reminder cccececeeeteeeeeeeeeeetees 166 WASHED ccc cece enii uae 146 Wiper Activated cceceecceseeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 166 Head Up Display HUD
143. al seconds all status indicator lights and battery charging remain on or if there are no lights at all there systems are working may be a problem with the lights or the passenger properly sensing system See your dealer for service If this light stays on your vehicle needs service You should take your vehicle to the dealer at once A CAUTION To save your battery until you get there turn off all accessories See DIC Controls and Displays on If the airbag off indicator and the airbag page 204 for more information readiness light ever come on together it means that something may be wrong with the airbag system If this ever happens have the vehicle serviced promptly because an adult size person sitting in the right front passenger seat may not have the protection of the airbag See Airbag Readiness Light on page 188 191 Voltmeter Gage When the vehicle is in accessory mode the voltmeter shows the voltage output of your battery When the engine is running it shows the voltage output of the charging system The reading will change as the rate of charge changes with engine speed for example but if the voltmeter reads at 9 volts or below your instrument panel cluster and other systems may shut down The Driver Information Center DIC will read LOW VOLTAGE when your vehicle is at 10 volts or below Have it checked right away Driving with the voltmeter reading at 10 volts or below could drain your batte
144. amples of symbols that may be found on the vehicle LATCH BOTH LAP AND ae SHOULDER BELTS TO crate ENGINE ee Se PROTECT OCCUPANT Suton AD cootant ering Ge DO NOT TWIST SAFETY i TEMP BELT WHEN ATTACHING PROTECT 4 TURN FUSE EYES BY FASTEN SIGNALS BATTERY BOX SHIELDING SEAT AIRBAG X CHARGING ACCESS U I BELTS SYSTEM PARKING CAUSTIC LANDS ENGINE BATTERY MOVE SEAT e DO NOT INSTALL a COOLANT Abin GAOL FULLY a AREAR FACING a CHILD RESTRAINT FAN CAUSE REARWARD dau HAZARD SECURE IN THIS SEATING BURNS CHILD SEAT POSITION WARNING FLASHER COOLANT AVOID PULL BELT SPARKS OR OUT FLAMES COMPLETELY ai THEN SECURE y IN THIS SEATING CHILD SEAT LAMPS PRESSURE SPARK OR POSITION FLAME M ANTI LOCK COULD rower MLT DOOR LOCK ae SERVICE gt EXPLODE MANUAL BATTERY winpow __ _ UNLOCK SYSTEM e DO NOT INSTALL A FORWARD FACING DAYTIME CHILD RESTRAINT RUNNING ENGINE OL ara OWNER MANUAL Section 1 Seats and Restraint Systems Front Seats opioa aaa 8 Lower Anchors and Tethers for POWer Seats iiisiorei sinnti iie a Eak 8 Children LATCH 00 ceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 39 Power Lumbar sif00s shucceivinetes ieeertiicinnecis 9 Securing a Child Restraint in the Heated and Cooled Seats ceeeeeeeee 9 Passenger Seat Position a 40 Memory Seat Mirrors and Airbag System ccccccccccceccecesseseeesseeees 44 Steering Wheel 0 0 eset 10 Where Are the Airbag
145. an DEX COOL may cause premature engine heater core or radiator corrosion In addition the engine coolant could require changing sooner at 30 000 miles 50 000 km or 24 months whichever occurs first Any repairs would not be covered by your warranty Always use DEX COOL silicate free coolant in your vehicle How to Add Coolant to the Coolant Surge Tank If you have not found a problem yet check to see if coolant is visible in the surge tank If coolant is visible but the coolant level is not at the FULL COLD mark on the front of the coolant surge tank add a 50 50 mixture of clean drinkable water and DEX COOL coolant at the coolant surge tank but be sure the cooling system including the coolant surge tank pressure cap is cool before you do it See Engine Coolant on page 385 for more information If no coolant is visible in the surge tank add coolant as follows A CAUTION Steam and scalding liquids from a hot cooling system can blow out and burn you badly They are under pressure and if you turn the coolant surge tank pressure cap even a little they can come out at high speed Never turn the cap when the cooling system including the coolant surge tank pressure cap is hot Wait for the cooling system and coolant surge tank pressure cap to cool if you ever have to turn the pressure cap 393 Notice In cold weather water can freeze and crack the engine radiator heater core and A CAUTION
146. an suffer permanent injuries or even death from heat stroke Always lock your vehicle whenever you leave it CAUTION Continued CAUTION Continued e Outsiders can easily enter through an unlocked door when you slow down or stop your vehicle Locking your doors can help prevent this from happening To lock or unlock your vehicle from the outside use the keyless access transmitter and press the appropriate lock or unlock button You may also unlock and open the door passively when you squeeze the door handle sensor as long as you have your transmitter with you Passive entry occurs when the door handle sensor is pressed and the vehicle recognizes your keyless access transmitter When the passenger door is opened first the driver s door will also become unlocked 73 From the inside use the power door lock buttons located at the top of the door panel near the window See Power Door Locks on page 75 for more information gt Q If you are inside the vehicle use the door release handle located on the floor next to each seat eee Pull the handle up to unlock and unlatch the door To open a door from the inside press the button in front of the door handle and push the door open If power to the vehicle or the keyless access transmitter is lost there are two ways to open the door 74 If you are outside the vehicle there is a door release tab in the trunk The tab is located behind a panel on t
147. ance company s collision policy repair limits as you have no contractual limits with that company In such cases you can have control of the repair and parts choices as long as cost stays within reasonable limits 495 Reporting Safety Defects Reporting Safety Defects to the United States Government If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death you should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration NHTSA in addition to notifying General Motors If NHTSA receives similar complaints it may open an investigation and if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles it may order a recall and remedy campaign However NHTSA cannot become involved in individual problems between you your dealer or General Motors 496 To contact NHTSA you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll free at 1 888 327 4236 TTY 1 800 424 9153 go to http www safercar gov or write to Administrator NHTSA 400 Seventh Street SW Washington D C 20590 You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http www safercar gov Reporting Safety Defects to the Canadian Government If you live in Canada and you believe that your vehicle has a safety defect you should immediately notify Transport Canada in addition to notifying General Motors of Canada Limited You may call them at 1 800 333 0510 or write to Transp
148. and are not recommended Do not use silicone or wax based products or those containing organic solvents to clean your vehicle s interior because they can alter the appearance by increasing the gloss in a non uniform manner Never use shoe polish on your leather 444 Instrument Panel Vinyl and Other Plastic Surfaces A soft cloth dampened with water may be used to remove dust If a more thorough cleaning is necessary a clean soft cloth dampened with a mild soap solution can be used to gently remove dust and dirt Never use spot lifters or removers on plastic surfaces Many commercial cleaners and coatings that are sold to preserve and protect soft plastic surfaces may permanently change the appearance and feel of your interior and are not recommended Do not use silicone or wax based products or those containing organic solvents to clean your vehicle s interior because they can alter the appearance by increasing the gloss in a non uniform manner Some commercial products may increase gloss on your instrument panel The increase in gloss may cause annoying reflections in the windshield and even make it difficult to see through the windshield under certain conditions Wood Panels Use a clean cloth moistened in warm soapy water use mild dish washing soap Dry the wood immediately with a clean cloth Speaker Covers Vacuum around a speaker cover gently so that the speaker will not be damaged Clean spots with just
149. anding under heavy foliage bridges garages or tunnels may cause loss of XM signal for a period of time The radio may display NO XM SIGNAL to indicate interference Cellular Phone Usage Cellular phone usage may cause interference with your vehicle s radio This interference may occur when making or receiving phone calls charging the phone s battery or simply having the phone on This interference is an increased level of static while listening to the radio If static is received while listening to the radio unplug the cellular phone and turn it off Care of Your CDs Handle CDs carefully Store them in their original cases or other protective cases and away from direct sunlight and dust The CD player scans the bottom surface of the disc If the surface of a CD is damaged such as cracked broken or scratched the CD will not play properly or not at all If the surface of a CD is soiled take a soft lint free cloth or dampen a clean soft cloth in a mild neutral detergent solution mixed with water and clean it Make sure the wiping process starts from the center to the edge Do not touch the bottom side of a CD while handling it this could damage the surface Pick up CDs by grasping the outer edges or the edge of the hole and the outer edge 229 Care of the CD Player Do not use CD lens cleaners for CD players because the lens of the CD optics can become contaminated by lubricants Diversity Antenna Syste
150. ant on hot engine parts Coolant contains ethylene glycol and it will burn if the engine parts are hot enough Do not spill coolant on a hot engine When replacing the pressure cap press down and turn it clockwise until you hear a clicking sound Make sure the cap is hand tight and fully seated 388 Coolant Surge Tank Pressure Cap Notice If the pressure cap is not tightly installed coolant loss and possible engine damage may occur Be sure the cap is properly and tightly secured The coolant surge tank pressure cap must be fully installed on the coolant surge tank See Engine Compartment Overview on page 374 for more information on location Engine Overheating You will find a COOLANT OVER TEMP message or an ENGINE HOT STOP ENGINE message displayed in the Driver Information Center DIC See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 206 You will also hear a chime There is also an engine coolant temperature gage on the instrument panel cluster See Engine Coolant Temperature Gage on page 195 If Steam Is Coming From Your Engine A CAUTION Steam from an overheated engine can burn you badly even if you just open the hood Stay away from the engine if you see or hear steam coming from it Turn it off and get everyone away from the vehicle until it cools down Wait until there is no sign of steam or coolant before you open the hood If you keep driving when the vehicles engine is overheated the liquids in it can cat
151. arch needs e make it available for research where appropriate confidentiality is to be maintained and need is shown or e share summary data which is not tied to a specific vehicle with non GM organizations for research purposes Others such as law enforcement may have access to the special equipment that can read the information if they have access to the vehicle or the device that stores the data If your vehicle has OnStar please check the OnStar subscription service agreement or manual for information on its operations and data collection 492 Collision Damage Repair If your vehicle is involved in a collision and it is damaged have the damage repaired by a qualified technician using the proper equipment and quality replacement parts Poorly performed collision repairs will diminish your vehicle s resale value and safety performance can be compromised in subsequent collisions Collision Parts Genuine GM Collision parts are new parts made with the same materials and construction methods as the parts with which your vehicle was originally built Genuine GM Collision parts are your best choice to assure that your vehicle s designed appearance durability and safety are preserved The use of Genuine GM parts can help maintain your GM New Vehicle Warranty Recycled original equipment parts may also be used for repair These parts are typically removed from vehicles that were total losses in prior accidents
152. arts 475 O Odometer 00 cceeecccceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeseeeeeeeeaeees 187 Odometer Trip ssisise cons sedscasssiensbeawuoddea vanes coats 187 Off Road Recovery cececeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeenaees 335 Oil EDONG maar Sckteeretannctieeeatiatas 377 Engine Oil Pressure Gage ee 200 Life Indicator ccceceeceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 224 Supercharger Engine eeeeeeees 382 Oil Engine Oil Life System 000 ee 380 Older Children Restraints cccccceeeeee ee 28 Online Owner Center cccceeeeeeeeeeeeeees 484 OnStar System fs accncranricidearsancicostntdorrnsiatians 281 OnStar System see OnStar Manual 107 Ordering Map DVDS figacetctastenstcedeseectieecanitndvesntiedee 284 Other Warning Devices ccceeeeeeeeee 140 Outlet Adjustment ceceeeeeeeteeeeeeeeeeeeeeee 184 Outlet s Accessory Power eeeeeeee ees 177 Outside Automatic Dimming Mirror eee 105 Convex Mirror eceececeeeeeceeeeaeeeeeeeeneeees 106 Curb View Assist Mirror eee 106 Power Heated Mirrors eseeeeeeeeneeees 105 Overheated Engine Protection Operating Mode ceeeeeseeetteeeeeeeeees 390 Owner Checks and Services aen 470 Owners Canadian cccccccccecceeeceeeeeeaeeeees 3 507 Paint Damage sipsi iian ia 449 Park AIQ seccse seth les ceecteneiwned sc bokdvives vauwscahioaees 175 Park P Shifting MO sesiscctvet
153. asts traffic announcements You may also receive traffic announcements from stations in the network related to the current station If the current station does not broadcast traffic announcements the audio system will seek to a station which will When the audio system finds a station which broadcasts traffic announcements it will stop If no station is found TA will turn off While a traffic announcement plays the audio system uses TA volume To increase TA volume touch the VOL button on your steering wheel or use the VOL up or down buttons during the announcement See Voice Guidance Volume Settings under Setup Menu on page 243 for more information 295 When a traffic announcement comes on the current radio station or a related network station you will hear it even if the volume is muted or a CD is playing If the audio system tunes to a related network station for a traffic announcement it will return to the original station when the announcement is finished If the CD player was being used the CD will stay in the player and resume play at the point where it stopped Touch RDS followed by TA again to turn TA off MSG Message When RDS is on if the current station has a message MSG will appear on the display Touch MSG from the preset menu to view the message If the whole message does not appear on the display parts of the message will appear every three seconds until the message is completed Once the c
154. ation is complete Press and hold the retractable hardtop button to fully open or close the top 217 TRAC Traction SYSTEM ACTIVE This message displays when the Traction Control System TCS is limiting wheel spin Slippery road conditions may exist if this message is displayed so adjust your driving accordingly This message stays on for a few seconds after the TCS stops limited wheel spin TRAC Traction STABILITRAK OFF This message displays when both the Traction Control System TCS and the StabiliTrak System are off This message will remain until the systems are turned on again TRAC Traction STABILITRAK ON This message displays when both the Traction Control System TCS and the StabiliTrak System are on TRACTION SYSTEM OFF This message displays when the Traction Control System TCS is off but the StabiliTrak System remains on 218 TRACTION SYSTEM ON This message displays when the Traction Control System TCS is on TRUNK AJAR This message displays when the trunk is open while the vehicle is running and is not in PARK P WAIT FOR STABILITRAK This message displays after driving 19 mph 30 km h for 10 seconds if the steering is not centered The StabiliTrak System is not available until the steering centers itself and the STABILITRAK READY message is displayed in the DIC Other Messages Here are more messages that you can receive on your Driver Information Center DIC To
155. ation on page 259 Add Touch Add to add additional waypoints Refer to the steps for adding a waypoint listed previously in this section Calculate Touch Calculate to begin route calculation This feature will only be available if the final destination has been set 256 Editing a Waypoint This feature allows you to edit waypoints that have already been set To edit a waypoint do the following 1 Touch Edit Waypoint 2 Touch the MAP key to view the destination location on the map screen 3 Touch CHANGE ORDER to change the order of the waypoints and the final destination You can also use the map scroll to change a waypoint from one location to another Deleting a Waypoint To delete a waypoint from your route do the following 1 Touch Delete Waypoint 2 Select the waypoint you want to delete A confirmation window will appear 3 Touch YES to delete the waypoint or NO to return to the previous menu Edit Avoid Point Area From this menu you can register edit and delete an area to be avoided while planning a route These areas can also be saved so the system can automatically avoid them when planning a route 2 23AM 85 F FM 105 5 MHz To access the AVOID POINT AREA menu do the following 1 Press the ROUTE key 2 Touch Edit Avoid Point Area Registering an Avoid Point Area To store an avoid point area do the following Touch Register Avoid Point Area Enter a location See
156. attery and maybe other parts too And do not connect the negative cable to the negative terminal on the dead battery because this can cause sparks 405 8 Now connect the black negative cable to Notice If the jumper cables are connected or the negative terminal of the good battery removed in the wrong order electrical Use a remote negative terminal if the shorting may occur and damage the vehicle vehicle has one The repairs would not be covered by your Do not let the other end touch anything until warranty Always connect and remove the next step The other end of the negative the jumper cables in the correct order making cable does not go to the dead battery It sure that the cables do not touch each other goes to a heavy unpainted metal engine part or other metal or to a remote negative terminal on the vehicle with the dead battery 9 Connect the other end of the negative cable at least 18 inches 45 cm away from the dead battery but not near engine parts that move The electrical connection is just as good there and the chance of sparks getting back to the battery is much less 10 Now start the vehicle with the good battery and run the engine for a while 11 Try to start the vehicle that had the dead battery If it will not start after a few tries it probably needs service Jumper Cable Removal A Heavy Unpainted Metal Engine Part B Good Battery C Dead Batter
157. attery has enough water You do not need to add water to the battery installed in your new vehicle But if a battery has filler caps be sure the right amount of fluid is there If it is low add water to take care of that first If you do not explosive gas could be present Battery fluid contains acid that can burn you Do not get it on you If you accidentally get it in your eyes or on your skin flush the place with water and get medical help immediately A CAUTION Fans or other moving engine parts can injure you badly Keep your hands away from moving parts once the engine is running 5 Check that the jumper cables do not have loose or missing insulation If they do you could get a shock The vehicles could be damaged too Before you connect the cables here are some 6 Connect the red positive cable to the basic things you should know Positive positive terminal of the dead battery will go to positive or to a remote positive Use a remote positive terminal if terminal if the vehicle has one Negative the vehicle has one will go to a heavy unpainted metal engine part 7 Do not let the other end touch metal Connect or to a remote negative terminal if the it to the positive terminal of the good vehicle has one battery Use a remote positive terminal if Do not connect positive to negative or the vehicle has one you will get a short that would damage the b
158. ature goes down the outside temperature will be shown when you start the vehicle If it has been turned off for less than three hours the temperature will be recalled from the previous vehicle operation There is also an inside temperature sensor located to the left of the ignition button The automatic climate control system uses this sensor to receive information so if you block or cover it the system will not function properly 182 Defogging and Defrosting Fog on the inside of windows is a result of high humidity moisture condensing on the cool window glass This can be minimized if the climate control system is used properly There are two modes to clear fog or frost from your windshield Use the floor defog mode to clear the windows of fog or moisture and warm the passengers Use defrost to remove fog or frost from the windshield more quickly 43 Floor Defog Press the mode button until the defog mode appears on the display This mode directs the air between the windshield floor outlets and side windows When you select this mode the system turns off recirculation and runs the air conditioning compressor unless the outside temperature is near or below freezing Defrost Press this button to direct most of the air to the windshield with some air directed to the side windows In this mode the system will automatically turn off the recirculation and run the air conditioning compressor unless the outside temper
159. ature is near or below freezing Do not drive the vehicle until all the windows are clear Rear Window Defogger The rear window defogger uses a warming grid to remove fog or frost from the rear window The rear window defogger will only work when the engine is running Gt Rear Window Defogger Press this button to turn the rear window defogger on or off Be sure to clear as much snow from the rear window as possible The rear window defogger will turn off about 10 minutes after the button is pressed when traveling less than 30 mph 48 km h If turned on again the defogger will only run for about five minutes before turning off The defogger can also be turned off by pressing the button again or by turning off the engine The heated outside rearview mirrors will heat to help clear fog or frost from the surface of the mirrors when the rear window defogger is on The rear window defogger and heated mirrors are automatically disabled when the retractable hardtop is moving or down Notice Do not use anything sharp on the inside of the rear window If you do you could cut or damage the warming grid and the repairs would not be covered by your warranty Do not attach a temporary vehicle license tape a decal or anything similar to the defogger grid 183 Outlet Adjustment Passenger Compartment Air Filter Use the thumbwheel to open or close the outlets The passenger compartment air filter removes i certain particles
160. ave you purchased the GM Protection Plan The Plan supplements your new vehicle warranties See your Warranty and Owner Assistance booklet or your dealer for details 462 Maintenance Requirements Notice Maintenance intervals checks inspections replacement parts and recommended fluids and lubricants as prescribed in this manual are necessary to keep your vehicle in good working condition Any damage caused by failure to follow scheduled maintenance may not be covered by warranty Your Vehicle and the Environment Proper vehicle maintenance not only helps to keep your vehicle in good working condition but also helps the environment All recommended maintenance is important Improper vehicle maintenance can even affect the quality of the air we breathe Improper fluid levels or the wrong tire inflation can increase the level of emissions from your vehicle To help protect our environment and to keep your vehicle in good condition be sure to maintain your vehicle properly Using the Maintenance Schedule We at General Motors want to help you keep your vehicle in good working condition But we do not know exactly how you will drive it You may drive very short distances only a few times a week Or you may drive long distances all the time in very hot dusty weather You may use your vehicle in making deliveries Or you may drive it to work to do errands or in many other ways Because of all the different ways people u
161. ayed As you approach the next turn the system will display a closer view of the upcoming maneuver Arrow Select this feature to have the guidance screen display the next turn A directional arrow street name and distance to the turn will be displayed As you approach the turn the system will display a closer view of the upcoming maneuver 2D Select this feature to display the guidance screen as a two dimensional view 3D Select this feature to display the guidance screen as a three dimensional view 247 Map Appearance This menu allows you to set the map appearance screen options The current setting will appear as light blue 1 45AM 85 F 1025 ui 2D Select this feature to display the map as a two dimensional view 3D Select this feature to display the map as a three dimensional view 248 Set 3D Viewing Angle This feature allows you to adjust the 3D viewing angle To do so do the following 1 Touch 3D on the MAP APPEARANCE menu 2 Touch Set 3D Viewing Angle The map screen with the 3D viewing angle bar will be displayed 3 Touch the up or down arrows to set the viewing angle 4 Touch Return to save your settings and to exit this menu or touch Reset to restore the viewing angle to the default setting Voice Guidance Volume Settings This feature allows you to set the voice prompt volume level or to turn voice prompts on or off Set the voice prompt volume level by touching th
162. aypoint location if more than four waypoints have been set Destination Map This command will cause the system to display the map view of the final destination location if one has been set 317 Point of Interest POI Commands The following commands will cause the system to display icons if they are available on the map screen when the map scale is set to a half mile eight tenths km or less Restaurant I m Hungry These commands will cause the system to display restaurant POI icons American Restaurant American Food These commands will cause the system to display American restaurant POI icons Chinese Restaurant Chinese Food These commands will cause the system to display Chinese restaurant POI icons Continental Restaurant Continental Food These commands will cause the system to display Continental restaurant POI icons French Restaurant French Food These commands will cause the system to display French restaurant POI icons Italian Restaurant Italian Food These commands will cause the system to display Italian restaurant POI icons 318 Japanese Restaurant Japanese Food These commands will cause the system to display Japanese restaurant POI icons Mexican Restaurant Mexican Food These commands will cause the system to display Mexican restaurant POI icons Seafood Restaurant Seafood These commands will cause the system to display Seafood restaurant POI icons Other Restaurant Other Food
163. be trapped in the vehicle after an accident if am wearing a safety belt You could be whether you are wearing a safety belt or not But you can unbuckle a safety belt even if you are upside down And your chance of being conscious during and after an accident so you can unbuckle and get out is much greater if you are belted If my vehicle has airbags why should have to wear safety belts Airbags are supplemental systems only so they work with safety belts not instead of them Every airbag system ever offered for sale has required the use of safety belts Even if you are in a vehicle that has airbags you still have to buckle up to get the most protection That is true not only in frontal collisions but especially in side and other collisions 17 Q If am a good driver and I never drive far from home why should wear safety belts A You may be an excellent driver but if you are in an accident even one that is not your fault you and your passenger can be hurt Being a good driver does not protect you from things beyond your control such as bad drivers Most accidents occur within 25 miles 40 km of home And the greatest number of serious injuries and deaths occur at speeds of less than 40 mph 65 km h Safety belts are for everyone How to Wear Safety Belts Properly This part is only for people of adult size Be aware that there are special things to know about safety belts and chi
164. be used as a single music CD player or a video DVD player CD Player To use the player as a single music CD player you must first remove the navigation map DVD While playing a CD in the CD DVD Player the navigation system is not available The message The disc installed is not a map DVD will appear on the display if any of the navigation hard keys are pressed To remove the navigation map DVD and load a music CD use the following steps 1 Start the vehicle 2 Press the TILT hard key until you hear a beep This will open the faceplate of the system 3 If one is loaded the navigation map DVD will eject from the slot 4 Gently remove the navigation map DVD from the slot and return it to its case 305 5 Insert the music CD into the slot The system will pull the CD into the player 6 Press and release the TILT hard key to close the faceplate Notice Shifting out of PARK P with the system s faceplate open will cause the faceplate to close automatically This could cause damage to a CD DVD or the system if it is partially loaded Before shifting out of PARK P make sure that the DVD or CD is loaded properly The vehicle must be shifted back into PARK P to close the faceplate 306 RDS Track 1 01 42 eae TRACKS CD Player Screen Once a music CD is loaded the CD player menu will appear on the display When using the system as a single CD player the CD hard key will alte
165. ble There is a special procedure for checking and changing the transmission fluid Because this procedure is difficult you should have this done at the dealership service department Contact your dealer for additional information or the procedure can be found in the service manual To purchase a service manual see Service Publications Ordering Information on page 497 Notice Use of the incorrect automatic transmission fluid may damage your vehicle and the damages may not be covered by your warranty Always use the automatic transmission fluid listed in Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 473 Change the fluid and filter at the intervals listed in Additional Required Services on page 467 and be sure to use the fluid listed in Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 473 Engine Coolant The cooling system in your vehicle is filled with DEX COOL engine coolant This coolant is designed to remain in your vehicle for five years or 150 000 miles 240 000 km whichever occurs first if you add only DEX COOL extended life coolant The following explains your cooling system and how to add coolant when it is low If you have a problem with engine overheating see Engine Overheating on page 388 A 50 50 mixture of clean drinkable water and DEX COOL coolant will e Giving freezing protection down to 34 F 37 C e Give boiling protection up to 265 F 129 C e Protect against rust and corrosion e Help
166. by dropping back And if something happens to cause you to cancel your pass you need only slow down and drop back again and wait for another opportunity If other vehicles are lined up to pass a slow vehicle wait your turn But take care that someone is not trying to pass you as you pull out to pass the slow vehicle Remember to glance over your shoulder and check the blind spot Check your vehicle s mirrors glance over your shoulder and start your left lane change signal before moving out of the right lane to pass When you are far enough ahead of the passed vehicle to see its front in your vehicle s inside mirror activate the right lane change signal and move back into the right lane Remember that your vehicle s passenger side outside mirror is convex The vehicle you just passed may seem to be farther away from you than it really is e Try not to pass more than one vehicle at a time on two lane roads Reconsider before passing the next vehicle e Do not overtake a slowly moving vehicle too rapidly Even though the brake lamps are not flashing it may be slowing down or starting to turn e If you are being passed make it easy for the following driver to get ahead of you Perhaps you can ease a little to the right Loss of Control Let us review what driving experts say about what happens when the three control systems brakes steering and acceleration do not have enough friction where the tires meet the
167. by your warranty To lift your vehicle properly follow the advice in this part To help prevent vehicle damage e Be sure to place a block or pad between the jack and the vehicle e Make sure the jack you are using spans at least two crossmember ribs e Lift only in the areas shown in the following pictures For additional information see your GM dealer and the Cadillac XLR service manual Lifting From the Front 1 Locate the front lifting points A according to the illustration shown The front lifting points can be accessed from either side of your vehicle behind the front tires 2 Be sure to place a block or pad between the jack and the vehicle 437 Lifting From the Rear 3 Lift the vehicle with the jack making sure the jack spans at least two of the crossmember n ribs B The rear lifting points can be accessed from the rear of the vehicle on either the drivers or passenger s side 438 1 Locate the rear lifting points A according to the illustration shown 2 Be sure to place a block or pad between the jack and the vehicle DE A A Q I 3 Lift the vehicle with the jack making sure the jack spans at least two of the crossmember ribs B For more information see Doing Your Own Service Work on page 364 439 If a Tire Goes Flat It is unusual for a tire to blow out while you are driving especially if you maintain your tires properly If a
168. can make it harder to see road signs and traffic signals pavement markings the edge of the road and even people walking It is wise to keep your windshield wiping equipment in good shape and keep your windshield washer fluid reservoir filled with washer fluid Replace your windshield wiper inserts when they show signs of streaking or missing areas on the windshield or when strips of rubber start to separate from the inserts A CAUTION Wet brakes can cause accidents They may not work as well in a quick stop and may cause pulling to one side You could lose control of the vehicle After driving through a large puddle of water or a car wash apply your brake pedal lightly until your brakes work normally Driving too fast through large water puddles or even going through some car washes can cause problems too The water may affect your brakes Try to avoid puddles But if you cannot try to slow down before you hit them Hydroplaning Hydroplaning is dangerous So much water can build up under your tires that they can actually ride on the water This can happen if the road is wet enough and you are going fast enough When your vehicle is hydroplaning it has little or no contact with the road Hydroplaning does not happen often But it can if your tires do not have much tread or if the pressure in one or more is low It can happen if a lot of water is standing on the road If you can see reflections from trees tele
169. ces Wash the vehicle as soon as possible If necessary use non abrasive cleaners that are marked safe for painted surfaces to remove foreign matter Exterior painted surfaces are subject to aging weather and chemical fallout that can take their toll over a period of years To help keep the paint finish looking new keep the vehicle in a garage or covered whenever possible Windshield and Wiper Blades If the windshield is not clear after using the windshield washer or if the wiper blade chatters when running wax sap or other material may be on the blade or windshield Clean the outside of the windshield with a glass cleaning liquid or powder and water solution The windshield is clean if beads do not form when it is rinsed with water Grime from the windshield will stick to the wiper blades and affect their performance Clean the blade by wiping vigorously with a cloth soaked in full strength windshield washer solvent Then rinse the blade with water Check the wiper blades and clean them as necessary replace blades that look worn 447 Aluminum or Chrome Plated Wheels Your vehicle may have either aluminum or chrome plated wheels Keep the wheels clean using a soft clean cloth with mild soap and water Rinse with clean water After rinsing thoroughly dry with a soft clean towel A wax may then be applied Notice If you use strong soaps chemicals abrasive polishes cleaners brushes or cleaners that contain
170. ch List to view name choices or continue to spell the street name to further reduce the number of available items Select a street name If the street name you entered exists in more than one city on the DVD database a list of cities will appear You can select a city from the list or enter the city name by selecting City As you begin to enter the city name you can select the desired city from the list which will appear or continue to spell the city name to further reduce the number of available items Once the city name has been selected enter the house number using the numeric keypad The system will list the house number range that is available for the street When you have finished entering all of the address information touch Enter to plan your route 261 All Points of Interest This destination entry method allows you to choose a destination from the point of interest POI list Selecting All Points Of Interest from the DESTINATION menu will bring up the alpha keypad While inputting a POI or city name the List option will become available As information is entered the system will search for available POI and city names based on the information given The system will supply a list of names to make a selection from when the choices are five or less 102 5MHz 2 55AM 85 F POINTS OF INTEREST 262 You may search for a POI using the following three methods e Touch NAME to type
171. ch fire You or others could be badly burned Stop your engine if it overheats and get out of the vehicle until the engine is cool See Overheated Engine Protection Operating Mode on page 390 for information on driving to a safe place in an emergency Notice lf your engine catches fire because you keep driving with no coolant your vehicle can be badly damaged The costly repairs would not be covered by your warranty See Overheated Engine Protection Operating Mode on page 390 for information on driving to a safe place in an emergency If No Steam Is Coming From Your Engine An overheat warning along with a low coolant message can indicate a serious problem If you get an engine overheat warning with no low coolant message but see or hear no steam the problem may not be too serious Sometimes the engine can get a little too hot when you e Climb a long hill on a hot day e Stop after high speed driving e Idle for long periods in traffic e Tow a trailer 389 If you get the overheat warning with no sign of steam try this for a minute or so 1 In heavy traffic let the engine idle in NEUTRAL N while stopped If it is safe to do so pull off the road shift to PARK P or NEUTRAL N and let the engine idle 2 Set the climate controls to the highest heat setting and fan speed and open the windows as necessary If you no longer have the overheat warning you can drive Just to be safe drive slower for abo
172. cies provide reduced protection to your GM vehicle by limiting compensation for damage repairs by using aftermarket collision parts Some insurance companies will not specify aftermarket collision parts When purchasing insurance we recommend that you assure your vehicle will be repaired with GM original equipment collision parts If such insurance coverage is not available from your current insurance carrier consider switching to another insurance carrier If your vehicle is leased the leasing company may require you to have insurance that assures repairs with Genuine GM Original Equipment Manufacturer OEM parts or Genuine Manufacturer replacement parts Read your lease carefully as you may be charged at the end of your lease for poor quality repairs 493 If an Accident Occurs Here is what to do if you are involved in an accident e Try to relax and then check to make sure you are all right If you are uninjured make sure that no one else in your vehicle or the other vehicle is injured e If there has been an injury call 911 for help Do not leave the scene of an accident until all matters have been taken care of Move your vehicle only if its position puts you in danger or you are instructed to move it by a police officer e Give only the necessary and requested information to police and other parties involved in the accident Do not discuss your personal condition mental frame of mind or anything unr
173. circulation for long periods of time may cause the air inside your vehicle to become too dry To prevent this from happening after the air in your vehicle has cooled turn the recirculation mode off Sensors There are sensors to measure the temperature and sun s effect on passenger comfort The solar sensor on your vehicle monitors the solar radiation then uses the information to maintain the selected temperature when operating in AUTO mode by initiating needed adjustments to the temperature the fan speed and the air delivery system The system may also supply cooler air to the side of the vehicle facing the sun The recirculation mode will also be activated as necessary Do not cover the solar sensor located on the top of the instrument panel near the windshield or the system will not work properly 181 There is also a sensor located behind the front bumper This sensor reads the outside air temperature and helps maintain the temperature inside the vehicle The outside temperature will be displayed in the navigation system only when the engine is running Any cover on the front of the vehicle could give a false reading of the temperature If the outside temperature goes up the display temperature will not change until e The vehicle s speed is above 15 mph 24 km h for five minutes e The vehicle s speed is above 32 mph 51 km h for two and one half minutes These delays prevent false readings If the temper
174. ck Brake System Warning Light on page 193 327 Let us say the road is wet and you are driving safely Suddenly an animal jumps out in front of you You slam on the brakes and continue braking Here is what happens with ABS A computer senses that wheels are slowing down If one of the wheels is about to stop rolling the computer will separately work the brakes at each wheel 328 ABS can change the brake pressure faster than any driver could The computer is programmed to make the most of available tire and road conditions This can help you steer around the obstacle while braking hard As you brake your computer keeps receiving updates on wheel speed and controls braking pressure accordingly Remember ABS does not change the time you need to get your foot up to the brake pedal or always decrease stopping distance If you get too close to the vehicle in front of you you will not have time to apply your brakes if that vehicle suddenly slows or stops Always leave enough room up ahead to stop even though you have ABS Using ABS Do not pump the brakes Just hold the brake pedal down firmly and let anti lock work for you You may hear a motor or clicking noise and feel the brake pedal move a little during a stop but this is normal Braking in Emergencies With ABS you can steer and brake at the same time In many emergencies steering can help you more than even the very best braking Traction Control Sy
175. cle has averaged since the last time the value was reset To reset the average miles per gallon press the information button to display AVERAGE xx x MPG then press and hold the RESET button until AVERAGE 00 0 MPG is displayed INST xx x MPG Instantaneous Miles Per Gallon This feature shows the instantaneous fuel economy which varies with your driving conditions such as acceleration braking and the grade of the road being traveled The RESET button does not function in this mode AVERAGE SPEED This feature shows the average speed the vehicle has traveled since the last time the value was reset To reset the value press the information button to display AVERAGE SPEED then press and hold the RESET button until AVERAGE SPEED 00 0 is displayed ELAPSED TIME This feature is like a stopwatch in that you can clock the time it takes to get from one point to another To operate press the information button to display ELAPSED TIME Each of the fields for the hours minutes and seconds are two numeric digits Once ELAPSED TIME 00 00 00 is displayed press the RESET button to start the timing feature Press the RESET button again to stop it If you will be starting and stopping your vehicle during a trip for instance the ELAPSED TIME feature will automatically start timing where it left off when you last stopped To reset it press and hold the RESET button until the display reads ELAPSED TIME 00 00 00 Press the information
176. conditions can create a chemical fallout Airborne pollutants can fall upon and attack painted surfaces on the vehicle This damage can take two forms blotchy ring shaped discolorations and small irregular dark spots etched into the paint surface Although no defect in the paint job causes this GM will repair at no charge to the owner the surfaces of new vehicles damaged by this fallout condition within 12 months or 12 000 miles 20 000 km of purchase whichever occurs first Vehicle Care Appearance Materials Description Use Polishing Cloth Interior and exterior Wax Treated polishing cloth Tar and Road Oil Removes tar road oil Remover and asphalt Chrome Cleaner and Use on chrome or Polish stainless steel White Sidewall Tire Removes soil and black Cleaner marks from whitewalls Vinyl Cleaner Cleans vinyl Removes dirt grime Glass Cleaner smoke and fingerprints 450 Description Usas Removes dirt and grime ee and Wire Wheel from chrome wheels and wire wheel covers Removes dust fingerprints and surface contaminants Spray on and wipe off Removes swirl marks fine Swirl Remover Polish scratches and other light surface contamination Cleaner Wax Removes light scratches and protects finish F Cleans shines and ona e Shine protects in one step No wiping necessary Medium foaming shampoo Cleans and lightly waxes Biodegradable and phosphate free Quickly removes spots and s
177. cting replacing the filters 2 Move the clasps on the top of the engine air cleaner filter cover forward to unlatch the cover Lift the front of the cover at an angle and remove This is necessary due to the four tabs located on the rear of the cover Remove the engine air cleaner filter element and any loose debris that might be found in the air cleaner base 383 5 Inspect or replace the filter 6 Repeat the procedure for the second air cleaner filter Reverse the above procedure to reinstall the engine air cleaner filter housings A CAUTION Operating the engine with the air cleaner filter off can cause you or others to be burned The air cleaner not only cleans the air it helps to stop flames if the engine backfires If it is not there and the engine backfires you could be burned Do not drive with it off and be careful working on the engine with the air cleaner filter off Notice If the air cleaner filter is off a backfire can cause a damaging engine fire And dirt can easily get into your engine which will damage it Always have the air cleaner filter in place when you are driving 384 Automatic Transmission Fluid How to Check Automatic Transmission Fluid It is not necessary to check the transmission fluid level A transmission fluid leak is the only reason for fluid loss If a leak occurs take the vehicle to the dealership service department and have it repaired as soon as possi
178. d other parts If you have to add coolant more than four times a year have your dealer check your cooling system Notice If you use extra inhibitors and or additives in your vehicle s cooling system you could damage your vehicle Use only the proper mixture of the engine coolant listed in this manual for the cooling system See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 473 for more information Checking Coolant The engine coolant surge tank is located toward the rear of the engine compartment on the driver s side of the vehicle For more information on location see Engine Compartment Overview on page 374 A CAUTION Turning the surge tank pressure cap when the engine and radiator are hot can allow steam and scalding liquids to blow out and burn you badly Never turn the surge tank pressure cap even a little when the engine and radiator are hot The vehicle must be on a level surface When your engine is cold the coolant level should be at the FULL COLD mark located on the side of the surge tank that faces the front If the LOW COOLANT message on the Driver Information Center DIC comes on and stays on it means you are low on engine coolant See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 206 for more information 387 Adding Coolant If you need more coolant add the proper DEX COOL coolant mixture at the surge tank but only when the engine is cool A CAUTION You can be burned if you spill cool
179. d to the beads are laid at 90 degrees to the centerline of the tread Rim A metal support for a tire and upon which the tire beads are seated Sidewall The portion of a tire between the tread and the bead Speed Rating An alphanumeric code assigned to a tire indicating the maximum speed at which a tire can operate Traction The friction between the tire and the road surface The amount of grip provided Tread The portion of a tire that comes into contact with the road Treadwear Indicators Narrow bands sometimes called wear bars that show across the tread of a tire when only 1 16 inch 1 6 mm of tread remains See When It Is Time for New Tires on page 428 UTQGS Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards A tire information system that provides consumers with ratings for a tire s traction temperature and treadwear Ratings are determined by tire manufacturers using government testing procedures The ratings are molded into the sidewall of the tire See Uniform Tire Quality Grading on page 431 419 Vehicle Capacity Weight The number of designated seating positions multiplied by 150 Ibs 68 kg plus the rated cargo load See Loading Your Vehicle on page 354 Vehicle Maximum Load on the Tire Load on an individual tire due to curb weight accessory weight occupant weight and cargo weight Vehicle Placard A label permanently attached to a vehicle showing the vehicle s capacity weight and the original equipm
180. d to tow a trailer 359 4 NOTES 360 Section 6 Service and Appearance Care SOR VICG iaaea e Ei 363 Accessories and Modifications 0 363 California Proposition 65 Warning 364 Doing Your Own Service Work 0 8 364 Adding Equipment to the Outside of Your Vehicle 00 cece cece ceeee eee eeeeeeeeeaeeeeeeeaaaeeees 365 FueI cniinn eaa n nai 365 Gasoline Octane cceeeceeeeeeeteeeeeeeeeeeeees 366 Gasoline Specifications cceeeeee 366 California Fuel secagem 367 AGUIIVES E T E E ET 367 Fuels in Foreign Countries a e 368 Filling the Tank ssssesssescrrsesnrrrrssrrrrensrrne 369 Filling a Portable Fuel Container 371 Checking Things Under the Hood 372 Hood Release ccececcceeeeeeeeneeeeeeeeeeeeees 373 Engine Compartment Overview 0 374 Engine Olb ccswdedsseteececndeguasgeeeivaeasnceeaneeendeed 377 Engine Oil Life System ees 380 Supercharger Oil cceccseccsssseeeeeeeeeeenee 382 Engine Air Cleaner Filter ceee 382 Automatic Transmission Fluid 00 384 Engine Coolant ssiri cnidevtinenennseveeanes 385 Coolant Surge Tank Pressure Cap 388 Engine Overheating cccceesseeeeeeeeeeees 388 Overheated Engine Protection Operating Mode 390 Cooling System 0 cccceceeeeeeeeeeteeeeeeeeeees 391 Power Steering Fluid ceeeeeeeee
181. d will change the audio system to the XM2 audio source CD Changer This command will change the audio system to the CD changer audio source WX Weather Band These commands will change the audio system to the weather band audio source 314 Power On Audio On These commands will turn the system s power on Power Off Audio Off These commands will turn the system s power off Seek Up This command will cause the selected audio source to seek up to the next strongest signal Seek Down This command will cause the selected audio source to seek down to the next strongest signal Stop Scan This command will cause the audio source to stop scanning for the next strongest signal CD Changer Commands Track Up This command will cause the CD changer to skip up to the next track Previous Track Track Down This command will cause the CD changer to go to the previous track Screen Commands Screen Day Mode Day Mode On These commands will adjust the system s screen setting to the day mode Screen Night Mode Night Mode On These commands will adjust the system s screen setting to the night mode Screen Auto Mode Auto Mode On These commands will adjust the system s screen setting to auto mode Screen Off This command will turn the system s screen display off Position Commands Current Position Current Location Show Current Position Show Current Location These commands will cause the syst
182. d without taking off the cap Look at the brake fluid reservoir The fluid level should be above the MIN mark on the reservoir If it is not have your brake system checked to see if there is a leak After work is done on the brake hydraulic system make sure the level is between the MIN and MAX marks What to Add When you do need brake fluid use only DOT 3 brake fluid Refer to Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 473 Use new brake fluid from a sealed container only Always clean the brake fluid reservoir cap and the area around the cap before removing it This will help keep dirt from entering the reservoir 400 A CAUTION With the wrong kind of fluid in the brake system the brakes may not work well or they may not even work at all This could cause a crash Always use the proper brake fluid Notice e Using the wrong fluid can badly damage brake system parts For example just a few drops of mineral based oil such as engine oil in the brake system can damage brake system parts so badly that they will have to be replaced Do not let someone put in the wrong kind of fluid e If you spill brake fluid on your vehicle s painted surfaces the paint finish can be damaged Be careful not to spill brake fluid on your vehicle If you do wash it off immediately See Washing Your Vehicle on page 446 Brake Wear Your vehicle has four wheel disc brakes Disc brake pads have built in wear indicators that
183. ddevee sect doeeaiee 99 Shifting Out Of cece eeeeeeeeeee eee eeeeeeeeeees 100 Parking PAS SIS Ue cats dashes donee saan cec A Saeed mated 175 BAKC seare eraa a a 97 Over Things That Burn ecce 101 Passenger Airbag Status Indicator 189 Passenger Compartment Air Filter 184 Passenger Position Safety Belts 27 Passenger Sensing System cceeeeeee 53 PASSING sieccetastsctectateesan aude enccueseumeadateeanend sede 335 Plam ROUG iecisie active c ctlstadetstinbavectiieeteni se des 249 Power Accessory Outlet S cceeeeesteeeeeeeeeeeeeee 177 DOOP LOCKS weccsecccsstesccsnentvseestreteeanstetieseneetty 75 Electrical System 452 Lumbar Controls cccceeeeeeeeeeeteeeeeeeeeees 9 Reclining Seatbacks eseeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeee 11 Retained Accessory RAP cce 89 DOA E ivehenctnnengsaavensedeseesienaueebeneeeszas 8 Steering Fluid cesiveesetevnesteveewesesasieeseaweesees 396 508 Power cont Tilt Wheel and Telescopic Steering COMM iicwsicccsenscvncdenvivedeoaerasecseanaceaantens 141 WINGOWS sisadicicsdacsesiacsvenscadiemsasavesatnaresads vas 82 Pretensioners Safety Belt 0 ceeeeeees 27 Problems with Route Guidance 283 Programmable Automatic Door Unlock 76 Q Questions and Answers About Safety Belts 17 R Racing or Other Competitive Driving 338 FRAGIO eao E 285 Personalization wit
184. dealer can prepare the vehicle for inspection 200 Engine Oil Pressure Gage United States Canada The engine oil pressure gage shows the engine oil pressure in psi pounds per square inch or kPa kilopascals when the engine is running Oil pressure should be 20 to 80 psi 140 to 550 kPa In certain situations such as long extended idles on hot days it could read as low as 6 psi 40 kPa and still be considered normal It may vary with engine speed outside temperature and oil viscosity The Driver Information Center DIC may display messages regarding the oil condition See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 206 and Engine Oil on page 377 A CAUTION Do not keep driving if the oil pressure is low If you do your engine can become so hot that it catches fire You or others could be burned Check your oil as soon as possible and have your vehicle serviced Notice Lack of proper engine oil maintenance may damage the engine The repairs would not be covered by your warranty Always follow the maintenance schedule in this manual for changing engine oil Security Light For information regarding this light see Theft Deterrent f Systems on page 84 Fog Lamp Light The fog lamps light will come on when the fog i lamps are in use The light will go out when the fog lamps are turned off See Fog Lamps on page 168 for more information 201 Lights On Reminder This light comes on whenev
185. dealers and all program options such as shuttle service may not be available at every dealer Please contact your dealer for specific information about availability All Courtesy Transportation arrangements will be administered by appropriate dealer personnel Canadian Vehicles For warranty repairs during the Complete Vehicle Coverage period of the General Motors of Canada New Vehicle Limited Warranty alternative transportation may be available under the Courtesy Transportation Program Please consult your dealer for details General Motors reserves the right to unilaterally modify change or discontinue Courtesy Transportation at any time and to resolve all questions of claim eligibility pursuant to the terms and conditions described herein at its sole discretion Vehicle Data Collection and Event Data Recorders Your vehicle like other modern motor vehicles has a number of sophisticated computer systems that monitor and control several aspects of the vehicle s performance Your vehicle uses on board vehicle computers to monitor emission control components to optimize fuel economy to monitor conditions for airbag deployment and if so equipped to provide anti lock braking and to help the driver control the vehicle in difficult driving situations Some information may be stored during regular operations to facilitate repair of detected malfunctions other information is stored only in a crash event by computer systems such as
186. ding Washer Fluid under Windshield Washer Fluid on page 397 Engine Oil If the LOW OIL LEVEL or LOW OIL PRESSURE message on the Driver Information Center DIC appears it means you need to check the engine oil level right away For more information see LOW OIL LEVEL and LOW OIL PRESSURE under DIC Warnings and Messages on page 206 You should check the engine oil level regularly this is an added reminder Checking Engine Oil It is a good idea to check the engine oil every time you get fuel In order to get an accurate reading the oil must be warm and the vehicle must be on level ground The engine oil dipstick handle is a yellow loop See Engine Compartment Overview on page 374 for the location of the engine oil dipstick 1 Turn off the engine and give the oil several minutes to drain back into the oil pan If you do not do this the oil dipstick might not show the actual level 2 Pull out the dipstick and clean it with a paper towel or cloth then push it back in all the way Remove it again keeping the tip down and check the level 377 When to Add Engine Oil S If the oil is below the cross hatched area at the tip of the dipstick you will need to add at least one quart liter of oil But you must use the right kind This section explains what kind of oil to use For engine oil crankcase capacity see Capacities and Specifications on page 458 Notice Do not add too much oil If the engine has so much o
187. displays when the vehicle is reducing engine power because the transmission is being placed in gear under conditions that may cause damage to the vehicle s engine transmission or ability to accelerate Reduced engine power can affect the vehicle s ability to accelerate If this message is on but there is no reduction in performance proceed to your destination The performance may be reduced the next time the vehicle is driven The vehicle may be driven at a reduced speed while this message is on but acceleration and speed may be reduced Anytime this message stays on the vehicle should be taken to your dealer for service as soon as possible RIGHT DOOR AJAR This message displays anytime the engine is running the transmission is not in PARK P and the passenger s door is open or ajar A chime sounds if the vehicle s speed is greater than 3 mph 5 km h 213 SERVICE A C This message displays when the electronic sensors that control the air conditioning and heating systems are no longer working Have the climate control system serviced by your dealer if you notice a drop in heating and air conditioning efficiency SERVICE ABS Anti lock Brake System If this message displays when you are driving stop as soon as possible and turn the ignition off Then start the engine again to reset the system If the message stays on or comes back on again while you are driving your vehicle is in need of service See your
188. driver s door the driver preferences for the lowest driver number will be recalled If a keyless access transmitter is programmed as 3 or 4 the personalization system will not recognize the transmitter The Driver Information Center DIC will not display a current 220 driver number and the features that are normally programmed through the DIC will be set to the default states Also if the OPTIONS button is pressed the DIC does not display the menus used to set personalizations but instead displays OPTIONS UNAVAILABLE for a few seconds Feature Programming To change feature preferences make sure the vehicle is running and in PARK P To avoid excessive drain on the battery it is recommended that the headlamps are turned off Press the OPTIONS button and the Driver Information Center DIC will display the current driver for a few seconds then display the first personalization menu item You can now use the OPTIONS button to change the setting of the displayed feature Press the top or bottom of the information button to scroll up or down the list of features When you get to a feature you want to change press the OPTIONS button again When you are finished press the RESET button to exit the personalization menu If no button is pressed within 45 seconds the DIC will exit the personalization menu The following are DIC options that will be available in the personalization menu Auto Recall This feature allow
189. ds D Tire Identification Number TIN The letters and numbers following DOT code are the Tire Identification Number TIN The TIN shows the manufacturer and plant code tire size and date the tire was manufactured The TIN is molded onto both sides of the tire although only one side may have the date of manufacture 415 E Tire Ply Material The type of cord and number of plies in the sidewall and under the tread F Uniform Tire Quality Grading UTQG Tire manufacturers are required to grade tires based on three performance factors treadwear traction and temperature resistance For more information see Uniform Tire Quality Grading on page 431 G Maximum Cold Inflation Load Limit Maximum load that can be carried and the maximum pressure needed to support that load Tire Size The following illustration shows an example of a typical passenger p metric vehicle tire size P225 60R16 97S 416 A Passenger P Metric Tire The United States version of a metric tire sizing system The letter P as the first character in the tire size means a passenger vehicle tire engineered to standards set by the U S Tire and Rim Association B Tire Width The three digit number indicates the tire section width in millimeters from sidewall to sidewall C Aspect Ratio A two digit number that indicates the tire height to width measurements For example if the tire size aspect ratio is 60 as shown in item C
190. e Compartment Overview on page 374 for the location of the windshield washer fluid reservoir Also see Windshield Washer Fluid on page 397 for more information MAX Maximum SPEED XX MPH XX KM H This message displays when a failure in the magnetic ride control system has occurred The Powertrain Control Module PCM determines the speed to which your vehicle is limited Have your vehicle serviced by your dealer if this message appears 211 NO FOB DETECTED This message displays if the vehicle does not detect the presence of a keyless access transmitter when you have attempted to start the vehicle or a vehicle door has just closed The following conditions may cause this message to appear e Driver added equipment plugged into the accessory power outlet on the center console is causing interference Examples of these devices are cell phones and cell phone chargers two way radios power inverters or similar items Try moving the keyless access transmitter away from these devices when starting the vehicle In addition PDA devices and remote garage and gate openers may also generate Electromagnetic Interference EMI that may interfere with the keyless access transmitter Do not carry the keyless access transmitter in the same pocket or bag as these devices e The vehicle is experiencing Electromagnetic Interference EMI Some locations such as airports automatic toll booths and some gas stations have EMI fields which
191. e numbered buttons to increase or decrease the volume level You may also choose to turn the voice prompts off Then touch Return to save your setting and to return to the SETUP MENU If a voice prompt is active while the audio system is on the audio system volume will decrease and the voice prompt will be heard through the driver s side front speaker Voice prompts will not be heard while using voice recognition Plan Route To plan a route press the ROUTE key The PLAN ROUTE menu will be displayed 2 33AM 85 F Ent f Destination EB e Preference GRD Edit Avoid Point Area You may use one of several destination entry methods to plan a route See Enter Destination on page 259 for more information 249 Edit Memory Point This feature allows you to store delete and edit memory points Touch the Edit Memory Point screen button from the PLAN ROUTE menu to access the EDIT MEMORY POINT screen EM2 402 5 MHz _ M 85 F EDIT MEMORY POINT You can store memory points in four different categories personal business entertainment and marked point 250 Memory points are stored when you select either START or MARK when setting a destination on the map or when you are storing destinations in memory A total of 60 locations can be stored The last 10 destinations entered will be stored under Previous Destination In addition one memory point can be stored under the Home category
192. e 284 Navigation Audio System Notice Before adding any sound equipment to your vehicle such as an audio system CD player CB radio mobile telephone or two way radio make sure that it can be added by checking with your dealer Also check federal rules covering mobile radio and telephone units If sound equipment can be added it is very important to do it properly Added sound equipment may interfere with the operation of your vehicle s engine radio or other systems and even damage them Your vehicle s systems may interfere with the operation of sound equipment that has been added Your vehicle has a feature called Retained Accessory Power RAP With RAP the audio system can be played even after the ignition is turned off See Retained Accessory Power RAP on page 89 for more information The audio system is operated using navigation system menus The audio menus are explained in this section Main Audio Menu 2 L Audio Adjust Press this key to view the main audio screen 285 Preset Selection Here you can program the audio system s presets to recall your home settings by touching HOME You can also recall the presets you use when traveling to another area by touching AWAY See Preset Station Menu later in this section for more information on how to store preset stations The Home and Away feature is not available for the XM Satellite Radio source if equipped 286 Dis
193. e Storage Area There is a center console storage area located between the seats To open this storage area push the latch button and lift the lid There is also an upright center console storage area between the seatbacks To open the storage area press and release the button near the top so it extends out Then turn the button in either direction to unlatch the lid and pull the console lid down After you close the lid press the release button back in Map Pocket The map storage pockets are located on each door behind a cover 122 Floor Mats The driver s side floor mat is held in place by two snaps and the passenger s side is held in place by one Remove and Replace the Floor Mats To remove the floor mats pull up on the rear of the mat to disconnect from the snaps To reinstall the floor mats line up the openings in the floor mat over the snaps and push down into place Be sure that the drivers side floor mat is properly placed on the floor so that it does not block the movement of the accelerator pedal Rear Storage Area a ARF AIHH a HTHH AES FLLLLFTLTETETLD There is a cargo divider located in the trunk to keep cargo from getting in the way of the retractable hardtop The cargo divider must be in place for the top to move To install the cargo divider snap the bottom of the divider onto the snaps B located on the floor of the trunk Then pull the divider up and place the pins on
194. e called methylcyclopentadienyl manganese tricarbonyl MMT ask the attendant where you buy gasoline whether the fuel contains MMT General Motors recommends against the use of such gasolines Fuels containing MMT can reduce the life of spark plugs and the performance of the emission control system may be affected The malfunction indicator lamp may turn on If this occurs return to your dealer for service Fuels in Foreign Countries If you plan on driving in another country outside the United States or Canada the proper fuel may be hard to find Never use leaded gasoline or any other fuel not recommended in the previous text on fuel Costly repairs caused by use of improper fuel would not be covered by your warranty To check the fuel availability ask an auto club or contact a major oil company that does business in the country where you will be driving Filling the Tank A CAUTION Fuel vapor burns violently and a fuel fire can cause bad injuries To help avoid injuries to you and others read and follow all the instructions on the pump island Turn off your engine when you are refueling Do not smoke if you are near fuel or refueling your vehicle Keep sparks flames and smoking materials away from fuel Do not leave the fuel pump unattended when refueling your vehicle This is against the law in some The fuel door release places Keep children away from the fuel button is located on the The tethered
195. e cap properly installed should turn the light off Did you just drive through a deep puddle of water If so your vehicle s electrical system may be wet The condition will usually be corrected when the electrical system dries out A few driving trips should turn the light off Have you recently changed brands of fuel If so be sure to fuel your vehicle with quality fuel See Gasoline Octane on page 366 Poor fuel quality will cause the engine not to run as efficiently as designed You may notice this as stalling after start up stalling when you put the vehicle into gear misfiring hesitation on acceleration or stumbling on acceleration These conditions may go away once the engine is warmed up This will be detected by the system and cause the light to turn on If you experience one or more of these conditions change the fuel brand you use It will require at least one full tank of the proper fuel to turn the light off If none of the above steps have made the light turn off your dealer can check the vehicle Your dealer has the proper test equipment and diagnostic tools to fix any mechanical or electrical problems that may have developed Emissions Inspection and Maintenance Programs Some state provincial and local governments have or may begin programs to inspect the emission control equipment on your vehicle Failure to pass this inspection could prevent you from getting a vehicle registration Here are s
196. e control at a desired speed and then you apply the brake This disengages the cruise control But it does not need to be reset Once you are going about 25 mph 40 km h or more you can move the cruise control switch briefly from on to resume accelerate You will go right back up to your chosen speed and stay there If you hold the switch at resume accelerate the vehicle will keep going faster until you release the switch or apply the brake Do not hold the switch at resume accelerate unless you want the vehicle to go faster Increasing Speed While Using Cruise Reducing Speed While Using Cruise Control Control e Press and hold the set button until you reach the lower speed desired then release it There are two ways to go to a higher speed e Use the accelerator pedal to get to the higher speed Press the set button at the end of the lever then release the button and the accelerator pedal You will now cruise at the higher speed If the accelerator pedal is To slow down in very small amounts briefly press the set button Each time you do this your vehicle will go about 1 mph 1 6 km h slower held longer than 60 seconds cruise control will turn off e Move the cruise switch from on to resume accelerate Hold it there until you get up to the desired speed and then release the switch To increase your speed in very small amounts move the switch briefly to resume accelerate Each time you do this your vehicle w
197. e following 1 Press the ROUTE hard key 2 Press the Route Preference screen button 3 Press the Cancel Route screen button 4 Press the Yes screen button to confirm cancellation Guidance Volume To adjust the volume of voice guidance prompts do the following 1 Press the MENU hard key 2 Press the ON screen button to turn voice volume on 3 Select the desired volume or select the OFF screen button The system will play back the new volume level See Voice Guidance Volume Settings under Setup Menu on page 243 for more information 240 Features and Controls Using the Navigation System This section presents basic information you will need to know to operate the navigation system Use the keys located on each side of the navigation screen as well as the available touch sensitive screen buttons to operate the system See Navigation System Overview on page 232 for more information on location Once the vehicle is moving various functions will be disabled to reduce driver distraction Hard Keys The following hard keys are located to the left of the navigation screen BAND Press the BAND key to access the band screen and switch between AM FM1 FM2 XM1 XM2 and WX if equipped See Finding a Station under Navigation Audio System on page 285 CD Press the CD key to play a CD The CD screen will be displayed See Six Disc CD Changer on page 302 or CD DVD Player on page 305 DVD Pres
198. e footnote h Check engine coolant and windshield washer fluid levels If you have the 4 4L V8 supercharged engine check intercooler fluid level Add fluid as needed Perform any needed additional services See Additional Required Services in this section spect wiper blades See oomo O O Oo To ooo inspect restraint system components See oomo 9 T F Lubricate body components See toome T J F Replace passenger compartment arfiter See omor fey 466 Additional Required Services The following services should be performed at the first maintenance service I or II after the indicated miles kilometers shown for each item Additional Required Services Service and Miles Kilometers 25 000 50 000 75 000 100 000 125 000 150 000 40 000 80 000 120 000 160 000 200 000 240 000 Inspect fuel system for damage or leaks Inspect exhaust system for loose or damaged components Replace engine air cleaner filter See Engine Air Cleaner Filter on page 382 Change automatic transmission fluid and filter severe service See footnote f Change automatic transmission fluid and filter normal service 4 4L Supercharged Engine Supercharger service See footnote I 467 Additional Required Services cont d Service and Miles Kilometers 25 000 50 000 75 000 100 000 125 000 150 000 ners ee 40 000 80000 120 000 160 000 200 000 240 000 Replace spa
199. e has an electronic keyless ignition with pushbutton start ENGINE O Ace e e Q START Press this button while your foot is on the brake to start the engine The shifter must be in PARK P or NEUTRAL N to start the engine and the keyless access transmitter must be in the vehicle for the ignition to work Acc OFF ACCESSORY When this button is pressed the engine will turn off even if the shifter is not in PARK P If the shifter is in PARK P the ignition mode will change to Retained Accessory Power RAP if all doors are closed The ignition mode will change to OFF if a front door is opened 88 See Retained Accessory Power RAP on page 89 for more information If the shifter is not in PARK P the ignition mode will change to Acc Accessory See Shifting Into Park P on page 99 When the engine is off press this button to place the vehicle in accessory mode ACCESSORY MODE ON will display on the Driver Information Center DIC This mode allows you to use things like the radio and the windshield wipers while the engine is off Use accessory mode if you must have your vehicle in motion while the engine is off for example if your vehicle is being towed If the door is open while in accessory mode the key in reminder chime will sound continuously If the push button start is not working your vehicle may be near a strong radio antenna signal causing interference to the keyless access system See D C Wa
200. e off and a chime will sound See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 206 for more information Engine Coolant Temperature Gage Canada United States This gage shows the engine coolant temperature As the pointer nears 260 F 125 C your engine coolant temperature is high A message may display on the Driver Information Center DIC depending on how high the temperature is See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 206 for more information See Engine Overheating on page 388 for more information 195 Tire Pressure Light This light will come on briefly when you turn the ignition on This light will also come on when one or more of your tires are significantly underinflated A LOW TIRE PRESS DIC message will accompany the light see Other Messages on page 219 for more information 196 Stop and check your tires as soon as it is safe to do so If underinflated inflate to the proper pressure See Tires on page 413 for more information This light will flash for about 60 seconds and then turn on solid if a problem is detected with the Tire Pressure Monitor system See Tire Pressure Monitor System on page 423 for more information Malfunction Indicator Lamp Check Engine Light Your vehicle has a computer which monitors operation of the fuel ignition and emission control systems This system is called OBD II On Board Diagnostics Second Generation and is intended to assure that emissions are at acce
201. e or an overpass may remain icy when the surrounding roads are clear If you see a patch of ice ahead of you brake before you are on it Try not to brake while you are actually on the ice and avoid sudden steering maneuvers e Tie a red cloth to your vehicle to alert police that you have been stopped by the snow e Put on extra clothing or wrap a blanket around you If you do not have blankets or extra clothing make body insulators from newspapers burlap bags rags floor mats anything you can wrap around yourself or tuck under your clothing to keep warm 351 A CAUTION Snow can trap exhaust gases under your vehicle This can cause deadly CO carbon monoxide gas to get inside CO could overcome you and kill you You cannot see it or smell it so you might not know it is in your vehicle Clear away snow from around the base of your vehicle especially any that is blocking your exhaust pipe And check around again from time to time to be sure snow does not collect there You can run the engine to keep warm but be Open a window just a little on the side of careful the vehicle that is away from the wind This will help keep CO out Run your engine only as long as you must This saves fuel When you run the engine make it go a little faster than just idle That is push the accelerator slightly This uses less fuel for the heat that you get and it keeps the battery charged 352 You will need a well charged
202. e passenger vehicles Load Index An assigned number ranging from 1 to 279 that corresponds to the load carrying capacity of a tire Maximum Inflation Pressure The maximum air pressure to which a cold tire may be inflated The maximum air pressure is molded onto the sidewall Maximum Load Rating The load rating for a tire at the maximum permissible inflation pressure for that tire Maximum Loaded Vehicle Weight The sum of curb weight accessory weight vehicle capacity weight and production options weight Normal Occupant Weight The number of occupants a vehicle is designed to seat multiplied by 150 Ibs 68 kg See Loading Your Vehicle on page 354 Occupant Distribution Designated seating positions Outward Facing Sidewall The side of an asymmetrical tire that has a particular side that faces outward when mounted on a vehicle The side of the tire that contains a whitewall bears white lettering or bears manufacturer brand and or model name molding that is higher or deeper than the same moldings on the other sidewall of the tire Passenger P Metric Tire A tire used on passenger cars and some light duty trucks and multipurpose vehicles Recommended Inflation Pressure Vehicle manufacturer s recommended tire inflation pressure as shown on the tire placard See Inflation Tire Pressure on page 422 and Loading Your Vehicle on page 354 Radial Ply Tire A pneumatic tire in which the ply cords that exten
203. e preset station menu will appear 3 Tune to the desired station by using the TUNE SEEK arrows 4 Touch SOUND to set the bass mid range treble and DSP for your preset if desired See Sound Menu later in this section for more information 5 Touch and hold one of the six numbered preset buttons for more than two seconds until you hear a beep 6 Repeat the steps for each preset and source SCAN To scan stations touch SCAN The radio will go to a station play for a few seconds then go on to the next station Touch SCAN again to stop scanning To scan preset stations touch and hold SCAN for two seconds It will only scan the audio source it is in with the exception of FM 1 and FM 2 which will both be scanned if in that source Touch SCAN again to stop scanning RDS Radio Data System See Radio Data System RDS later in this section for more information MSG Message See Radio Data System RDS later in this section for more information AutoSet Touch AutoSet to replace currently stored preset stations with the strongest stations available in the immediate area Touch AutoSet again to return to the original preset stations SOUND See Sound Menu following for more information DSP See Adjusting the Speakers later in this section for more information Sound Menu Touch SOUND at the bottom of the main audio screen source menu or DSP menu to chan
204. e regular bake 2 Press the Acc button twice to place the ignition in accessory mode 3 Apply and hold the brake until the end of Step 4 4 Shift to NEUTRAL N 5 Start the engine and then shift to the drive gear you want 6 Have your vehicle inspected by your dealer as soon as possible A CAUTION Things that can burn could touch hot exhaust parts under your vehicle and ignite Do not park over papers leaves dry grass or other things that can burn 101 Engine Exhaust A CAUTION Engine exhaust can kill It contains the gas carbon monoxide CO which you cannot see or smell It can cause unconsciousness and death You might have exhaust coming in if e Your exhaust system sounds strange or different e Your vehicle gets rusty underneath e Your vehicle was damaged in a collision CAUTION Continued 102 CAUTION Continued e Your vehicle was damaged when driving over high points on the road or over road debris e Repairs were not done correctly e Your vehicle or exhaust system has been modified improperly If you ever suspect exhaust is coming into your vehicle e Drive it only with all the windows down to blow out any CO and e Have your vehicle fixed immediately Running the Engine While Parked It is better not to park with the engine running But if you ever have to here are some things to know A CAUTION Idling the engine with the climate control sy
205. e the fascia lens and clean the inside of the fascia lens and radar lens 164 To clean the inside of the fascia lens and radar lens insert a tool into one of the small slots on the inboard side of the lens and pop the lens out Clean the surface with a 50 50 mixture of isopropyl alcohol and water on a dampened cloth After cleaning the lens set the lens back in place and press until it snaps in Exterior Lamps The exterior lamp control is located to the left of the steering wheel on the multifunction lever Exterior Lamp Control Turn the band with this symbol on it to operate the exterior lamps The exterior lamp band has four positions Off Turning the band to this position turns off all lamps AUTO Automatic Turning the band to this position sets the exterior lamps in automatic mode AUTO mode will turn the exterior lamps on and off depending on how much light is available outside the vehicle Turning the band to AUTO mode also enables the Adaptive Forward Lighting system See Adaptive Forward Lighting System on page 167 To override AUTO mode turn the control to off To reset to AUTO mode turn the control to exterior lamps and then back to AUTO Automatic mode will also reset when your vehicle is turned off and then back on again when the control is left in the AUTO position See Twilight Sentinel on page 168 200 Parking Lamp Turning the band to this position turns on the parking lamps
206. e to follow the instructions that came with the child restraint Secure the child in the child restraint when and as the instructions say 1 Your vehicle has a right front passenger s frontal airbag See Passenger Sensing System on page 53 We recommend that rear facing child restraints not be transported in your vehicle even if the airbags are off If your child restraint is forward facing move the seat as far back as it will go before securing the child restraint in this seat See Power Seats on page 8 When the passenger sensing system has turned off the right front passenger s frontal airbag and side impact airbag the off indicator in the passenger airbag status indicator should light and stay lit when the vehicle is started See Passenger Airbag Status Indicator on page 189 2 Put the child restraint on the seat 41 3 Pick up the latch plate and run the lap and shoulder portions of the vehicle s safety belt through or around the restraint The child restraint instructions will show you how 4 Buckle the belt Make sure the release button is positioned so you would be able to unbuckle the safety belt quickly if you ever had to 42 5 Pull the rest of the shoulder belt all the way out of the retractor to set the lock To tighten the belt push down on the child restraint pull the shoulder portion of the belt to tighten the lap portion of the belt and feed the shoulder belt back into the retrac
207. e to keep interior noise levels to a minimum Otherwise the system might not recognize voice commands The system will only recognize commands spoken in English Voice Recognition Commands The following list shows all of the voice commands available for the navigation system with a brief description of each To use the voice commands refer to the instructions listed previously Help Commands These commands are universal and will enable you to use the help prompts available from the system Map Help This command will enable the system to provide the available commands for the map screen Destination Help This command will enable the system to provide the available commands for entering a destination Guidance Help This command will enable the system to provide the available commands for the guidance method Radio Help This command will enable the system to provide the available commands for the radio Disc Help This command will enable the system to provide the available commands for the CD changer 313 Radio Commands Radio This command will change the audio system to the next radio audio source AM This command will change the audio system to the AM audio source FM1 This command will change the audio system to the FM1 audio source FM2 This command will change the audio system to the FM2 audio source XM1 This command will change the audio system to the XM1 audio source XM2 This comman
208. e working properly Look for any other loose or damaged safety belt system parts If you see anything that might keep a safety belt system from doing its job have it repaired See Care of Safety Belts on page 445 for more information Torn or frayed safety belts may not protect you in a crash They can rip apart under impact forces If a belt is torn or frayed get a new one right away Also look for any opened or broken airbag covers and have them repaired or replaced The airbag system does not need regular maintenance 60 Notice If you damage the covering for the driver s or the passenger s airbag or the airbag covering on the driver s and passenger s seatback the airbag may not work properly You may have to replace the airbag module in the steering wheel both the airbag module and the instrument panel for the passenger s airbag or both the airbag module and seatback for the driver s and passenger s side impact airbag Do not open or break the airbag coverings Replacing Restraint System Parts After a Crash A CAUTION A crash can damage the restraint systems in your vehicle A damaged restraint system may not properly protect the person using it resulting in serious injury or even death in a crash To help make sure your restraint systems are working properly after a crash have them inspected and any necessary replacements made as soon as possible If you have had a crash do you need new belt
209. eading lamps console or glove box lamps are accidentally left on or something is left plugged into the accessory power outlet or cigarette lighter If any of the accessory lamps are left on they will automatically time out after about 20 minutes To reset the battery protection all of the above lamps must be turned off or the ignition must be in the Acc position Head Up Display HUD A CAUTION If the HUD image is too bright or too high in your field of view it may take you more time to see things you need to see when it is dark outside Be sure to keep the HUD image dim and placed low in your field of view The Head Up Display HUD allows you to see some of the driver information that appears on your instrument panel cluster The information may be displayed in English or metric units and appears as an image focused out toward the front of your vehicle To change from English to metric units see Driver Information Center DIC on page 203 171 The HUD consists of the following information e Speedometer e Turn Signal Indicators e High Beam Indicator Symbol e Tap Up Tap Down Transmission Feature e Check Gages Icon e Adaptive Cruise Control Features and Indicators e Radio Features Be sure to continue scanning your displays controls and driving environment just as you would in a vehicle without HUD If you never look at your instrument panel cluster you may not see something important such as a wa
210. eat Step 1 as this will erase all previous programming from the Universal Home Remote buttons 120 Gate Operator and Canadian Programming Canadian radio frequency laws require transmitter signals to time out or quit after several seconds of transmission This may not be long enough for Universal Home Remote to pick up the signal during programming Similarly some U S gate operators are manufactured to time out in the same manner If you live in Canada or you are having difficulty programming a gate operator or garage door opener by using the Programming Universal Home Remote procedures regardless of where you live replace Step 3 under Programming Universal Home Remote with the following Continue to press and hold the Universal Home Remote button while you press and release every two seconds cycle the hand held transmitter button until the frequency signal has been successfully accepted by the Universal Home Remote The Universal Home Remote indicator light will flash slowly at first and then rapidly Proceed with Step 4 under Programming Universal Home Remote to complete Using Universal Home Remote Press and hold the appropriate Universal Home Remote button for at least half of a second The indicator light will come on while the signal is being transmitted Erasing Universal Home Remote Buttons To erase programming from the three Universal Home Remote buttons do the following 1 Press a
211. eature On some vehicles the mute button can be used to dial numbers into voicemail systems or to dial phone extensions See the OnStar Owner s Guide for more information How OnStar Service Works In order to provide you with OnStar services your vehicle s OnStar system has the capability of recording and transmitting vehicle information This information is automatically sent to an OnStar Call Center at the time of an OnStar button press Emergency button press or if your airbags or AACN system deploys The vehicle information usually includes your GPS location and in the event of a crash additional information regarding the accident that your vehicle has been involved in e g the direction from which your vehicle was hit When you use the Virtual Advisor feature of OnStar Hands Free Calling your vehicle also sends OnStar your GPS location so that we can provide you with location based services 109 OnStar service cannot work unless your vehicle is in a place where OnStar has an agreement with a wireless service provider for service in that area OnStar service also cannot work unless you are in a place where the wireless service provider OnStar has hired for that area has coverage network capacity and reception when the service is needed and technology that is compatible with the OnStar service Not all services are available everywhere particularly in remote or enclosed areas or at all tim
212. eature If you want to stop the window as it is raising press the switch again Express Window Anti Pinch Feature If any object is in the path of the window when the express up is active the window will stop at the obstruction and auto reverse to a preset factory position Weather conditions such as severe icing may also cause the window to auto reverse The window will return to normal operation once the obstruction or condition is removed A CAUTION If express override is activated the window will not reverse automatically You or others could be injured and the window could be damaged Before you use express override make sure that all people and obstructions are clear of the window path Express Window Anti Pinch Override In an emergency the anti pinch feature can be overridden in a supervised mode Hold the window switch all the way down in the express position The window will rise for as long as the switch is held Once the switch is released the express mode is re activated In this mode the window can still close on an object in its path Use care when using the override mode 83 Window Indexing This feature automatically lowers the window a small amount when the door is opened Then when the door is closed the window will raise to its full up position Sun Visors Notice Raising or lowering the retractable hardtop with the visor or the visor vanity mirror cover up may cause damage to
213. eck 5 13AM 85 e a Lh i poe N Whole This option allows you to view the entire planned route The distance to destination will be displayed on the map screen Touch Return when finished Dest Destination Map This option allows you to view the final destination location The destination s name or address will be displayed on the map screen Touch Return when finished 278 RDS TP Fm1 LiteRock TURN LIST PTY MSG Soft Rek 2 11PM 85 F Woi o a p gt W SQUARE LAKE RD O7 us P CROOKS RD Ry W SQUARE LAKE RD Turn List This option allows you to view a step by step listing of upcoming street names the distance that you will travel on the road and turns you will need to make during your planned route After touching Turn List the system may take some time to create the list The length of time will vary depending on the length of your route and the planning methods you have selected The turn list will read from bottom to top The bottom street name is the street you are currently on The system automatically updates this screen as you make each turn You may also touch the scroll up and down arrows providing scroll is available Touching the down arrow will bring you to your current location Touching the up arrow will give you upcoming streets At times there may not be names available for entrance or exit ramps To avoid a turn touch AVOID next to the turn you
214. ections later in this section You can set up to 12 PTYs 6 FM 1 and 6 FM2 To save a PTY preset do the following 1 Touch FM1 or FM2 Touch RDS to enter the RDS menu Touch RDS ON OFF to turn RDS on Touch PTY Touch SEL PTY and select the desired PTY from the list 6 Touch and hold one of the six presets for more than two seconds until you hear a beep Whenever you touch that numbered preset for less than two seconds the PTY you set will return 7 Repeat the steps for each preset aR WwW PY Once you have stored a PTY for each of your preset stations you can recall a PTY preset by touching the preset station for less than two seconds Then use TUNE SEEK or SCAN to locate a station for that PTY selection ALERT This type of announcement warns of national or local emergencies You will not be able to turn off alert announcements Alert announcements will come on even if RDS mode is turned off ALERT appears on the display when an alert announcement plays The audio system uses TA volume during these announcements To increase volume touch the VOL button on your steering wheel or use the VOL up and down buttons during the announcement See Voice Guidance Volume Settings under Setup Menu on page 243 for more information When an alert announcement comes on the tuned radio station or a related network station you will hear it even if the volume is muted or a CD is playing If the audio system tunes t
215. edentenes sss 435 Chemical Paint Spotting 0 ceeeee 450 Lifting Your Vehicle aseeseen 435 Vehicle Care Appearance Materials 450 If a Tire Goes Flat eee eee teeeees 440 Vehicle Identification cccceeees 451 Appearance Care ccceeeseeesteeeeees 441 Vehicle Identification Number VIN 451 Cleaning the Inside of Your Vehicle 441 Service Parts Identification Label 451 Fa bric CaPetai ennea 443 Electrical System ccccccccseseseseseseeeeeeee 452 Leather n eetertrerertretereterenenenerenene 444 Add On Electrical Equipment 000 00 452 Instrument Panel Vinyl and Other Windshield Wiper Fuses seee 452 Plastic Surfaces 444 Power Windows and Other Power Wood Panels ssssssssssssssrisssnninsrnrnnsnnnnentn s 445 OPONS rinaosna yai 452 Sp aker COVERS deirsdstinanerssainapcasdvnrecesaavanes 445 Fuses and Circuit Breakers ccccccccecccceeeee 453 Care of Safety Belts A army Shavains eeScmrbrane is de Rb avi oie e Sits 445 Instrument Panel Fuse Block eaten ound E E 453 P be a ea ee Underhood Fuse Block cccceccecereeeees 455 ashing Your Vehicle ceceeeeeeeeeees signet Cleaning Exterior Lamps Lenses 446 Capacities and Specifications 458 Finish Care esssssesssrsrersesrsrrrrrrrrresesrens 447 362 Service Your dealer knows your vehicle best and wants you to be happy wi
216. edestrians bicyclists or pets CAUTION Continued 175 How the System Works URPA comes on automatically when the shift lever is moved into REVERSE R and the vehicle speed is less than 3 mph 5 km h When the system comes on the three lights on the display will illuminate to let you know that the system is working URPA senses how close your vehicle is to an object The distance is determined by the four ultrasonic sensors located on the rear bumper When you shift into REVERSE R and an object is detected the following will occur in sequence depending on the distance from the object e At 5 feet 1 5 m a chime will sound and one amber light will be lit e at 40 inches 1 0 m both amber lights will be lit e at 20 inches 0 5 m a continuous chime will sound and all three lights amber amber red will be lit and e at1 foot 0 3 m a continuous chime will sound and all three lights amber amber red will flash URPA can detect objects 3 inches 7 6 cm and wider and at least 10 inches 25 4 cm tall but it cannot detect objects that are above trunk 176 level In order for the rear sensors to recognize an object it must be within operating range If the URPA system is not functioning properly the display will flash red indicating that there is a problem The light will also flash red while driving if a trailer is attached to your vehicle or a bicycle or object is on the back of or hanging out of your trunk T
217. eeeeeeeeeeeaeeeees 28 Securing a Child Restraint in the Passenger Seat Position 0c 40 Cigarette Lighter cceeeseeestteeeeeeeeeeees 178 Cleaning Aluminum or Chrome Plated Wheels 448 Exterior Lamps Lenses c ecereeeeeees 446 Fabric Carpet voissa aaia 443 Finish Care seiscacccsuicdencsdeedcendsancndcamecveceonas 447 Inside of Your Vehicle esene 441 Instrument Panel Vinyl and Other Plastic MUMACES sctsiisSecdvuaiieccmsasceetiestuapecesehnerhesst 444 Leather sccsdinciideessstiverecaseeicsersdecesnenveeseads 444 Speaker Covers cceceeeeeeeneeeeeeeeeeeeees 445 MIKES ekaa aiaa e aa ea sae gents 449 Underbody Maintenance l a 449 Cleaning cont Washing Your Vehicle seese 446 WeatherstripS ccecceseseeeeeeneeeeseeeeeeeees 445 Windshield and Wiper Blades 447 Wood Panel c sisccccssuecasasbvieeecaaitadecaeeas 445 Climate Control System Air Filter Passenger Compartment 184 DUAL criure aa 178 Outlet Adjustment 0 ceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 184 Collision Damage Repair a se 492 Competitive Driving Racing or Other 338 Control of a Vehicle cccceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeee 326 Convenience Net cceceeeeetseeeeeeeeeeeeeeeas 123 Coolant Engine Temperature Gage eee 195 Surge Tank Pressure Cap eese 388 Cooled Seats ii cetsusgesevigectawereeereettuansavesiveencttens 9 Cooling System
218. eering column control Two personalized exit positions can be set by first recalling the driving position by pressing 1 or 2 then positioning the steering wheel and seat in the desired exit positions and then pressing and holding the exit button until two beeps are heard The exit button is located between buttons 1 and 2 With the vehicle in PARK P the exit position for the previously set driver can be recalled by pressing the exit button When you use the keyless access transmitter to unlock your vehicle automatic seat and steering wheel movement to the exit position may occur The numbers on the back of the transmitter 1 and 2 corresponds to the numbers on the memory buttons Further programming for automatic seat and mirror movement can be done using the Driver Information Center DIC For programming information see DIC Vehicle Personalization on page 220 Power Reclining Seatbacks Your seats have power reclining seatbacks L J Use the vertical power seat control located on the outboard side of the seat to operate them e To recline the seatback press the control toward the rear of the vehicle e To raise the seatback press the control toward the front of the vehicle 11 A CAUTION Sitting in a reclined position when your vehicle is in motion can be dangerous Even if you buckle up your safety belts cannot do their job when you are reclined like this The shoulder belt cannot do its job I
219. ees 283 System Overview Overview Navigation System 2 05 232 T Tachometer sartina tiina aaa de aa 187 TCS Warning Light eeceeeeeeeeee eee 194 Telescopic Steering Column Power Tilt WNEI didien ach vecactseedeupatedeasazacenelanecd vaccines 141 Theft Deterrent Radio cccccecc eee eeeeeeees 226 Theft Deterrent System ceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeee 84 Theft Deterrent Systems ceceeeeee eee 84 Tire Pressure LIQMt scace sasvesncesencensoteesencedeiatecense 196 TIVES dossier aaa A hace ddan 413 Aluminum or Chrome Plated Wheels Cleaning seeeeeeeeeesseeessrrrrrrrereeesreennna 448 Buying New Tires ccceeeeeeeeeeeereeeeeees 428 GAINS OEI SEE A ASS 435 Tires cont CIS ANING sicondi anaa 449 Different S ZE soiree eecceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaeaes 430 If a Tire Goes Flat 2 0 cceeceeeeeeeeeeee eee 440 Inflation Tire Pressure aeee 422 Inspection and Rotation eee 426 Lifting Your Vehicle esee 435 Pressure Monitor System cceeeeeeeee 423 PRUNE at oeira 420 Tire Sidewall Labeling cceeeeeeeee 415 Tire Terminology and Definitions 417 Uniform Tire Quality Grading 431 Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance 432 Wheel Replacement eeeeeeeeeeeeeees 432 When It Is Time for New Tires 5 428 Winter Tires ccceceeeeeseeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeneeeeeees 414 Towing Recreationa
220. ees 364 Engine Soon Light ece 196 Publications Ordering Information 497 Servicing Your Airbag Equipped Vehicle 58 Setup MEU sscascceencnesessccusecsannsceceasuvecenneenccte 243 Sheet Metal Damage ecceseeeeeeeeeeeeeeee 449 Shifting Into Park P wicsscccsaudecseevtedosetaesdecnseues 99 Shifting Out of Park P cceeeeeeeeeeeeee 100 Signals Turn and Lane Change 0 142 Six Disc CD Changer ccsteeeeeeeeeeeeeeee 302 Specifications Capacities cceee 458 SPCCUOMBtOl sesicicincntsesscuciedveedeceecssetecaenneactes 187 StabiliTrak System siccataisccniacrsesgcsiseiadmansies 331 Starting Your Engine s soiiosisiuiuinni i aieia 89 Steering socrii E 333 Steering Wheel Controls Audio 227 Steering Wheel Controls Memory 0 10 Steering Wheel Power Tilt Wheel and Telescopic Steering Column 0008 141 Storage Areas Center Console Storage Area 0 0 122 Convenience Net 0 cceeeeeeeeeeeteeeeeeees 123 510 Storage Areas cont C pholder S i danct eeceeiauiisderteedeerheawsdeaeeane rcs 122 GIOVE BOX akcsesassbscetodntstenceseanceenmaevendieneurs 121 Map POCKOL onien S 122 Rear Storage Area a e 123 Stuck in Sand Mud Ice or Snow 353 SUN VISOS cceceeeceeceeteeeeeeeeaeeeeeeeaeeeeeeaaaeeeees 84 SVIMDOIS arrigarriena aani 275 System Needs Service If cceeeeeeeeeee
221. eeway driving is Keep up with traffic and keep to the right Drive at the same speed most of the other drivers are driving Too fast or too slow driving breaks a smooth traffic flow Treat the left lane on a freeway as a passing lane At the entrance there is usually a ramp that leads to the freeway If you have a clear view of the freeway as you drive along the entrance ramp you should begin to check traffic Try to determine where you expect to blend with the flow Try to merge into the gap at close to the prevailing speed Switch on your turn signal check your mirrors and glance over your shoulder as often as necessary Try to blend smoothly with the traffic flow Once you are on the freeway adjust your speed to the posted limit or to the prevailing rate if it is slower Stay in the right lane unless you want to pass Before changing lanes check your mirrors Then use your turn signal Just before you leave the lane glance quickly over your shoulder to make sure there is not another vehicle in your blind spot Once you are moving on the freeway make certain you allow a reasonable following distance Expect to move slightly slower at night When you want to leave the freeway move to the proper lane well in advance If you miss your exit do not under any circumstances stop and back up Drive on to the next exit The exit ramp can be curved sometimes quite sharply The exit speed is usually posted Reduce your
222. ef surrender to frustration or anger can suddenly put the passing driver face to face with the worst of all traffic accidents the head on collision 335 So here are some tips for passing 336 Drive ahead Look down the road to the sides and to crossroads for situations that might affect your passing patterns If you have any doubt whatsoever about making a successful pass wait for a better time Watch for traffic signs pavement markings and lines If you can see a sign up ahead that might indicate a turn or an intersection delay your pass A broken center line usually indicates it is all right to pass providing the road ahead is clear Never cross a solid line on your side of the lane or a double solid line even if the road seems empty of approaching traffic Do not get too close to the vehicle you want to pass while you are awaiting an opportunity For one thing following too closely reduces your area of vision especially if you are following a larger vehicle Also you will not have adequate space if the vehicle ahead suddenly slows or stops Keep back a reasonable distance When it looks like a chance to pass is coming up start to accelerate but stay in the right lane and do not get too close Time your move so you will be increasing speed as the time comes to move into the other lane If the way is clear to pass you will have a running start that more than makes up for the distance you would lose
223. el up to the mark What to Use To determine what kind of fluid to use see Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 473 Always use the proper fluid Failure to use the proper fluid can cause leaks and damage hoses and seals Windshield Washer Fluid What to Use When you need windshield washer fluid be sure to read the manufacturer s instructions before use If you will be operating your vehicle in an area where the temperature may fall below freezing use a fluid that has sufficient protection against freezing 397 Adding Washer Fluid The LOW WASHER FLUID message will be displayed on the Driver Information Center DIC when the fluid is low Open the cap with the washer symbol on it Add washer fluid until the tank is full See Engine Compartment Overview on page 374 for reservoir location 398 Notice e When using concentrated washer fluid follow the manufacturer s instructions for adding water Do not mix water with ready to use washer fluid Water can cause the solution to freeze and damage your washer fluid tank and other parts of the washer system Also water does not clean as well as washer fluid Fill your washer fluid tank only three quarters full when it is very cold This allows for expansion if freezing occurs which could damage the tank if it is completely full Do not use engine coolant antifreeze in your windshield washer It can damage your washer system and paint B
224. elated to the accident This will help guard against post accident legal action e If you need roadside assistance call GM Roadside Assistance See Roadside Service on page 487 for more information 494 If your vehicle cannot be driven know where the towing service will be taking it Get a card from the tow truck operator or write down the driver s name the service s name and the phone number Remove any valuables from your vehicle before it is towed away Make sure this includes your insurance information and registration if you keep these items in your vehicle Gather the important information you will need from the other driver Things like name address phone number driver s license number vehicle license plate vehicle make model and model year Vehicle Identification Number VIN insurance company and policy number and a general description of the damage to the other vehicle If possible call your insurance company from the scene of the accident They will walk you through the information they will need If they ask for a police report phone or go to the police department headquarters the next day and you can get a copy of the report for a nominal fee In some states provinces with no fault insurance laws a report may not be necessary This is especially true if there are no injuries and both vehicles are driveable e Choose a reputable collision repair facility for your vehicle Whether you select a GM
225. em to display the vehicle s current location on the map screen Map This command will cause the system to display the map screen Map Commands Zoom In This command will cause the system to zoom in when on the map screen Zoom Out This command will cause the system to zoom out when on the map screen Maximum Scale This command will cause the system to zoom out to the maximum available map scale when on the map screen Minimum Scale This command will cause the system to zoom in to the minimum available map scale when on the map screen Heading Up Change to Heading Up These commands will cause the system to display the Vehicle Up heading when on the map screen The map scale should be set for under 2 miles 4 km North Up Change to North Up These commands will cause the system to display the North Up heading when on the map screen if the map scale is set to 2 miles 4 km or less 315 Map Direction Change Map Direction These commands will cause the system to change the vehicle s direction from North Up to Heading Up or Heading Up to North Up on the map screen if the map scale is set to 2 miles 4 km or less Mark Mark This Point These commands will cause the system to mark the location as a memory point while on the map screen Destination Commands Home Go Home These commands will cause the system to enter the Home destination if one is set Go To Starting Point Previous Starting Point
226. en Touch Return to go back to the previous menu Calculate Route This feature allows you to begin route calculation for the selected destination Cancel Route If you are traveling on a planned route and would like to cancel it touch Cancel Route The system will ask you to confirm by touching YES Touch YES to confirm cancellation of your planned route or touch Return to keep your planned route Maps This section includes basic information you need to know about the map database Regional Maps The maps are stored on a DVD ROM The 48 contiguous United States and portions of Canada are contained on one disc The U S map database includes interstate freeways state highways country roads and major and general streets Refer to the Navigation System Map Disc manual to view the explanation of map coverage and detailed city lists in each region The map disc manual will be in your map DVD case when the vehicle is delivered from the factory Installing the DVD Map Disc When your vehicle is delivered from the factory the dealer may have installed the map DVD If the map DVD was not installed in your vehicle when first purchased do the following 1 Turn the ignition on 2 With the vehicle in PARK P press and hold the TILT key until a beep is heard The system s faceplate will open 3 If already loaded the map DVD or a CD will eject from the slot 271 4 Load the map DVD into the slot by ins
227. ent tire size and recommended inflation pressure See Tire and Loading Information Label under Loading Your Vehicle on page 354 Run Flat Tires Your vehicle when new had run flat tires There is no spare tire no tire changing equipment and no place to store a tire in the vehicle Run flat tires perform so well without any air that a Tire Pressure Monitor TPM is used to alert you if a tire has lost pressure 420 If a tire goes flat you will not need to stop on the side of the road to change the tire You can just keep on driving The shorter the distance you drive and the slower the speed the greater the chance that the tire will not have to be replaced If you drive on a deflated run flat tire for 50 miles 80 km or less and at speeds of 55 mph 90 km h or less there is a good chance that the tire can be repaired The tire can operate effectively with no air pressure for up to 100 miles 160 km at speeds up to 55 mph 90 km h but the tire would then have to be replaced When a tire is filled with air it provides a cushion between the road and the wheel Because you will not have this cushion when driving on a deflated tire try to avoid potholes that could damage your wheel and require replacement of it Some road hazards can damage a tire beyond repair This damage could occur even before you have driven on the tire in a deflated condition When a tire has been damaged or if you have driven any distance
228. ep your speed down Applying the brake disengages the system You may choose not to use Adaptive Cruise Control on steep hills Disengaging Adaptive Cruise Control To disengage the system apply the brake pedal or move the Adaptive Cruise Control switch to off Adaptive Cruise Control information will not appear on the HUD when the system is not engaged Erasing Set Speed Memory When you turn the Adaptive Cruise Control switch or the ignition off the set speed memory is erased Other Messages There are three messages that may appear in the Driver Information Center DIC They are SERVICE RADAR CRUISE CRUISE NOT READY and CLEAN RADAR CRUISE These messages will only appear to indicate a problem if Adaptive Cruise Control is active See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 206 for more information You may also see CRUISE SPEED LIMITED displayed in the HUD See Head Up Display HUD on page 177 for more information 163 Cleaning the System The radar can become blocked by snow ice or dirt If so you may need to turn off the engine and clean the lens The lens is located on the driver s side of the front fascia Clean the surface with a 50 50 mixture of isopropyl alcohol and water on a dampened cloth After cleaning the fascia lens try to engage Adaptive Cruise Control If this does not fix the problem you may have to remov
229. er See Engine Air Cleaner Filter on page 382 Engine Oil Fill Cap See When to Add Engine Oil under Engine Oil on page 377 Engine Oil Dipstick See Checking Engine Oil under Engine Oil on page 377 Brake Master Cylinder Reservoir See Brake Fluid under Brakes on page 399 Engine Coolant Surge Tank and Pressure Cap See Coolant Surge Tank Pressure Cap on page 388 Windshield Washer Fluid Reservoir See Adding Washer Fluid under Windshield Washer Fluid on page 397 375 is what you will see When you open the hood on the 4 4L V8 XLR V engine here Ug PLN e OM TEES PESA as tn to Ie lt a Es i ee eo rs z lt a E O E 376 Battery See Battery on page 402 Passenger Compartment Air Filter See Passenger Compartment Air Filter on page 184 Underhood Fuse Block See Underhood Fuse Block on page 455 Power Steering Fluid See Power Steering Fluid on page 396 Engine Air Cleaner Filter See Engine Air Cleaner Filter on page 382 Engine Oil Fill Cap See When to Add Engine Oil under Engine Oil on page 377 Engine Oil Dipstick See Checking Engine Oil under Engine Oil on page 377 Brake Master Cylinder Reservoir See Brake Fluid under Brakes on page 399 Engine Coolant Surge Tank and Pressure Cap See Coolant Surge Tank Pressure Cap on page 388 Windshield Washer Fluid Reservoir See Ad
230. er Warning Devices If you carry reflective triangles you can set them up at the side of the road about 300 feet 100 m behind your vehicle Horn Press near or on the horn symbols on your steering wheel pad to sound the horn Power Tilt Wheel and Telescopic Steering Column iy A Z The power tilt wheel control is located on the outboard side of the steering column To operate the power tilt feature push the control up and the steering wheel will tilt up Push the control down and the steering wheel will go down Push the control forward and the steering wheel moves toward the front of the vehicle Push the control rearward and the steering wheel moves toward the rear of the vehicle To set the memory position see DIC Vehicle Personalization on page 220 and Memory Seat Mirrors and Steering Wheel on page 10 Turn Signal Multifunction Lever The lever on the left side of the steering column includes the following e Turn and Lane Change Signals See Turn and Lane Change Signals on page 142 e D Headlamp High Low Beam Changer See Headlamp High Low Beam Changer on page 143 e 0 Fog Lamps See Fog Lamps on page 168 141 e Flash to Pass Feature See Flash to Pass on page 143 e Cruise Control See Cruise Control on page 147 e Exterior Lamps Control See Exterior Lamps on page 164 Turn and Lane Change Signals The turn signal has two upward for right and two downward for left po
231. er gear See Shifting Out of Park P on page 100 REVERSE R Use this gear to back up Notice Shifting to REVERSE R while your vehicle is moving forward could damage the transmission The repairs would not be covered by your warranty Shift to REVERSE R only after your vehicle is stopped To rock your vehicle back and forth to get out of snow ice or sand without damaging your transmission see f Your Vehicle is Stuck in Sand Mud Ice or Snow on page 353 NEUTRAL N In this position your engine does not connect with the wheels To restart when you are already moving use NEUTRAL N only Also use NEUTRAL N when your vehicle is being towed Use Neutral N if the vehicle must be moved with the engine off for short distances Please see Towing Your Vehicle on page 359 A CAUTION Shifting into a drive gear while your engine is running at high speed is dangerous Unless your foot is firmly on the brake pedal your vehicle could move very rapidly You could lose control and hit people or objects Do not shift into a drive gear while your engine is running at high speed Notice Shifting out of PARK P or NEUTRAL N with the engine running at high speed may damage the transmission The repairs would not be covered by your warranty Be sure the engine is not running at high speed when shifting your vehicle 93 DRIVE D This position is for normal driving It provides the best fuel economy for your
232. er the headlamps are on United States Only Highbeam On Light This light comes on when the high beam headlamps are in use See Headlamp High Low Beam Changer on page 143 202 Fuel Gage Your fuel gage tells you about how much fuel you have left when the ignition is on When the needle approaches the low fuel symbol LOW FUEL will appear on the Driver Information Center DIC display At this time you still have a little fuel left but you should get more soon Press RESET to acknowledge a DIC message s Pressing RESET will also turn off a DIC message but the LOW FUEL message will come on again in 10 minutes if you have not added fuel to the vehicle Here are five things that some owners ask about All these things are normal and do not indicate that anything is wrong with the fuel gage e At the gas station the gas pump shuts off before the gage reads the full symbol e t takes more or less fuel to fill up than the gage reads For example the gage reads half full but it took more or less than half of the tank s capacity to fit it e The gage pointer may move while cornering braking or speeding up e The gage may not indicate the tank is empty when the ignition is turned off e The gage reading may change slightly within the first several minutes after starting the vehicle You can use the Driver Information Center DIC to display more detailed fuel information While scrolling thr
233. erly TIGHT CURVE This message indicates that ACC has reduced your vehicle speed due to a tight curve in the road Once the road straightens ACC will return to your selected set speed or follow distance setting See Adaptive Cruise Control ACC under Turn Signal Multifunction Lever on page 141 for more information You may also see an ACC active symbol alert symbol or vehicle ahead symbol See Adaptive Cruise Control ACC under Turn Signal Multifunction Lever on page 141 for more information Ultrasonic Rear Parking determine how close an object is to your rear backing up you could hit a vehicle child bumper within a given area making parking easier pedestrian bicyclist or pet resulting in vehicle damage injury or death Even A CAUTION though the vehicle has the URPA system always check carefully before backing up The Ultrasonic Rear Park Assist URPA by checking behind your vehicle system does not replace driver vision URPA does not e Operate above speeds of 3 mph The URPA display is 5 km h located inside the Detect objects more than 5 feet vehicle on the center 1 5 meters behind the vehicle This console It has three distance may be less during warmer color coded lights or humid weather that can be seen Detect objects that are below the through the rearview mirror or by turning around bumper underneath the vehicle or that are very close to the vehicle Detect children p
234. ers aaa ope wet ent fens eevee aS Vehicle Positioning Ventilation Adjustment eeeeeeeeeeeeee Visors Voice Recognition 00 0 eee eeeeeeeeeeeeneeeeeeeaee ees Voltmeter Gage Warning Lights Gages and Indicators Warnings DIC Warnings and Messages 0006 Hazard Warning Flashers Other Warning Devices Safety and Symbols ceeeeseeeeeeeeeeeees Vehicle Damage Waypoint Edit ce eeeeeeeeeeeeneeeeeeeaneees Wheels Alignment and Tire Balance Different Size REPIACOMON encccceccaneses coeehoceaserenssdeeenenescees 512 WIRKQWS E E 81 P OWON secies aE E A E R 82 Windshield Rainsense Wipers ssesseserrrersrren 145 Replacement sorrires 412 Washer sic cieviiecteiiisineiieiviteaietee iene 146 Washer FIUId 0 0 eee cece eee eetneeeeeeeaeeeeeeeee 397 Wiper Blade Replacement eee 412 Wiper Blades Cleaning ccceeeeeee 447 Wiper FUSOS etsescinelsceenetyasesncetannseneitdennenin 452 WIDOT sirar aE EE 144 Winter Driving sasarean cekaeverendns 349 Winter TIOS 2 sicec cc tied etedevee ste airian nas 414 Wiper Activated Headlamps ee 166 X XM Satellite Radio Antenna System 230 Y Your Vehicle and the Environment 462
235. erting it partway The system will pull it in 5 Press and release the TILT key to close the faceplate Notice Shifting out of PARK P with the system s faceplate open will cause the faceplate to close automatically This could cause damage to a CD DVD or the system if it is partially loaded Before shifting out of PARK P make sure that the DVD or CD is loaded properly The vehicle must be shifted back into PARK P to close the faceplate Once the map DVD is inserted correctly you will have the following two choices e LANGUAGE e AGREE You can change the language at this time See Language under Navigation Audio System on page 285 for more information on choosing a language Once a language has been selected touch AGREE to plan a route The map will appear showing your current vehicle position 272 Ejecting the DVD Map Disc When the DVD map disc is not loaded you will not be able to use the navigation portion of the system 1 Turn the ignition on 2 With the vehicle in PARK P press and hold the TILT key until a beep is heard The system s faceplate will open 3 The map DVD will eject from the slot Pull the disc out 4 Press and release the TILT key to close the faceplate Notice Shifting out of PARK P with the system s faceplate open will cause the faceplate to close automatically This could cause damage to a CD DVD or the system if it is partially loaded Before shifting
236. ery be installed in your hand held transmitter for quicker and more accurate transmission of the radio frequency signal Programming Universal Home Remote 4 The indicator light will flash slowly at first and then rapidly after Universal Home Remote successfully receives the frequency signal from the hand held transmitter Release both Follow these steps to program up to three channels 1 Press and hold down the two outside Universal Home Remote buttons releasing only when the Universal Home Remote indicator light begins to flash after 20 seconds Do not hold down the buttons for longer than 30 seconds and do not repeat this step to program a second and or third hand held transmitter to the remaining two Universal Home Remote buttons 2 Position the end of your hand held transmitter about 1 to 3 inches 3 to 8 cm away from the Universal Home Remote buttons while keeping the indicator light in view 3 Simultaneously press and hold both the desired Universal Home Remote button and the hand held transmitter button Do not release the buttons until Step 4 has been completed Some entry gates and garage door openers may require you to substitute Step 3 with the procedure noted in Gate Operator and Canadian Programming later in this section buttons Press and hold the newly trained Universal Home Remote button and observe the indicator light If the indicator light stays on continuously programming is comple
237. es OnStar service that involves location information about your vehicle cannot work unless GPS satellite signals are unobstructed and available in that place as well Your vehicle must have a working electrical system including adequate battery power for the OnStar equipment to operate There are other problems OnStar cannot control that may prevent OnStar from providing OnStar service to you at any particular time or place Some examples are damage to important parts of your vehicle in an accident hills tall buildings tunnels weather or wireless phone network congestion 110 Your Responsibility You may need to increase the volume of your radio to hear the OnStar advisor If the light next to the OnStar buttons is red this means that your system is not functioning properly and should be checked by a dealer If the light appears clear no light is appearing your OnStar subscription has expired You can always press the OnStar button to confirm that your OnStar equipment is active Universal Home Remote System Universal Home Remote System With One Triangular LED The Universal Home Remote System provides a way to replace up to three hand held radio frequency RF transmitters used to activate devices such as garage door openers security systems and home lighting This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules Operation is subject to the following two conditions 1 This device may
238. es on page 413 City Driving R v Be ee hall z m LTE Py p mi 3 i SI 7A Z m E z DANAN Ze Fr A 38h i ARSA SEN 5 LL Hea Fox yaw AAS Z y ZMK A SS PAC T One of the biggest problems with city streets is the amount of traffic on them You will want to watch out for what the other drivers are doing and pay attention to traffic signals al Here are ways to increase your safety in city driving e Know the best way to get to where you are going Get a city map and plan your trip into an unknown part of the city just as you would for a cross country trip Try to use the freeways that rim and crisscross most large cities You will save time and energy See Freeway Driving on page 344 Treat a green light as a warning signal A traffic light is there because the corner is busy enough to need it When a light turns green and just before you start to move check both ways for vehicles that have not cleared the intersection or may be running the red light 343 Freeway Driving Mile for mile freeways also called thruways parkways expressways turnpikes or superhighways are the safest of all roads But they have their own special rules 344 The most important advice on fr
239. ess either by having you contact the toll free number 1 877 NAV DISC 1 877 628 3472 or the center s website www gmnavdisc com After verifying your address you should receive the updated disc in about two weeks After receiving the updated disc replace the old disc in the navigation system See Installing the DVD Map Disc and Ejecting the DVD Map Disc under Maps on page 271 Dispose of the old disc to avoid confusion about which disc is the most current 284 If you have any questions about the operation of the navigation system or the update process call the GM Nav Disc Center or go to the center s website If you need any future updates or a replacement disc because the current disc is lost damaged or needs to be updated call the GM Nav Disc Center or order a new disc online To order a disc have your Vehicle Identification Number VIN available This helps the center make sure you receive the correct and most up to date DVD map disc for your vehicle See Vehicle Identification Number VIN on page 451 for more information Database Coverage Explanations Coverage areas vary with respect to the level of map detail available for any given area Some areas will feature greater levels of detail than others If this happens it does not mean there is a problem with the system As the map DVD is updated more detail may become available for areas which previously had limited detail See Ordering Map DVDs on pag
240. ete either the word ON or the word OFF or the symbol for on or the symbol for off will be visible See Passenger Airbag Status Indicator on page 189 53 The passenger sensing system will turn off the passenger s frontal airbag and side impact airbag under certain conditions The driver s airbags are not part of the passenger sensing system The passenger sensing system works with sensors that are part of the passenger s seat and safety belt The sensors are designed to detect the presence of a properly seated occupant and determine if the passenger s frontal airbag and side impact airbag should be enabled may inflate or not Accident statistics show that children are safer if they are restrained in the rear rather than the front seat We recommend that rear facing child restraints not be transported in your vehicle even if the airbags are off Your vehicle has a label on the sun visor that says Never put a rear facing child seat in the front This is because the risk to the rear facing child is so great if the airbag deploys Never put a child in a rear facing child restraint in the passenger s seat unless the passenger airbag status indicator shows off and the airbags are off 54 A CAUTION A child in a rear facing child restraint can be seriously injured or killed if the passenger s airbag inflates This is because the back of the rear facing child restraint would be very close to the inflati
241. ey never drive after drinking For persons under 21 it is against the law in every U S state to drink alcohol There are good medical psychological and developmental reasons for these laws The obvious way to eliminate the leading highway safety problem is for people never to drink alcohol and then drive But what if people do How much is too much if someone plans to drive It is a lot less than many might think Although it depends on each person and situation here is some general information on the problem The Blood Alcohol Concentration BAC of someone who is drinking depends upon four things e The amount of alcohol consumed e The drinkers body weight e The amount of food that is consumed before and during drinking e The length of time it has taken the drinker to consume the alcohol 323 According to the American Medical Association a 180 Ib 82 kg person who drinks three 12 ounce 355 ml bottles of beer in an hour will end up with a BAC of about 0 06 percent The person would reach the same BAC by drinking three 4 ounce 120 ml glasses of wine or three mixed drinks if each had 1 1 2 ounces 45 ml of liquors like whiskey gin or vodka 324 It is the amount of alcohol that counts For example if the same person drank three double martinis 3 ounces or 90 ml of liquor each within an hour the person s BAC would be close to 0 12 percent A person who consumes food just before or during drink
242. f a participating Cadillac dealership If beyond this radius we will arrange to have your car towed to the nearest Cadillac dealership Reaching Roadside Service Dial the toll free Roadside Service number 1 800 882 1112 A Roadside Service Advisor will assist you and request the following information e A description of the problem e Name home address home telephone number e Location of your Cadillac and number you are calling from e The model year Vehicle Identification Number VIN mileage and date of delivery 488 Roadside Service for the Hearing or Speech Impaired Roadside Service is prepared to assist owners who have hearing difficulties or are speech impaired Cadillac has installed special telecommunication devices called Text Telephone TTY in the Roadside Service Center Any customer who has access to a TTY ora conventional teletypewriter can communicate with Cadillac by dialing from the United States or Canada 1 888 889 2438 daily 24 hours Courtesy Transportation To enhance your ownership experience we and our participating dealers are proud to offer Courtesy Transportation a customer support program for new vehicles The Courtesy Transportation program is offered to customers in conjunction with the Bumper to Bumper coverage provided by the New Vehicle Limited Warranty Several transportation options are available when warranty repairs are required This will reduce your inconvenience
243. f like shields 36 A booster seat F G is a child restraint designed to improve the fit of the vehicle s safety belt system Some booster seats have a shoulder belt positioner and some high back booster seats have a five point harness A booster seat can also help a child to see out the window Q How Should I Use a Child Restraint Securing an Add on Child Restraint in A A child restraint system is any device designed the Vehicle for use in a motor vehicle to restrain seat or position children A built in child restraint x system is a permanent part of the motor A CAUTION vehicle An add on child restraint system is a portable one which is purchased by the A child can be seriously injured or killed vehicle s owner To help reduce injuries an in a crash if the child restraint is not add on child restraint must be secured in properly secured in the vehicle Make sure the vehicle With built in or add on child the child restraint is properly installed in restraints the child has to be secured within the vehicle using the vehicle s safety belt the child restraint following the instructions that came with When choosing an add on child restraint be that restraint and also the instructions in sure the child restraint is designed to be this manual used in a vehicle If it is it will have a label saying that it meets federal motor vehicle To help reduce the chance of injury the child safety standards Then follow
244. for a few minutes and your vehicle is on a level surface Then check the dipstick and add oil if necessary See Engine Oil on page 377 LOW OIL PRESSURE If this message displays while the engine is running stop the engine and do not operate the vehicle until the cause of low oil pressure is corrected Severe damage to the engine can result A multiple chime sounds when this message is displayed LOW VOLTAGE This message displays when the electrical system is charging less than 10 volts or if the battery has been drained If this message displays immediately after starting it is possible that the generator can still recharge the battery The battery should recharge while driving but may take a few hours to do so Consider using an auxiliary charger to boost the battery after returning home or to a final destination Make sure you follow the manufacturer s instructions If this message displays while driving or after starting your vehicle and stays on have it checked immediately by your dealer to determine the cause of this problem To help the generator recharge the battery quickly you can reduce the load on the electrical system by turning off the accessories You can monitor battery voltage on the DIC by pressing the INFO button The normal range is 11 5 to 15 5 volts LOW WASHER FLUID This message displays when the windshield washer fluid is low Fill the windshield washer fluid reservoir as soon as possible See Engin
245. from the air including pollen and Operation Tips dust particles Reductions in airflow which e Clear away any ice snow or leaves from the may occur more often in dusty areas indicate that air inlets at the base of the windshield that the filter may need to be replaced early may block the flow of air into your vehicle The filter should be replaced as part of the routine e Use of non GM approved hood deflectors may scheduled maintenance See Scheduled adversely affect the performance of the Maintenance on page 465 for more information system To check or replace the air filter do the following e Keep the area around the base of the f i 1 With the hood open unlatch and remove instrument panel console and air path under the access panel the seats clear of objects to help circulate a the air inside of your vehicle more effectively The passenger compartment air filter and access panel are located on the passenger s side of the engine compartment near the battery See Engine Compartment Overview on page 374 for more information on location 2 Pull the old filter out of the housing 3 Insert the new filter into the housing 4 Reinstall the air filter access panel 184 Warning Lights Gages and Indicators This part describes the warning lights and gages that may be on your vehicle The pictures will help you locate them Warning lights and gages can signal that something is wrong before it becomes serious enough
246. g Press the CD hard key to access the six disc CD changer screen You can also use the system s DVD player for single CD play once the map DVD is removed See CD DVD Player on page 305 for more information If no CD is loaded in the CD DVD Player and you press the CD hard key the message No CD Loaded will appear on the display 302 07 3 33PM 85 F RDS Disc 1 Track 1 SOUND CD Changer Screen Once you access the CD changer screen you can select one of the numbered buttons to go from one compact disc to another among those loaded in the CD changer and use the arrows to rewind or fast forward through the disc selected The following features are also available from this screen e LOAD e EJECT e SCAN THE DISCS or SCAN THE TRACKS e and RANDOM ALL or RANDOM DISC The numbered buttons 1 through 6 represent the order of the discs loaded in the changer If there are only two CDs loaded buttons 1 and 2 will only be available to choose from LOAD Touch this button once each time you wish to load a CD into the changer It may take up to 10 seconds for the changer to accept the CD into the slot depending on the changer initializing Repeat this procedure for loading up to six discs Press and hold the LOAD button until a beep is heard to put the changer in LOAD ALL mode Once the Insert CD message is displayed you can load all six discs one after the other gt Play Touch this butt
247. g products on your vehicle may damage the paint finish and or tires When applying a tire dressing always wipe off any overspray from all painted surfaces on your vehicle Sheet Metal Damage If the vehicle is damaged and requires sheet metal repair or replacement make sure the body repair shop applies anti corrosion material to parts repaired or replaced to restore corrosion protection Original manufacturer replacement parts will provide the corrosion protection while maintaining the warranty Finish Damage Any stone chips fractures or deep scratches in the finish should be repaired right away Minor chips and scratches can be repaired with touch up materials available from your dealer or other service outlets Larger areas of finish damage can be corrected in your dealers body and paint shop Underbody Maintenance Chemicals used for ice and snow removal and dust control can collect on the underbody If these are not removed corrosion and rust can develop on the underbody parts such as fuel lines frame floor pan and exhaust system even though they have corrosion protection At least every spring flush these materials from the underbody with plain water Clean any areas where mud and debris can collect Dirt packed in close areas of the frame should be loosened before being flushed Your dealer or an underbody car washing system can do this for you 449 Chemical Paint Spotting Some weather and atmospheric
248. g center for help Supercharger Oil Because they are technically qualified and have the proper tools you should have your dealer perform this maintenance 382 When to Check See Additional Required Services on page 467 for when the oil level should be checked What Kind of Oil to Use Use only the recommended supercharger oil See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 473 Engine Air Cleaner Filter See Engine Compartment Overview on page 374 for the location of the engine air cleaner filters When to Inspect the Engine Air Cleaner Filters Inspect the air cleaner filters at the Maintenance II intervals and replace them at the first oil change after each 50 000 mile 83 000 km interval See Scheduled Maintenance on page 465 for more information If you are driving in dusty dirty conditions inspect the filters at each engine oil change How to Inspect the Engine Air Cleaner Filters To inspect the air cleaner filters remove the filters from the vehicle and lightly shake the filters to release loose dust and dirt If the filters remain caked with dirt new filters are required To inspect or replace the filters do the following 1 Some XLR V vehicles have a single piece black cover that snaps over the entire air cleaner assembly For vehicles with this cover simply pull it s left right sides toward the outside of the vehicle and lift up to remove cover Reinstall the cover when you are finished inspe
249. g loaded for the vehicle with the top raised 126 Under certain conditions the Driver Information Center DIC may display messages regarding the retractable hardtop If the CLOSE CARGO DIVIDER TOO COLD TO MOVE TOP TOP INOP VALET ON TOP INOP OUT OF PARK TOP MOTOR OVER TEMP or TOP NOT SECURE messages display see DIC Warnings and Messages on page 206 for more information If the retractable hardtop does not operate and there are no messages displayed on the Driver Information Center DIC then perform the Power Window Initialize steps under Power Windows on page 82 Manually Raising the Retractable Hardtop If your vehicle has a power loss such as a dead battery you can still raise the top manually by doing the following 1 Lower both sun visors and open both doors 2 Use the key to open the trunk See Keys on page 65 and Trunk on page 77 for more information 3 Raise the trunk by hand 4 Remove the wrench located inside the passenger s side storage compartment 5 Find the hydraulic pump under the carpet on the rear driver s side of the trunk Open the valve by turning it counterclockwise with your hand until it stops Notice Pressing the retractable hardtop button when the hydraulic pump valve is open could damage the pump Always close the hydraulic pump valve after the retractable hardtop has been closed manually 6 Pull both sides of the rear tonneau over center link down to unlock
250. g straight road The vehicle is approaching a tall building or a large vehicle The surface streets run parallel to a freeway The vehicle has just been transferred by a vehicle carrier or a ferry The current position calibration is set incorrectly The vehicle is traveling at high speed The vehicle changes directions more than once or when the vehicle is turning on a turn table in a parking lot The vehicle is entering and or exiting a parking lot garage or a lot with a roof The GPS signal is not received A roof carrier is installed on your vehicle The vehicle is being driven with tire chains The tires are replaced The tire pressure for your tires is incorrect The tires are worn The first time the map DVD is inserted The battery is disconnected for several days The vehicle is driving in heavy traffic where driving is at low speeds and the vehicle is stopped and started repeatedly If you experience problems with your system see your dealer Problems with Route Guidance Inappropriate route guidance may occur under one or more of the following conditions You have not turned onto the road indicated Route guidance may not be available when using automatic rerouting for the next right or left turn The route may not be changed when using automatic rerouting There is no route guidance when turning at an intersection Plural names of places may be announced occasionally It may take a l
251. ge the tone DSP if equipped fade and balance for all sources The audio system has a separate setting for these features for each source preset However the audio system keeps one fade and one balance setting for all audio sources 291 To adjust sound settings do the following 1 Touch the plus or minus signs to adjust treble mid range and bass 2 Touch the L for left or R for right to adjust the balance of the speakers 3 Touch the F for front or R for rear to adjust the fade of the speakers 4 Touch DSP to adjust your DSP if equipped See Adjusting the Speakers later in this section for more information After adjustments are made touch any source screen button This will take you back to the preset station menu Whenever you touch that screen button the previously stored information you have entered for each preset station will be recalled 292 To adjust the tone for each preset do the following ils 2 Press the BAND key Touch AM FM1 FM2 XM1 XM2 or WX if equipped to access the desired preset screen Touch SOUND Touch the plus or minus signs to adjust treble mid range and bass Touch Return to exit This will take you to the preset station menu Touch and hold one of the six preset screen buttons for more than two seconds until you hear a beep Whenever you touch that preset for less than two seconds the station and previously stored
252. ggressive driving maneuvers such as wide open throttle applications You may also hear audible spark knock during acceleration Refill your tank with premium fuel as soon as possible to avoid damaging your engine If you are using gasoline rated at 91 octane or higher and you hear heavy knocking your engine needs service Gasoline Specifications At a minimum gasoline should meet ASTM specification D 4814 in the United States or CAN CGSB 3 5 in Canada Some gasolines may contain an octane enhancing additive called methylcyclopentadienyl manganese tricarbonyl MMT General Motors recommends against the use of gasolines containing MMT See Additives on page 367 for additional information California Fuel If your vehicle is certified to meet California Emissions Standards it is designed to operate on fuels that meet California specifications See the underhood emission control label If this fuel is not available in states adopting California emissions standards your vehicle will operate satisfactorily on fuels meeting federal specifications but emission control system performance may be affected The malfunction indicator lamp may turn on and your vehicle may fail a smog check test See Malfunction Indicator Lamp on page 196 lf this occurs return to your authorized GM dealer for diagnosis If it is determined that the condition is caused by the type of fuel used repairs may not be covered by your warranty Additives To
253. h Home and Away FPOALUNG sanan 311 PRACIOS sanoen siirtosaa norni in AEREA SEENEN 225 Care of Your CD Player aeee 230 Care of Your CDS ceecee 229 Theft Deterrent ssnissssserssrssrrrreserrrenerrreen 226 Understanding Reception eeee 228 Rainsense Wipers esecceeeeeeeeeeeeeees 145 Raising the Retractable Hardtop 125 Reading Lamps isseire 171 Rear AXIC vais veiiedesesnedicleeeeitwined Heres 407 Limited Slip cee eeeeeeeteteeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaees 331 Rear Storage Area aseeseen 123 Rearview Mirror Automatic Dimming with ONSA e oe e EE 104 Reclining Seatbacks Power 0 cccceeeeeees 11 Recommended Fluids and Lubricants 473 Recreational Vehicle Towing ceecee 359 Replacement Windshield 0cece 412 Reporting Safety Defects Canadian Government 496 General Motors cceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 497 United States Government seeen 496 Restraint System Check Checking the Restraint Systems 60 Replacing Restraint System Parts After a GIGS arrat r EE E 61 Retained Accessory Power RAP e 89 Retractable Hardtop ss sssssssnssnisrernrininuninninnnnns 124 OWS ING caapi anaa 124 gel e sits E E ions 125 Roadside Service aise scacadipusdisenenigadacsadgarvacgseazacstaiaedas 487 Rocking Your Vehicle to Get it Out 0 354 Route Preference cceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaeeeees 269 Routing Engine Drive Belt
254. han day driving One reason is that some drivers are likely to be impaired by alcohol or drugs with night vision problems or by fatigue Here are some tips on night driving e Drive defensively e Do not drink and drive e Adjust the inside rearview mirror to reduce the glare from headlamps behind you e Since you cannot see as well you may need to slow down and keep more space between you and other vehicles e Slow down especially on higher speed roads Your vehicle s headlamps can light up only so much road ahead e In remote areas watch for animals e f you are tired pull off the road in a safe place and rest No one can see as well at night as in the daytime But as we get older these differences increase A 50 year old driver may require at least twice as much light to see the same thing at night as a 20 year old What you do in the daytime can also affect your night vision For example if you spend the day in bright sunshine you are wise to wear sunglasses Your eyes will have less trouble adjusting to night But if you are driving do not wear sunglasses at night They may cut down on glare from headlamps but they also make a lot of things invisible You can be temporarily blinded by approaching headlamps It can take a second or two or even several seconds for your eyes to re adjust to the dark When you are faced with severe glare as from a driver who does not lower the high beams or a vehicle
255. has a steering system that continuously adjusts the effort you feel when steering at all vehicle speeds It provides ease when parking yet a firm solid feel at highway speeds Steering Tips It is important to take curves at a reasonable speed A lot of the driver lost control accidents mentioned on the news happen on curves Here is why Experienced driver or beginner each of us is subject to the same laws of physics when driving on curves The traction of the tires against the road surface makes it possible for the vehicle to change its path when you turn the front wheels If there is no traction inertia will keep the vehicle going in the same direction If you have ever tried to steer a vehicle on wet ice you will understand this The traction you can get in a curve depends on the condition of the tires and the road surface the angle at which the curve is banked and your speed While you are in a curve speed is the one factor you can control Suppose you are steering through a sharp curve Then you suddenly accelerate Both control systems steering and acceleration have to do their work where the tires meet the road Adding the sudden acceleration can demand too much of those places You can lose control See Traction Control System TCS on page 329 What should you do if this ever happens Ease up on the accelerator pedal steer the vehicle the way you want it to go and slow down Speed limit sign
256. hat your top tether be anchored do not use a child restraint in this vehicle because a top tether cannot be properly anchored You must use the safety belts to secure your child restraint in this vehicle unless a national or local law requires that the top tether be anchored Refer to your child restraint instructions and instructions in this manual for securing a child restraint using the vehicle s safety belts 39 Securing a Child Restraint in the Passenger Seat Position Your vehicle has a right front passenger airbag In addition your vehicle has the passenger sensing system The passenger sensing system is designed to turn off the right front passenger s frontal airbag and side impact airbag when an infant in a rear facing infant seat or a small child in a forward facing child restraint or booster seat is detected See Passenger Sensing System on page 53 and Passenger Airbag Status Indicator on page 189 for more information on this including important safety information Your vehicle has a label on your sun visor that says Never put a rear facing child seat in the front This is because the risk to the rear facing child is so great if the airbag deploys 40 Never put a child in a rear facing child restraint in the passenger s seat unless the passenger airbag status indicator shows off and the airbag is off Here is why A CAUTION A child in a rear facing child restraint can be seriously injured or
257. he CD Player a se 230 ights On Reminder a n 202 Di iversity Antenna System s e 230 Highbeam On Light a i 202 xXM Satellite Radio Antenna System 230 Fuel Gage sinnir i igana asak 202 YSE niente 136 NOTES 137 Instrument Panel Overview XLR shown XLR V similar 138 The main components of the instrument panel are the following A Head Up Display HUD Controls Instrument Panel Brightness Controls See Head Up Display HUD on page 171 or Instrument Panel Brightness on page 170 Turn Signal Multifunction Lever See Turn Signal Multifunction Lever on page 141 Cruise Control See Cruise Control on page 147 Exterior Lamps Control See Exterior Lamps on page 164 Fog Lamps See Fog Lamps on page 168 Instrument Panel Cluster See Instrument Panel Cluster on page 186 Windshield Wiper Washer Lever See Windshield Wipers under Turn Signal Multifunction Lever on page 141 Driver Information Center DIC Controls Interior Lamps See DIC Controls and Displays on page 204 Air Outlets See Outlet Adjustment on page 184 G H Hazard Warning Flasher Button See Hazard Warning Flashers on page 140 Voice Commands Audio Controls See OnStar System on page 107 or Audio Steering Wheel Controls on page 227 Adaptive Cruise Controls If Equipped See Adaptive Cruise Control ACC under Turn
258. he button and hold it The washer will spray until you release the button The wipers will continue to clear the window for about six seconds after the button is released and then stop or return to your preset speed 146 A CAUTION In freezing weather do not use your washer until the windshield is warmed Otherwise the washer fluid can form ice on the windshield blocking your vision If the fluid in the windshield washer fluid reservoir is low the message LOW WASHER FLUID will appear on the Driver Information Center DIC display It will take 60 seconds after the bottle is refilled for this message to turn off For information on the correct washer fluid mixture to use see Windshield Washer Fluid on page 397 and Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 473 Headlamp Washer The headlamps washer only functions every fourth time the washer button is depressed and if the headlamps are on Cruise Control Your vehicle has cruise control Off This position turns the system off On This position turns the system on Resume Accelerate This position makes the vehicle accelerate or resume to a previously set speed Set Press this button at the end of the lever to set the speed With cruise control you can maintain a speed of about 25 mph 40 km h or more without keeping your foot on the accelerator This can really help on long trips Cruise control does not work at speeds below about 25
259. he driver s side of the trunk Pull the handle to unlock and unlatch the driver s door See Trunk on page 77 for information on opening the trunk during a loss of power Power Door Locks The power door lock switches are located on the door panels near the windows oS A Unlock Press this portion of the button to unlock the doors Lock Press this portion of the button to lock the doors There is an indicator light on the rear of the door near the window When the lock portion of the button is pressed and the door is closed a beep will sound and the light will come on for a few seconds then turn off If the button is pressed and the door is open a beep will sound and the light will stay on continuously 75 When the unlock portion of the button is pressed and the door is closed a beep will sound and the light will flash twice When the button is pressed and the door is open a beep will sound and the light will flash Automatic Door Lock Your vehicle is programmed so that when the doors are closed the ignition is on and the shift lever is moved out of PARK P all the doors will lock If someone needs to get out while the vehicle is not in PARK P have the person use the power door unlock switch When the door is closed again the doors will lock either when your foot is removed from the brake or the vehicle speed becomes faster than 8 mph 13 km h 76 Programmable Automatic Door Unl
260. he engine cooling fan By this time the coolant level inside the coolant surge tank may be lower If the level is lower add more of the proper mixture to the coolant surge tank until the level stabilizes at the FULL COLD mark on the coolant surge tank 5 Then replace the pressure cap Be sure the cap is hand tight and fully seated 396 If the LOW COOLANT message does not appear on the Driver Information Center DIC after two minutes the coolant is at the proper fill level If a LOW COOLANT message does appear repeat Steps 1 through 3 then reinstall the pressure cap or see your dealer Power Steering Fluid See Engine Compartment Overview on page 374 for reservoir location When to Check Power Steering Fluid It is not necessary to regularly check power steering fluid unless you suspect there is a leak in the system or you hear an unusual noise A fluid loss in this system could indicate a problem Have the system inspected and repaired How to Check Power Steering Fluid To check the power steering fluid do the following 1 Turn the ignition off and let the engine compartment cool down 2 Wipe the cap and the top of the reservoir clean 3 Unscrew the cap and wipe the dipstick with a clean rag 4 Replace the cap and completely tighten it 5 Remove the cap again and look at the fluid level on the dipstick The level should be at the FULL COLD mark If necessary add only enough fluid to bring the lev
261. he light will continue to flash until the trailer or the object is removed and your vehicle is driven forward at least 15 mph 25 km h It may also flash red if the ultrasonic sensors are not kept clean So be sure to keep your rear bumper free of mud dirt snow ice and slush or materials such as paint or the system may not work properly If after cleaning the rear bumper and driving forward at least 15 mph 25 km h the display continues to flash red see your dealer For cleaning instructions see Washing Your Vehicle on page 446 It may also flash red if your vehicle is moving in REVERSE R at a speed greater than 3 mph 5 km h Other conditions that may affect system performance include things like the vibrations from a jackhammer or the compression of air brakes on a very large truck As always drivers should use care when backing up a vehicle Always look behind you being sure to check for other vehicles obstructions and blind spots Accessory Power Outlet s The accessory power outlet can be used to connect electrical equipment such as a cellular phone or CB radio The accessory power outlet is located inside the center console storage compartment on the forward left side To use the outlet remove the tethered cap When not using it always cover the outlet with the protective cap Notice When using an accessory power outlet maximum electrical load must not exceed 20 amps Always turn off any electrica
262. hen release it The lamps will remain off until you turn the control band to off again Twilight Sentinel also provides exterior illumination as you leave the vehicle If Twilight Sentinel has turned on the lamps when you turn off the ignition your lamps will remain on until e The exterior lamp switch is moved from OFF to the parking lamp position or e a delay time that you select has elapsed See Driver Information Center DIC on page 203 to select the delay time that you want You can also select no delay time If you turn off the ignition with the exterior lamp switch in the parking lamp or headlamp position the Twilight Sentinel delay will not occur The lamps will turn off as soon as the switch is turned off As with any vehicle you should turn on the regular headlamp system when you need it Exterior Lighting Battery Saver If the manual parking lamps or headlamps have been left on the exterior lamps will turn off as soon as the ignition is turned off or RAP is active This protects against draining the battery in case you have accidentally left the headlamps or parking lamps on The battery saver does not work if the headlamps are turned on after the ignition switch is turned to off If you need to leave the lamps on use the exterior lamp control to turn the lamps back on 169 Instrument Panel Brightness The button for this feature is located on the instrument panel to the left of the steering column
263. here the tires meet the road Sometimes as when you are driving on snow or ice it is easy to ask more of those control systems than the tires and road can provide That means you can lose control of your vehicle See Traction Control System TCS on page 329 and StabiliTrak System on page 331 Adding non GM accessories can affect your vehicle s performance See Accessories and Modifications on page 363 326 Braking See Brake System Warning Light on page 192 Braking action involves perception time and reaction time First you have to decide to push on the brake pedal That is perception time Then you have to bring up your foot and do it That is reaction time Average reaction time is about three fourths of a second But that is only an average It might be less with one driver and as long as two or three seconds or more with another Age physical condition alertness coordination and eyesight all play a part So do alcohol drugs and frustration But even in three fourths of a second a vehicle moving at 60 mph 100 km h travels 66 feet 20 m That could be a lot of distance in an emergency so keeping enough space between your vehicle and others is important And of course actual stopping distances vary greatly with the surface of the road whether it is pavement or gravel the condition of the road whether it is wet dry or icy tire tread the condition of the brakes the weight of the vehicle and
264. hicle like suitcases tools packages or anything else they will go as fast as the vehicle goes If you have to stop or turn quickly or if there is a crash they will keep going A CAUTION Things you put inside your vehicle can strike and injure people in a sudden stop or turn or in a crash e Put things in the rear area of your vehicle Try to spread the weight evenly Never stack heavier things like suitcases inside the vehicle so that some of them are above the tops of the seats Do not leave an unsecured child restraint in your vehicle When you carry something inside the vehicle secure it whenever you can Towing Towing Your Vehicle Consult your dealer or a professional towing service if you need to have your disabled vehicle towed See Roadside Service on page 487 Recreational Vehicle Towing Recreational vehicle towing means towing your vehicle behind another vehicle such as behind a motorhome The two most common types of recreational vehicle towing are known as dinghy towing towing your vehicle with all four wheels on the ground and dolly towing towing your vehicle with two wheels on the ground and two wheels up on a device known as a dolly Your vehicle was not designed to be towed with any of its wheels on the ground If your vehicle must be towed see Towing Your Vehicle earlier in this section Towing a Trailer Your XLR is neither designed nor intende
265. hime will be provided for several seconds to remind people to buckle their safety belts The driver safety belt light will also be provided and stay on for several seconds then it will flash for several more You should buckle your seat belt This chime and light will be repeated if the driver remains unbuckled and the vehicle is in motion LZ If the driver s belt is buckled neither the chime nor the light will be provided 187 Airbag Readiness Light There is an airbag readiness light on the instrument panel cluster which shows a deployed airbag symbol The system checks the airbag s electrical system for malfunctions The light tells you if there is an electrical problem The system check includes the airbag modules the wiring and the diagnostic module For more information on the airbag system see Airbag System on page 44 This light will come on when you start your vehicle and it will flash for a few seconds Then the light should go out This means the system is ready e N If the airbag readiness light stays on after you start the vehicle or comes on when you are driving your airbag system may not work properly Have your vehicle serviced right away 188 A CAUTION If the airbag readiness light stays on after you start your vehicle it means the airbag system may not be working properly The airbags in your vehicle may not inflate in a crash or they could even inflate without a crash
266. ians will perform the work using genuine GM parts If you want to purchase service information see Service Publications Ordering Information on page 497 Owner Checks and Services on page 470 tells you what should be checked when to check it and what you can easily do to help keep your vehicle in good condition The proper replacement parts fluids and lubricants to use are listed in Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 473 and Normal Maintenance Replacement Parts on page 475 When your vehicle is serviced make sure these are used All parts should be replaced and all necessary repairs done before you or anyone else drives the vehicle We recommend the use of genuine GM parts Scheduled Maintenance When the CHANGE OIL NOW message in the Driver Information Center DIC comes on it means that service is required for your vehicle Have your vehicle serviced as soon as possible within the next 600 miles 1 000 km It is possible that if you are driving under the best conditions the engine oil life system may not indicate that vehicle service is necessary for over a year However your engine oil and filter must be changed at least once a year and at this time the system must be reset Your GM Goodwrench dealer has GM trained service technicians who will perform this work using genuine GM parts and reset the system If the engine oil life system is ever reset accidentally you must service your vehicle within 3 000 m
267. icle Tires ceeeee 435 Light Airbag Readiness aeee 188 Anti Lock Brake System Warning 193 Brake System Warning ccccceeeeeeeeees 192 Charging System 0 cceeeeeeeeeeeteeeeeeeeeees 191 Fog LAMP wcsitesedestcviwtesmbactelsisectantbtedes 201 Highbeam ON ceeeeceeceeteeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaaaeeees 202 Light cont Lights On Reminder c a 202 Malfunction Indicator ccceeeeeeeeeees 196 Passenger Airbag Status Indicator 189 Safety Belt Reminder eeceeees 187 SECUN iieeiavieed en ee 201 TCS Warning Light ccce 194 Tire PrOSSUPE rrira ieia 196 Traction Control System TCS WANING ossea i a anean i 194 Lighting Enty EXit case ceicesien sie vchudetcetnavesavndedctensiids 170 Limited Slip Rear Axle o a 331 Loading Your Vehicle eeeeeeeeeeeeeneeeeees 354 LOCKOUT Protectio misiismo acekard 77 Locks Automatic Door LOCK sarisini ni 76 DOOM sesicdsteva cousdaiedavanaasadetavccasancetuuneteieigenevates 73 LOCKOUT Protection sescssessincaeaneutscacaisencedenbe wee 77 Power DOOM innia r 75 Programmable Automatic Door Unlock 76 Loss Of Control ccccececeeeeeeeeeeneeeeeeeaeeeeees 337 Lowering the Retractable Hardtop 124 Lumbar Power Controls cccccesseeceeeeeeeeeeeeaeeeeeees 9 506 Magnetic Ride Control aeee 331 Maintenance Schedule Additional Required Services
268. icle position do the following 1 Touch the Adjust Vehicle Position screen button The system will display Position Adjustment The vehicle location symbol and the scroll symbol will appear on the map 2 Use the scroll symbol and the zoom in zoom out feature to locate the vehicle position on the map 3 Touch Enter to set the vehicle position The system will display Position Adjustment and two arrows will appear on the map screen 4 Touch the arrows to adjust the direction of the vehicle As you touch the arrows you will see the vehicle symbol direction changing 244 5 When you have set the vehicle to the correct direction touch Enter Relocation Complete will be displayed 6 Touch Return to exit this menu Calibrate Vehicle Speed Signal If there are tire pressure differences or if a spare tire is installed the navigation system will automatically recalibrate the system You may also choose to calibrate it yourself by doing the following 1 Touch Start to begin calibration 2 Touch Return to exit this menu Time to Destination This feature allows you to view the estimated time to travel from your current position to the destination and to reset the average speed to factory default settings Estimated travel time is based on calculated route information and the vehicle s average speed Touch ON to turn this feature on OFF to turn this feature off or Reset to restore vehicle speed default settings Wi
269. ifferent tire sizes front to rear should not be rotated 427 When It Is Time for New Tires One way to tell when it is time for new tires is to check the treadwear indicators which will appear when your tires have only 1 16 inch 1 6 mm or less of tread remaining You need a new tire if any of the following statements are true e You can see the indicators at three or more places around the tire e You can see cord or fabric showing through the tire s rubber e The tread or sidewall is cracked cut or snagged deep enough to show cord or fabric e The tire has a bump bulge or split e The tire has a puncture cut or other damage that cannot be repaired well because of the size or location of the damage 428 Buying New Tires GM has developed and matched specific tires for your vehicle The original equipment tires installed on your vehicle when it was new were designed to meet General Motors Tire Performance Criteria Specification TPC spec system rating If you need replacement tires GM strongly recommends that you get tires with the same TPC Spec rating This way your vehicle will continue to have tires that are designed to give the same performance and vehicle safety during normal use as the original tires GM s exclusive TPC Spec system considers over a dozen critical specifications that impact the overall performance of your vehicle including brake system performance ride and handling tractio
270. ight of this screen button Touch this screen button to toggle between time zones and select the desired one The time of the selected zone will be displayed to the right of the GPS TIME screen button To set the clock to the new setting touch GPS TIME If the system is not receiving GPS information you can still set the time manually as described above but the GPS time and Daylight Saving Time features will not be available Touch Return to go back to the previous menu 288 Screen Adjust Menu Bante t SCREEN OFF _ The following options are available from this menu Contrast Touch the plus or minus signs to adjust the contrast of the screen You will see the screen change Touch SET to confirm the setting xx Brightness Touch the plus or minus signs to adjust the brightness of the screen You will see the screen change Touch SET to confirm the setting AUTO This setting automatically adjusts the contrast and brightness of the screen depending on exterior lighting conditions DAY This setting leaves the screen in day mode Day mode is best suited for daylight conditions NIGHT This setting leaves the screen in night mode Night mode is best suited for nighttime conditions SCREEN OFF Touch SCREEN OFF to turn off the screen Press any hard key to turn the screen back on SET Touch SET to save your choices and exit the CLOCK ADJUST menu Language Your vehicle ha
271. il that the oil level gets above the cross hatched area that shows the proper operating range the engine could be damaged 378 See Engine Compartment Overview on page 374 for the location of the engine oil fill cap E7 hAM Meili SAE 5W 30 Be sure to add enough oil to put the level somewhere in the proper operating range Push the dipstick all the way back in when you are through What Kind of Engine Oil to Use RECOMMENDED SAE VISCOSITY GRADE ENGINE OILS HOT WEATHER FIT c LOOK FOR THIS SYMBOL A ror AND GM 4GASOLINEE STANDARD QENGINES SS CERTE Ca GM4718M DO NOT USE SAE 10W 40 SAE 20W 50 OR ANY OTHER VISCOSITY GRADE OIL NOT RECOMMENDED COLD WEATHER Look for two things e GM4718M Your vehicle s engine requires a special oil meeting GM Standard GM4718M Oils meeting this standard may be identified as synthetic However not all synthetic oils will meet this GM standard You should look for and use only an oil that meets GM Standard GM4718M Notice If you use oils that do not have the GM4718M Standard designation you can cause engine damage not covered by your warranty e SAE 5W 30 As shown in the viscosity chart SAE 5W 30 is best for your vehicle These numbers on an oil container show its viscosity or thickness Do not use other viscosity oils such as SAE 20W 50 Oils meeting these requirements should also have the starburst symbol on the container This symbol
272. iles 5 000 km since your last service Remember to reset the oil life system whenever the oil is changed See Engine Oil Life System on page 380 for information on the Engine Oil Life System and resetting the system When the CHANGE OIL NOW message appears certain services checks and inspections are required Required services are described in the following for Maintenance I and Maintenance II Generally it is recommended that your first service be Maintenance I your second service be Maintenance II and that you alternate Maintenance I and Maintenance II thereafter However in some cases Maintenance II may be required more often 465 Maintenance I Use Maintenance I if the Maintenance II Use Maintenance II if the CHANGE OIL NOW message comes on within previous service performed was Maintenance I 10 months since the vehicle was purchased Always use Maintenance II whenever the message or Maintenance II was performed comes on 10 months or more since the last service or if the message has not come on at all for one year Scheduled Maintenance OOo eO J Maintenance T Maintenance n Change engine oil and filter See Engine Oil on page 377 Reset oil life system See Engine Oil Life System on page 380 An Emission Control Service Visually check for any leaks or damage See footnote a ooo e o e e Inspect engine air cleaner filter If necessary replace filter See Engine Air Cleaner Filter on page 382 Se
273. ill go about 1 mph 1 6 km h faster Passing Another Vehicle While Using Cruise Control Use the accelerator pedal to increase your speed When you take your foot off the pedal your vehicle will slow down to the cruise control speed you set earlier 149 Using Cruise Control on Hills How well your cruise control works on hills depends upon your speed load and the steepness of the hills When going up steep hills you might have to step on the accelerator pedal to maintain your speed When going downhill you might have to brake or shift to a lower gear to keep your vehicle s speed down Of course applying the brake turns off the cruise control Many drivers find this to be too much trouble and do not use cruise control on steep hills Ending Cruise Control There are two ways to turn off the cruise control e Step lightly on the brake pedal e Move the cruise control switch to off Erasing Speed Memory Turning off the cruise control or the ignition will erase your cruise control set speed memory 150 Adaptive Cruise Control If your vehicle has this feature be sure to read this entire section before using it The system operates on a radio frequency subject to Federal Communications Commission FCC Rules and with Industry Canada This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules Operation is subject to the following two conditions 1 This device may not cause interference 2 This device must accept any
274. iming Your vehicle has high intensity discharge HID visual optical aiming type headlamps The aim has been preset at the factory and should need no further adjustment If you suspect that the headlamps need to be reaimed it is recommended that you contact your dealer for service However it is possible for you to re aim your headlamps as described in the following procedure Notice To make sure your headlamps are aimed properly read all the instructions before beginning Failure to follow these instructions could cause damage to headlamp parts The vehicle should be properly prepared as follows The vehicle should be placed so the headlamps are 25 ft 7 6 m from a light colored wall The vehicle must have all four tires on a perfectly level surface which is level all the way to the wall The vehicle should be placed so it is perpendicular to the wall The vehicle should not have any snow ice or mud attached to it The vehicle should be fully assembled and all other work stopped while headlamp aiming is being done The vehicle should be normally loaded with a full tank of fuel and one person or 160 Ibs 75 kg on the driver s seat Tires should be properly inflated Start the vehicle and rock it to level the suspension Headlamp aiming is done with the low beam headlamps The high beam headlamps are correctly aimed
275. in a POI by name using the alpha key pad As you type in a name the system will search for an available match to your input Select the desired POI e Select a POI by touching CATEGORY Use the arrows to scroll through the categories listed Select a category along with any appropriate sub categories If the list of available POls for the selected category is too long you may need to enter the POPs name or city e Select CITY then type in the city you wish to select a POI from Choose a city from the list of cities that will appear If the list of POls for the selected city is too long enter the POIs name or choose a category While inputting a POI or city name the List option will become available Touch List to view the list of name choices or continue to spell the name to further reduce the list of available items The system will list all POIs available You can sort by name using NAME SORT or touch DIST SORT to list POls by distance from your current location Select a location from the list The system will show the selected POI on the map If available a pop up window will be displayed Touch INFO to view the POI s name address city and phone number if available Touch Enter to plan your route Memory Points This destination entry method allows you to set a memory point as your destination Each time you store a destination from the map screen the destination is stored under MARKED POINT
276. in or other drivers are going to be careless your vehicle Buckle up See Safety Belts They and make mistakes Anticipate what they Are for Everyone on page 13 might do and be ready Rear end collisions are about the most preventable of accidents Yet they are common Allow enough following distance Defensive driving requires that a driver concentrate on the driving task Anything that distracts from the driving task makes proper defensive driving more difficult and can even cause a collision with resulting injury Ask a passenger to help do these things or pull off the road in a safe place to do them These simple defensive driving techniques could save your life 322 Drunken Driving Death and injury associated with drinking and driving is a national tragedy It is the number one contributor to the highway death toll claiming thousands of victims every year Alcohol affects four things that anyone needs to drive a vehicle e Judgment e Muscular Coordination e Vision e Attentiveness Police records show that almost half of all motor vehicle related deaths involve alcohol In most cases these deaths are the result of someone who was drinking and driving In recent years more than 16 000 annual motor vehicle related deaths have been associated with the use of alcohol with more than 300 000 people injured Many adults by some estimates nearly half the adult population choose never to drink alcohol so th
277. information you have entered for each preset station will be recalled Repeat the steps for additional presets Adjusting the Speakers 9 27PM 85 F DSP Digital Signal Processing The DSP feature is used to provide a choice of four different listening experiences DSP can be used while listening to the audio system or the CD player The audio system can store separate DSP settings for each source and preset station except WX which is always set to TALK To save DSP settings for your preset stations use the SOUND menu or touch DSP from the preset station menu to access the DSP menu See Sound Menu listed previously in this section for more information Touch DSP to change the following options ON OFF Touch ON OFF to turn DSP on and off DRIVER SEAT Touch this button to adjust the audio to give the driver the best possible sound quality TALK TALK makes spoken words sound very clear Touch this button when listening to non musical material such as news talk shows and sports broadcasts SPACIOUS Touch this button to make the listening space seem larger SOUND Touch SOUND to access the Sound menu See Sound Menu listed previously in this section for more information 293 Radio Data Systems RDS PTYMSG ST Soft Reck 2 10PM 85 F 294 The audio system has a Radio Data System RDS RDS features are available for use only on FM stations that broadcast RDS informati
278. ing will have a somewhat lower BAC level There is a gender difference too Women generally have a lower relative percentage of body water than men Since alcohol is carried in body water this means that a woman generally will reach a higher BAC level than a man of her same body weight will when each has the same number of drinks The law in most U S states and throughout Canada sets the legal limit at 0 08 percent In some other countries the limit is even lower For example it is 0 05 percent in both France and Germany The BAC limit for all commercial drivers in the United States is 0 04 percent The BAC will be over 0 10 percent after three to six drinks in one hour Of course as we have seen it depends on how much alcohol is in the drinks and how quickly the person drinks them But the ability to drive is affected well below a BAC of 0 10 percent Research shows that the driving skills of many people are impaired at a BAC approaching 0 05 percent and that the effects are worse at night All drivers are impaired at BAC levels above 0 05 percent Statistics show that the chance of being in a collision increases sharply for drivers who have a BAC of 0 05 percent or above A driver with a BAC level of 0 06 percent has doubled his or her chance of having a collision At a BAC level of 0 10 percent the chance of this driver having a collision is 12 times greater at a level of 0 15 percent the chance is 25 times greate
279. inside the vehicle when it is turned to off the DIC displays NO FOB OFF OR RUN See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 206 for more information 91 Automatic Transmission Operation There are several different positions for the shift lever PARK P This position locks the rear wheels It is the best position to use when you starting the engine because your vehicle cannot move easily 92 A CAUTION It is dangerous to get out of your vehicle if the shift lever is not fully in PARK P with the parking brake firmly set Your vehicle can roll Do not leave your vehicle when the engine is running unless you have to If you have left the engine running the vehicle can move suddenly You or others could be injured To be sure your vehicle will not move even when you are on fairly level ground always set your parking brake and move the shift lever to PARK P See Shifting Into Park P on page 99 Be sure the shift lever is fully in PARK P before starting the engine Your vehicle has an automatic transmission shift lock control system You have to fully apply the regular brakes first and then press the shift lever button before you can shift from PARK P when the vehicle is running If you cannot shift out of PARK P ease pressure on the shift lever and push the shift lever all the way into PARK P as you maintain brake application Then press the shift lever button and move the shift lever into anoth
280. interference received including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device This device complies with RSS 210 of Industry Canada Operation is subject to the following two conditions 1 This device may not cause interference 2 This device must accept any interference received including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device Changes or modifications to this system by other than an authorized service facility could void authorization to use this equipment Adaptive Cruise Control is an enhancement to traditional cruise control and is not a safety system It allows you to keep cruise control engaged in moderate traffic conditions without having to constantly reset your cruise control Adaptive Cruise Control uses radar to detect a vehicle directly ahead in your path within a distance of 328 ft 100 m and operates at speeds above 25 mph 40 km h When it is engaged by the driver the system can apply limited braking or acceleration of the vehicle automatically to maintain a selected follow distance to the vehicle ahead Braking is limited to 0 3 g s 2 95 m sec2 of deceleration which is comparable to moderate application of the vehicle s brakes To disengage Adaptive Cruise Control apply the brake If there is not a vehicle in your path your vehicle will react like traditional cruise control A CAUTION Adaptive Cruise Control will not apply hard braking or bring the vehic
281. ions because the audio system remembers them However you will have to reset your away radio preset stations Voice Recognition The navigation system s voice recognition allows for hands free operation of navigation and audio system features Voice recognition can be used when the ignition is on or when Retained Accessory Power RAP is active 312 This feature only works if the map DVD is inserted and AGREE has been selected If you try to use voice recognition without the map DVD inserted the system will display Please insert the navigation map DVD to use the voice recognition feature To use navigation voice recognition do the following 1 Press the talk e symbol steering wheel control and release it when you hear a beep The audio system if on will mute 2 Clearly state one of the commands listed on the following pages For example say FM1 3 The system will tell you the command being implemented For example the system will say FM1 Radio and change the audio system to the FM1 source You can end voice recognition by not speaking any commands After about five seconds of silence the system will automatically cancel voice recognition At times the system may not understand a spoken command If this happens try saying the command again If a spoken command is not available the system will provide feedback based on availability While using voice recognition make sur
282. ir goes out of a tire it is much more likely to leak out slowly See Tires on page 413 for additional information Your vehicle when new had run flat tires This type of tire can operate effectively with no air pressure so you will not need to stop on the side of the road to change a flat tire You can just keep on driving The shorter the distance you drive and the slower the speed the greater the chance that the run flat tire will not have to be replaced Run flat tires perform so well without any air that a Tire Pressure Monitor TPM is used to alert you if a tire has lost pressure See Run Flat Tires on page 420 and Tire Pressure Monitor System on page 423 440 A CAUTION When the TIRE FLAT MAX SPD 55 REDUCED HNDLG message is displayed on the Driver Information Center your vehicle s handling capabilities will be reduced during severe maneuvers If you drive too fast you could lose control of your vehicle You or others could be injured Don t drive over 55 mph 90 km h when the TIRE FLAT MAX SPD 55 REDUCED HNDLG message is displayed Drive cautiously and check your tire pressures as soon as you can If the TPM system detects a tire pressure below 5 psi 34 kPa the TIRE FLAT MAX SPD 55 REDUCED HNDLG warning message is displayed on the Driver Information Center DIC See DIC Controls and Displays on page 204 and DIC Warnings and Messages on page 206 for information and details about the DIC operation
283. is a critical problem with the airbag system or the passenger sensing system When the passenger s frontal airbag and side impact airbag have been turned off by the passenger sensing system the off indicator will light and stay lit to remind you that the airbags are off If a child restraint has been installed and the on indicator is lit turn the vehicle off Remove the child restraint from the vehicle and reinstall the child restraint following the child restraint manufacturer s directions and refer to Securing a Child Restraint in the Passenger Seat Position on page 40 If after reinstalling the child restraint and restarting the vehicle the on indicator is still lit check to make sure that the vehicle s seatback is not pressing the child restraint into the seat cushion If this happens slightly recline the vehicle s seatback and adjust the seat cushion if possible If the on indicator is still lit do not secure the child restraint in this vehicle and check with your dealer 55 The passenger sensing system is designed to enable may inflate the passenger s frontal airbag and side impact airbag anytime the system senses that a person of adult size is sitting properly in the passenger s seat When the passenger sensing system has allowed the airbags to be enabled the on indicator will light and stay lit to remind you that the airbags are active For some children who have outgrown child restraints and for very small
284. ker will stop the wipers until the motor cools So be sure to clear any ice and snow from the windshield wiper blades before using them If the wiper blades are frozen to the windshield carefully loosen them or warm the windshield before turning the wipers on If your blades do become worn or damaged get new blades or blade inserts Rainsense Wipers Your vehicle has Rainsense wipers The moisture sensor for this feature is mounted on the interior side of the windshield below the rearview mirror and is used to automatically operate the wipers by monitoring the amount of moisture build up on the windshield Wipes occur as needed to clear the windshield depending on driving conditions and the sensitivity setting In light rain or snow fewer wipes will occur In heavy rain or snow wipes will occur more frequently The Rainsense wipers operate in a delay mode as well as a continuous low or high speed as needed If the system is left on for long periods of time occasional wipes may occur without any moisture on the windshield This is normal and indicates that the Rainsense system is activated The Rainsense system is also sensitive to vibration The system may activate if something hits the windshield or if the vehicle hits a bump The Rainsense system can be activated by moving the wiper lever up to the delay position and turning the delay adjust band to one of the five sensitivity levels The bottom delay adj
285. l display a SERVICE RIDE CONTROL message See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 206 for more information See your dealer for service Limited Slip Rear Axle Your limited slip rear axle can give you additional traction on snow mud ice sand or gravel It works like a standard axle most of the time but when one of the rear wheels has no traction and the other does this feature will allow the wheel with traction to move the vehicle StabiliTrak System The StabiliTrak System is a computer controlled system that helps the driver maintain directional control of the vehicle in difficult driving conditions This is accomplished by selectively applying any one of the vehicle s brakes When you first start your vehicle and begin to drive away 6 mph 10 km h especially during cold weather the message STABILITRAK WARMING may be displayed in the Driver Information Center DIC the instrument panel cluster light will be on and a chime will sound This is normal You can acknowledge this message by pressing the RESET button The StabiliTrak System performance is affected until the message STABILITRAK READY is displayed in the DIC This can take up to 15 minutes The WAIT FOR STABILITRAK message may be displayed in the DIC after exceeding 19 mph 30 km h for 10 seconds if the steering is not centered The system is off until the STABILITRAK ACTIVE message is displayed 331 The STABILITRAK ACTIVE message will come
286. l equipment when not in use Leaving electrical equipment on for extended periods will drain your vehicle s battery Certain electrical accessories may not be compatible with the accessory power outlet and could result in blown vehicle or adapter fuses If you experience a problem see your dealer for additional information on accessory power outlets Notice Adding any electrical equipment to your vehicle may damage it or keep other components from working as they should The repairs would not be covered by your warranty Do not use equipment exceeding maximum amperage rating of 20 amperes Check with your dealer before adding electrical equipment When adding electrical equipment be sure to follow the installation instructions included with the equipment We recommend that you see a qualified technician or your dealer for the proper installation of your equipment Notice Improper use of the power outlet can cause damage not covered by your warranty Do not hang any type of accessory or accessory bracket from the plug because the power outlets are designed for accessory power plugs only 177 Ashtray s and Cigarette Lighter The ashtray and cigarette lighter are located under a lid in the front console to the right of the shift lever Press the left side of the lid and it will open automatically Notice lf you put papers pins or other flammable items in the ashtray hot cigarettes or other smoking materials could
287. l mute while scanning Forward Touch this button to fast forward quickly through a track selection 304 A TUNE SEEK v Press the up arrow on the TUNE SEEK switch to seek to the next selection on the compact disc If playing last track of disc pressing the up arrow will seek to the first track of the next disc Press the down arrow to seek to the previous selection on the compact disc If playing the first track of disc pressing the down arrow will seek to the last track on the selected disc The sound will mute while seeking RDS Radio Data Systems See Radio Data Systems RDS listed previously for information on this button SOUND See Sound Menu Tone DSP Fade and Balance for information on this button DSP Digital Signal Processing See Adjusting the Speakers listed previously for information on this button CD Changer Errors CDX ERROR could be displayed for the following e The road is too rough The disc should play when the road is smoother e The disc is dirty scratched wet or not loaded label side up e The air is very humid If so wait about an hour and try again If any error occurs repeatedly or if an error cannot be corrected please contact your GM dealer If your audio system displays an error number write it down and provide this information to your dealer when reporting the error CD DVD Player The player that is used for the navigation map DVD can also
288. l Vehicle 0 eeeeseeeeeeeeeees 359 Towing a WANG ecctcsteecetcuavventetiadsectsives cents 359 YOUN VONICIC esre A 359 Traction Control System TCS a e 329 Control System Warning Light 194 Limited Slip Rear Axle ceeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 331 Magnetic Ride Control a se 331 StabiliTrak System cicestveonsctsrnuesienssddsdouss 331 Transmission Fluid AUtOMaticC cccccceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 384 Transmission Operation Automatic 92 Trip Computer Oil Life Indicator eisni 224 Trip Odometer cccceeeeeeeeeeteeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeas 187 MMU erana E wean anne eamattes ates 77 Turn and Lane Change Signals 0 142 Turn Signal Multifunction Lever 05 141 Twilight Sentinel wccsesicsirrecrrensidesandeasenetuces 168 U Ultrasonic Rear Parking Assist URPA 175 Understanding Radio Reception 228 Uniform Tire Quality Grading 0 0c0 431 Universal Home Remote System 110 111 Operation cceecceeeseeeeeeeeeeeeeteeeees 112 118 Valet Lockout Switch cceeeeeeseseeeeeeeeeeees 86 Vehicle Control occidentale 326 Damage Warnings cseeeeesteeeeeeeneeeeeees 5 LOAGIAG csicves care iesiri naaa 354 MSVIMDOINS sraa a a eN 5 Vehicle Data Collection and Event Data Recorders Vehicle Identification Number VIN Service Parts Identification Label Vehicle Personalization DIC sett
289. l reminder to the Safety Belt Reminder Light in the instrument panel cluster See Safety Belt Reminder Light on page 187 for more information CHANGE OIL NOW This message displays when the life of the engine oil has expired See Scheduled Maintenance on page 465 After an oil change the Oil Life Indicator must be reset See Oil Life Indicator on page 224 and Engine Oil Life System on page 380 CHARGE SYSTEM FAULT This message displays when a problem with the charging system has been detected Have your vehicle serviced by your dealer CHECK GAS CAP This message displays if the fuel cap has not been fully tightened Check the fuel cap to make sure that it is on properly 207 CLEAN RADAR CRUISE If your vehicle has this feature this message displays when the Adaptive Cruise Control ACC system is disabled because the radar is blocked and cannot detect vehicles in your path It may also activate during heavy rain or due to road spray To clean the system see Adaptive Cruise Control on page 150 CLOSE CARGO DIVIDER This message displays if the cargo divider is not in place Open the trunk and make sure the cargo divider is secure and no objects are on the divider See Rear Storage Area on page 123 for more information COOLANT OVER TEMP Temperature This message displays when the engine coolant temperature is too hot Stop and allow your vehicle to idle in PARK P until it cools down and the message is removed
290. lamps on and off OPTIONS Press this button to choose personal options that are available on your vehicle 204 RESET Press this button to reset a feature It is also used to switch between English and Metric options Use the information button to scroll through the following options ODOMETER This feature shows how far the vehicle has been driven in either miles mi or kilometers km Use the ENG METRIC feature to switch between English and Metric units TRIP A This feature will record the distance traveled since the last time it was reset Press and hold the RESET button to return to zero If your vehicle is first sold in the United States the trip odometer will return to zero after 999 9 miles 1 609 km If your vehicle is first sold in Canada the trip odometer will return to zero after 1 242 miles 1 999 km TRIP B This feature allows you to record the distance traveled during a second trip and functions the same as TRIP A RANGE xxx MI This feature shows about how many miles mi or kilometers km you can drive without refilling your fuel tank Once the range drops below 40 miles 64 km remaining the display will show LOW If the vehicle has been idling for a long time the range displayed on the DIC could be abnormally low The vehicle must be driven 5 10 miles 8 16 km to get an accurate reading AVERAGE xx x MPG Average Miles Per Gallon This feature shows the approximate fuel economy the vehi
291. ldren And there are different rules for smaller children and babies If a child will be riding in your vehicle see Older Children on page 28 or Infants and Young Children on page 31 Follow those rules for everyone s protection First you will want to know which restraint systems your vehicle has We will start with the driver position Driver Position Lap Shoulder Belt The driver has a lap shoulder belt Here is how to wear it properly 1 Close and lock the door 2 Adjust the seat so you can sit up straight To see how see Seats in the Index Make sure the release button on the buckle is positioned so you would be able to unbuckle the safety belt quickly if you ever had to 3 Pick up the latch plate and pull the belt across you Do not let it get twisted The lap shoulder belt may lock if you pull the belt across you very quickly If this happens 5 To make the lap part tight pull up on the let the belt go back slightly to unlock it shoulder belt Then pull the belt across you more slowly It may be necessary to pull stitching on the 4 Push the latch plate into the buckle until it safety belt through the latch plate to fully clicks tighten the lap belt on smaller occupants Pull up on the latch plate to make sure it is secure If the belt is not long enough see Safety Belt Extender on page 27 19 20 N TND fal 4 N Y y A G i ie PIN lt 7
292. le If this happens place the transmitter in the glove box transmitter pocket with the buttons facing to the right Then with the vehicle in PARK P or NEUTRAL N press the brake pedal and the START button Although this will start the vehicle it is recommended that you replace the transmitter battery as soon as possible The DIC may display FOB BATTERY LOW Notice When replacing the battery use care not to touch any of the circuitry Static from your body transferred to these surfaces may damage the transmitter 72 Insert a flat object with a thin edge into the slot on the side of the transmitter and separate the bottom half from the top half Gently pull the battery out of the transmitter Put the new battery in the transmitter positive side up Use a battery type CR2032 or equivalent Reassemble the transmitter Make sure to put it together so water will not get in Test the transmitter Doors and Locks Door Locks A CAUTION Unlocked doors can be dangerous e Passengers especially children can easily open the doors and fall out of a moving vehicle When a door is locked it will not open You increase the chance of being thrown out of the vehicle in a crash if the doors are not locked So wear safety belts properly and lock the doors whenever you drive Young children who get into unlocked vehicles may be unable to get out A child can be overcome by extreme heat and c
293. le hardtop if leaving your vehicle outdoors 1 Park on a level surface and shift the transmission into PARK P 2 The vehicle s engine must be on or in Acc 3 Lower both sun visors Notice Raising or lowering the top while the vehicle is in motion can cause damage to the top or top mechanism Make sure the vehicle is in PARK P to lower or raise the top Notice Lowering the top if it is damp wet or dirty can cause stains mildew and damage to the inside of your vehicle Dry off the top before lowering it 4 Make sure that nothing or no one is on or around the top Make sure the trunk cargo cover is in place with nothing on top or in front of the cargo cover See Rear Storage Area on page 123 for more information Also make sure the valet lockout switch is off 5 Push and hold the bottom of the retractable hardtop SN button located on the console pea behind the shifter lever NAIA The windows will automatically lower and the top will automatically lower into the storage area A chime will sound when the top has lowered completely If the radio is on the sound may be muted briefly while the retractable top is lowered This occurs because a new audio system equalization is being loaded Under certain conditions the Driver Information Center DIC may display messages regarding the retractable hardtop If the CLOSE CARGO DIVIDER TOO COLD TO MOVE TOP TOP INOP VALET ON TOP INOP OUT OF PARK TOP
294. le to a complete stop It will not respond to stopped vehicles pedestrians or animals When you are approaching a vehicle or object Adaptive Cruise Control may not have time to slow your vehicle enough to avoid a collision Your complete attention is always required while driving and you should be ready to take action and apply the brakes For more information see Defensive Driving on page 322 151 Z CAUTION CAUTION Continued e On slippery roads fast changes in tire On winding roads Adaptive Cruise traction can cause needless wheel 152 Control may not detect a vehicle ahead You could crash into a vehicle ahead of you Do not use Adaptive Cruise Conirol on winding roads Adaptive Cruise Control may not have time to slow your vehicle enough to avoid a crash when you are driving in conditions where vehicles may suddenly slow or stop ahead of you enter your lane or cross your vehicle s path If you are driving in these conditions do not use Adaptive Cruise Control The warning beep and alert symbol may indicate that you are driving in conditions where Adaptive Cruise Control should not be used See Alerting the Driver in this section CAUTION Continued spinning and you could lose control Do not use cruise control on slippery roads When weather limits visibility such as when in fog rain or snow conditions Adaptive Cruise Control performance is limited There may not be enough di
295. ll be able to feel the temperature change in a few minutes The feature will automatically turn off when the vehicle is turned off See Dual Climate Control System on page 178 for more information Memory Seat Mirrors and Steering Wheel Your vehicle is equipped with the memory package The controls for these features are located on the drivers seat and are used to program and recall memory settings for the drivers seating positions Use the following steps to program each button 1 Adjust the drivers seat including the seatback recliner lumbar both outside mirrors and the steering wheel to a comfortable position 2 Press and hold button 1 until two beeps are heard then release the button A second mirror seating and steering wheel position can be programmed by repeating the above steps and pressing button 2 for driver 2 Each time a memory button is pressed and released a single beep will sound Each time button 1 or 2 is pressed and released while the vehicle is in PARK P the memory positions will be recalled after a brief delay If the vehicle is not in PARK P three beeps will be heard and the memory position will not be recalled When the engine is started the seat mirrors and steering wheel may automatically adjust to their programmed positions To stop recall movement of the memory feature at any time press one of the power seat controls power mirror control buttons memory buttons or power st
296. lt pretensioners can help tighten the safety belts in a side crash Pretensioners work only once If they activate in a crash you will need to get new ones and probably other new parts for your safety belt system See Replacing Restraint System Parts After a Crash on page 61 Safety Belt Extender If the vehicle s safety belt will fasten around you you should use it But if a safety belt is not long enough your dealer will order you an extender When you go in to order it take the heaviest coat you will wear so the extender will be long enough for you To help avoid personal injury do not let someone else use it and use it only for the seat it is made to fit The extender has been designed for adults Never use it for securing child seats To wear it just attach it to the regular safety belt For more information see the instruction sheet that comes with the extender 27 Child Restraints Older Children Older children who have outgrown booster seats should wear the vehicle s safety belts 28 Q What is the proper way to wear safety belts A If possible an older child should wear a lap shoulder belt and get the additional restraint a shoulder belt can provide The shoulder belt should not cross the face or neck The lap belt should fit snugly below the hips just touching the top of the thighs It should never be worn over the abdomen which could cause severe or even fatal internal injuries in a crash
297. m The AM FM antennas are located under the decklid surface in the trunk compartment The antennas are hidden from view and are not accessible 230 If adding an aftermarket cellular telephone to your vehicle do not attach the antenna to the rear glass This would interfere with the convertible top retraction operation and could cause damage to the finished painted surfaces XM Satellite Radio Antenna System Your vehicle may have the XM Satellite Radio antennas that are located in the outside rear view mirrors These antennas are hidden from view and are not accessible Section 4 OVErVIEW iini deen aaiae 232 Navigation System Overview eee 232 Getting Started scsreinircnirisnirenan 234 Features and Controls cccccceeeee 240 Using the Navigation System 0 0 240 Setup Menu cccceeeeceteteeeeeeeeeeeeees 243 Plan ROUI sic2ssssiescavisieetevsavieeee aie 249 Edit Memory Point lecer 250 Edit Waypoint wicca sscussnassuecdeeswetveanseccoreesetes 254 Edit Avoid Point Area ceeceeeeeteteeeeeeees 257 Enter Destination cccceeeeeeeteeeeeeeeetees 259 Route Preference ccccseeeeeeseeeeeeeeeeees 269 eT e e AE E ET ede en E A E T E ATA 271 SYVMDOINS sirisser ienn eaaa 275 Keyless Access System 280 Navigation System OnStar System o sosieieisieieineieinneineein 281 Global Positioning System GPS 281 Vehicle Positioning es
298. make a high pitched warning sound when the brake pads are worn and new pads are needed The sound may come and go or be heard all the time your vehicle is moving except when you are pushing on the brake pedal firmly A CAUTION The brake wear warning sound means that soon the brakes will not work well That could lead to an accident When you hear the brake wear warning sound have your vehicle serviced Notice Continuing to drive with worn out brake pads could result in costly brake repair Some driving conditions or climates may cause a brake squeal when the brakes are first applied or lightly applied This does not mean something is wrong with your brakes Brake linings should always be replaced as complete axle sets Brake Pedal Travel See your dealer if the brake pedal does not return to normal height or if there is a rapid increase in pedal travel This could be a sign of brake trouble Brake Adjustment As you make brake stops your disc brakes automatically adjust for wear Replacing Brake System Parts The braking system on a vehicle is complex Its many parts have to be of top quality and work well together if the vehicle is to have really good braking Your vehicle was designed and tested with top quality GM brake parts When you replace parts of your braking system for example when your brake linings wear down and you need new ones put in be sure you get new approved GM replacement parts If
299. mation 238 Entering a Point of Interest POI To set a destination by entering a Point of Interest POI do the following iP 2 N Press the power volume knob to turn the system on Insert the DVD map disc See Regional Maps under Maps on page 271 for more information Anotice may appear Touch the AGREE screen button to proceed If the radio is already on with a map disc inserted press the ROUTE hard key Press the Enter Destination screen button Verify that the selected Search Area is correct Press the All Points of Interest screen button Enter the specific title of the POI in the Name space i e Washington Monument using the alpha keypad on the screen Select the POI from the list Press the Enter screen button to plan your route Using the Category or City selections will aid the system in finding your POI by limiting the search options See All Points of Interest under Enter Destination on page 259 for more information Storing a Home Destination 1 2 Press the power volume knob to turn the system on Insert the DVD map disc See Regional Maps under Maps on page 271 for more information A notice may appear Touch the AGREE screen button to proceed If the radio is already on with a map disc inserted press the ROUTE hard key Press the Edit Memory Point screen button Press the Home screen button Press the Register screen bu
300. ment Panel Vinyl and Other Plastic SUMACES ssicefssdeaenccievesaweesenevanee ce 444 LOANO normearre a seeiaataccste 444 Sheet Metal Damage n 449 Speaker Covers ccceceeeeeetteeeeeeeeeees 445 WINGS ice ccasepec aca steete A T 449 Underbody Maintenance eee 449 Vehicle Care Appearance Materials 450 Washing Your Vehicle assesseer 446 Appearance Care cont WeatherstripS c eeccsseeeeeeeneeeeeeeeneerees 445 Windshield and Wiper Blades 447 Wood Panels sass diese staztoseosdipenecshvniseresanerss 445 Ashtray S seinest san aaka aaea seen 178 Audio System ssosssriciernni iis 285 Audio System S cccceeeeeeeeteeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 225 Audio Steering Wheel Controls 227 Care of Your CD Player ccecce 230 Care of Your CDS cccceeeeeeeeeeteteeeeeeees 229 Diversity Antenna System eeeeeeeee 230 Theft Deterrent Feature cence 226 Understanding Radio Reception 228 XM Satellite Radio Antenna System 230 Automatic Door LOCK ceecee 76 Automatic Transmission Oe ceive nchansagcesnaittgnavetendosneanagavexeeand enemas 384 OP SALON ea cscs discs saien seanrenterajaniiedbens sebenceadesings 92 Avoid Point Area Edit 257 B Battery sic scsaaencnnssAiee seal adeecncaianececaveececndee tine 402 Exterior Lighting Battery Saver 0 169 Run Down Protection ccecce 171 Before Leaving on a Long Trip
301. mmand will cause the system to display tourist attraction POI icons Winery This command will cause the system to display winery POI icons City Hall This command will cause the system to display city hall POI icons Police Station This command will cause the system to display police station POI icons Library This command will cause the system to display library POI icons Hospital This command will cause the system to display hospital POI icons Park amp Recreation Parks amp Recreation These commands will cause the system to display parks and recreation POI icons Civic Center Community Center These commands will cause the system to display community center POI icons Convention Center Exhibition Center These commands will cause the system to display convention center POI icons 319 Court House This command will cause the system to display court house POI icons Train Station This command will cause the system to display train station POI icons Airport This command will cause the system to display airport POI icons Bus Station This command will cause the system to display bus station POI icons Commuter Rail Station This command will cause the system to display commuter rail station POI icons Ferry Terminal This command will cause the system to display ferry terminal POI icons Park amp Ride This command will cause the system to display park amp ride POI icons Rest Area Res
302. mps on and turn on the hazard warning flashers when the airbags inflate You can lock the doors turn the interior lamps off and turn the hazard warning flashers off by using the controls for those features In many crashes severe enough to inflate an airbag windshields are broken by vehicle deformation Additional windshield breakage may also occur from the right front passenger airbag e Airbags are designed to inflate only once After they inflate you will need some new parts for the airbag system If you do not get them the airbag system will not be there to help protect you in another crash A new system will include airbag modules and possibly other parts The service manual for your vehicle covers the need to replace other parts e Your vehicle has a crash sensing and diagnostic module which records information after a crash See Vehicle Data Collection and Event Data Recorders on page 491 e Let only qualified technicians work on your airbag system Improper service can mean that an airbag system will not work properly See your dealer for service Passenger Sensing System Your vehicle has a passenger sensing system The passenger airbag status indicator in the rearview mirror will be visible when you start the vehicle PASSENGER AIR BAG eam ON United States Ro Ri Canada The words ON and OFF or the symbol for on and off will be visible during the system check When the system check is compl
303. n Touch Sensitive Buttons Touch sensitive buttons or screen buttons are located on the screen When you have successfully selected a screen button a beep will be heard These buttons will be highlighted when a feature is available and dim when they are unavailable There are some toggle screen buttons that will be light blue when active and dark blue when inactive Setup Menu Navigation Settings MENU Press the MENU key located to the This manu allows you ta change Me following right of the navigation screen to access the options for the navigation system SETUP MENU RDS 87 7MHz _ _1 29AM 85F_ SETUP MENU 877 MHz 1 31AM 85 F O oa 00 Restore Default Settings The SETUP MENU allows you to adjust such This feature will automatically reset the system to things as map appearance navigation settings the default values and voice guidance volume To restore the default settings do the following 1 Touch the Restore Default Settings screen button 2 Touch Enter 3 Touch Return to exit this menu 243 System Configuration This feature allows you to reconfigure the navigation system If you begin to drive your vehicle during this procedure the system will not be able to adjust the position or direction of your vehicle Touch the System Configuration screen button to view the following choices Adjust Vehicle Position To correct the position of your vehicle on the map or to change veh
304. n system faceplate for loading or removing the map DVD a video DVD or an audio CD This key can only be used while the vehicle is in PARK P 241 Alpha Numeric Keypad Letters of the alphabet symbols punctuation and numbers when available to you will be displayed on the navigation screen as an alpha or numeric keypad The alpha keypad will be displayed when the system needs you to input a city or street name You can also touch Char at the bottom of the alpha keypad to access the numeric keypad when inputting a house address punctuation mark or other character Touch A Z to return to the alpha keypad All characters are touch sensitive screen buttons Touch a character to select it Select the space symbol to enter a space between characters or the words of a name lt Select the backspace symbol if you have selected an incorrect character To make your name selections easier the system will only allow you to select a character which can follow the last one entered For example if you enter Z you would not be allowed to follow it with T The system will highlight the available characters and darken the unavailable characters 242 If you are unsuccessful when inputting a name it may need to be selected differently It is also possible that the map DVD database may not contain that information or the correct search area has not been selected See Database Coverage Explanations on page 284 for more informatio
305. n the windshield washer fluid reservoir and add the proper fluid if necessary At Least Once a Month Tire Inspection and Inflation Check Visually inspect your vehicle s tires for wear and make sure they are inflated to the correct pressures See Inflation Tire Pressure on page 422 At Least Once a Year Starter Switch Check A CAUTION When you are doing this inspection the vehicle could move suddenly If the vehicle moves you or others could be injured 1 Before you start be sure you have enough room around the vehicle 2 Firmly apply both the parking brake and the regular brake See Parking Brake on page 97 Do not use the accelerator pedal and be ready to turn off the engine immediately if it starts 3 Try to start the engine in each gear The vehicle should start only in PARK P or NEUTRAL N If the vehicle starts in any other position contact your GM Goodwrench dealer for service 471 Transmission Shift Lock Control System Check A CAUTION When you are doing this inspection the vehicle could move suddenly If the vehicle moves you or others could be injured 1 Before you start be sure you have enough room around the vehicle It should be parked on a level surface 2 Firmly apply the parking brake See Parking Brake on page 97 Be ready to apply the regular brake immediately if the vehicle begins to move 3 With the engine off and without applying the regular brake t
306. n the wipers on Position the wipers on the windshield in the mid wipe position Then with a door open turn the vehicle off 2 Tip the blade up and pull up on the tab to release the wiper blade assembly 3 To install align the wiper blade with the loop on the wiper blade assembly and push up to snap it into place Tires Your new vehicle comes with high quality tires made by a leading tire manufacturer If you ever e Underinflated tires pose the same have questions about your tire warranty and where danger as overloaded tires The to obtain service see your GM Warranty booklet for resulting accident could cause serious details For additional information refer to the tire injury Check all tires frequently to manufacturer s booklet included with your vehicle maintain the recommended pressure Tire pressure should be checked when your vehicle s tires are cold See Inflation Tire Pressure on page 422 Overinflated tires are more likely to be cut punctured or broken by a sudden impact such as when you hit a pothole Keep tires at the recommended pressure Worn old tires can cause accidents If the tire s tread is badly worn or if your vehicle s tires have been damaged replace them CAUTION Continued A CAUTION Poorly maintained and improperly used tires are dangerous e Overloading your vehicle s tires can cause overheating as a result of too much friction You could have an air out and a seriou
307. n a planned route 4 Touch Return to go back to the previous screen Enter Destination The DESTINATION menu will give you several ways to plan a route Touch the Enter Destination screen button from the PLAN ROUTE menu to display the DESTINATION menu For destination entry methods listed on the second page of the DESTINATION menu touch the Next Page arrow Touch the Prev Page arrow to return to the first page To enter a destination choose from one of the destination entry methods following in this section After entering a destination If available the system will display up to three routes in a pop up window indicating the total mileage and time to destination for each route Select a route by touching NEXT The map will display each route in a different color The selected route will be highlighted in red To start route guidance touch Start or begin driving your vehicle Route guidance will automatically begin after a short distance If you touch CHG ROUTE before touching Start you will be able to change route preferences See Route Preference on page 269 for more information When a route has been planned it will be highlighted and a bulls eye symbol will appear on the map to show your final destination If you wish to cancel a route that has been set see Cancel Route under Route Preference on page 269 259 Easy Planning Route With this destination entry method you can select a desti
308. n control and tire pressure monitoring performance GM s TPC Spec number is molded onto the tire s sidewall by the tire manufacturer If the tires have an all season tread design the TPC spec number will be followed by an MS for mud and snow See Tire Sidewall Labeling on page 415 for additional information Winter tires with the same speed rating as your original equipment tires may not be available for H V W Y and ZR speed rated tires If you choose snow tires with a lower speed rating never exceed the tire s maximum speed capability A CAUTION Mixing tires could cause you to lose control while driving If you mix tires of different sizes other than those originally installed on your vehicle brands or types radial and bias belted tires the vehicle may not handle properly and you could have a crash Using tires of different sizes other than those originally installed on your vehicle brands or types may also cause damage to your vehicle Be sure to use the correct size brand and type tires on all four wheels A CAUTION If you use bias ply tires on your vehicle the wheel rim flanges could develop cracks after many miles of driving A tire and or wheel could fail suddenly causing a crash Use only radial ply tires with the wheels on your vehicle If you must replace your vehicle s tires with those that do not have a TPC Spec number make sure they are the same size load range speed rati
309. n will sound once A Unlock Press this button once to unlock the driver s door The indicator light on the door will flash twice Press the button twice within 10 seconds to unlock both doors If it is dark enough outside your interior lamps will come on Your memory settings may also be recalled when you press the unlock button on the keyless access transmitter See Memory Seat Mirrors and Steering Wheel on page 10 for more information etm Trunk Press and hold this button for about one second to open the trunk while the engine is turned off or the shift lever is in PARK P Matching Transmitter s to Your Vehicle Each keyless access transmitter is coded to prevent another transmitter from working with your vehicle If a transmitter is lost or stolen a replacement can be purchased through your dealer Remember to bring any remaining transmitters with you when you go to your dealer Once your dealer has coded the new transmitter the lost transmitter will not work with your vehicle Each vehicle can have a maximum of four transmitters matched to it To match a new transmitter to your vehicle when you have a recognized transmitter do the following 1 The vehicle must be off 2 Have the recognized and new unrecognized transmitters on your person 3 Go to the rear of the vehicle and insert the vehicle key into the key cylinder located on the lower rear fascia on the driver s side of the vehicle See Trunk on
310. n your route Home This destination entry method allows you to select a destination that has been previously stored as Home ine Route Setting Minimize Distance Use Major Roads Use Toll Roads Use Ferries TE To choose Home as your destination do the following 1 Touch the Home symbol 2 Touch Enter to plan your route 265 Set by Map This destination entry method allows you to select a destination by using the scroll symbol 12 14AM 85 F TA a5 005 To use this feature do the following 1 Touch the Set By Map symbol Current vehicle position will be shown on the map screen 266 2 Use the scroll symbol to select the desired destination The zoom in and zoom out feature can be used to assist you in finding the desired location See Map Scales under Maps on page 271 3 Touch Enter to plan your route Freeway Entrance Exit This destination entry method allows you to select either a freeway entrance or an exit as a destination To enter a freeway name do the following 1 Touch the Freeway Entrance Exit symbol 2 Enter the freeway name using the alpha key pad Freeways sometimes have a name and a number associated with them which you may need to refer to when entering freeway information Freeways are also referred to by their abbreviated names For example Interstate 75 in the U S is selected by entering I 75 As you enter a freewa
311. n your vehicle using the following cleaners or techniques e Never use a knife or any other sharp object to remove a soil from any interior surface e Never use a stiff brush It can cause damage to your vehicle s interior surfaces e Never apply heavy pressure or rub aggressively with a cleaning cloth Use of heavy pressure can damage your interior and does not improve the effectiveness of soil removal e Use only mild neutral pH soaps Avoid laundry detergents or dishwashing soaps with degreasers Using too much soap will leave a residue that leaves streaks and attracts dirt For liquid cleaners about 20 drops per gallon 3 78 L of water is a good guide e Do not heavily saturate your upholstery while cleaning e Damage to your vehicle s interior may result from the use of many organic solvents such as naptha alcohol etc Fabric Carpet Use a vacuum cleaner with a soft brush attachment frequently to remove dust and loose dirt A canister vacuum with a beater bar in the nozzle may only be used on floor carpet and carpeted floor mats For soils always try to remove them first with plain water or club soda Before cleaning gently remove as much of the soil as possible using one of the following techniques e For liquids gently blot the remaining soil with a paper towel Allow the soil to absorb into the paper towel until no more can be removed e For solid dry soils remove as much as possible and then vacuum
312. nStar System Universal Home Remote System Universal Home Remote System With One Triangular LED 0008 Universal Home Remote System With Three Round LED Universal Home Remote System Operation With Three Round LED Universal Home Remote System Operation With One Triangular LED 63 Section 2 Features and Controls Storage Areas eerren 121 Floor Malbeno 122 Glove BOX uss ciasarhted savanna nni nenene n daaa 121 Rear Storage Area a e 123 Cupholder S ercran 122 Convenience Net cccceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 123 Center Console Storage Area 122 Retractable Hardtop c cccceseseeeeeeeee 124 Map Pocket scaisscscteviccevesdidndsieevecntvesstontaterss 122 Lowering the Retractable Hardtop 424 Raising the Retractable Hardtop 125 64 Keys A CAUTION Leaving children unattended in a vehicle is dangerous but it is even more dangerous if the keyless access transmitter is also left in the vehicle A child or others could be badly injured or even killed They could operate the power windows or other controls or even make the vehicle move If they started the engine and moved the shift lever out of PARK P that would release the parking brake Do not leave the keyless access transmitter in a vehicle with children 65 66 This key located inside the keyless access transmitter can be used for the glove box and the trunk if
313. na crash you could go into it receiving neck or other injuries The lap belt cannot do its job either In a crash the belt could go up over your abdomen The belt forces would be there not at your pelvic bones This could cause serious internal injuries For proper protection when the vehicle is in motion have the seatback upright Then sit well back in the seat and wear your safety belt properly Do not have a seatback reclined if your vehicle is moving Safety Belts Safety Belts They Are for Everyone This part of the manual tells you how to use safety belts properly It also tells you some things you should not do with safety belts A CAUTION Do not let anyone ride where he or she can not wear a safety belt properly If you are in a crash and you are not wearing a safety belt your injuries can be much worse You can hit things inside the vehicle or be ejected from it You can be seriously injured or killed In the same crash you might not be if you are buckled up Always fasten your safety belt and check that your passenger s belt is fastened properly too A CAUTION It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area inside or outside of a vehicle In a collision people riding in these areas are more likely to be seriously injured or killed Do not allow people to ride in any area of your vehicle that is not equipped with seats and safety belts Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and
314. nal destination The Estimated Travel Time feature must be on for estimated travel time to be displayed This symbol indicates the distance to your final destination in a straight line This symbol will appear before route guidance begins or if you are on a road where route guidance is not available 276 This symbol indicates the map with North up While in North up mode North will always be at the top of the map screen regardless of which direction the vehicle is traveling The shaded triangle indicates North While in Heading up mode the direction your vehicle is traveling will always be at the top of the map screen Touch either the North Up heading symbol or the vehicle Heading Up symbol to alternate between settings This symbol indicates the map with the vehicle travel direction up or Heading up This symbol will appear when the navigation system is unable to receive the GPS signal See Global Positioning System GPS on page 281 for more information When a point of interest POI or street address name is too long to be displayed an arrow will appear Touch the right or left arrow to scroll through the entire name This symbol indicates the position of the next turn instruction While on a planned route touch this symbol to display the DEST MAP WHOLE and TURN LIST options 277 With these options you can do the following RDS TP PTY MSG 43AM oF LiteRock Soft R
315. nation using the scroll symbol on the map screen See Maps on page 271 260 To use this destination entry method do the following 1 Press the MAP key 2 Touch the map screen twice for the scroll symbol to appear Touch the map or drag the scroll symbol toward your destination Touch the map screen continuously to scroll through the map faster The address of the location on the map will appear at the top of the screen If needed use the zoom feature to locate your destination See Map Scales under Maps on page 271 for more information Touch ENT DEST to set this location as your destination You may also touch MARK to store this location as a memory point 5 Touch Enter to plan your route Address This destination entry method allows you to input an address by providing the system with a house number street name and city Select Street to begin entering the desired address 102 5MHz 2 42AM 85 F To use this destination entry method do the following 1 Enter the street name using the alpha keypad See Alpha Numeric Keypad under Using the Navigation System on page 240 for more information Do not include name extensions such as N or Drive For example the street name N Civic Center Drive should be entered as Civic Center As information is entered the system will automatically search for available names and List will become available Tou
316. nd hold down the two outside buttons until the indicator light begins to flash after 20 seconds Do not hold the two outside buttons for longer than 30 seconds 2 Release both buttons The Universal Home Remote is now in the training learning mode and can be programmed at any time beginning with Step 2 under Programming Universal Home Remote shown earlier in this section Individual buttons cannot be erased but they can be reprogrammed See Reprogramming a Single Universal Home Remote Button following this section Reprogramming a Single Universal Home Remote Button To program a device to Universal Home Remote using a Universal Home Remote button previously trained follow these steps 1 Press and hold the desired Universal Home Remote button Do not release the button 2 The indicator light will begin to flash after 20 seconds While still holding the Universal Home Remote button proceed with Step 2 under Programming Universal Home Remote shown earlier in this section For additional information on Universal Home Remote see Customer Assistance Offices on page 485 Storage Areas Glove Box To open the glove box lift up on the lever The glove box has a light inside Use the key to lock and unlock 121 Cupholder s The cupholders are located under a lid in the front console to the right of the shift lever Press the left side of the lid and it will open automatically Center Consol
317. nd push the parking brake pedal down with your left foot If the ignition is on the parking brake indicator light on the instrument panel cluster should come on If it does not you need to have your vehicle serviced When you move out of PARK P or NEUTRAL N and the engine is running the parking brake should release If the parking brake has not been fully released and you try to drive off with the parking brake on the parking brake indicator light will come on and stay on If the parking brake does not fully release you can manually release the pedal A CAUTION Always shift to PARK P before pulling the manual release lever If your hand or arm is in the way of the pedal you could be hurt The pedal springs back quickly Keep your hand and arm away when you use the manual release lever Before releasing the manual parking brake be sure to put the vehicle in PARK P and turn the ignition off 97 98 Reach under the driver s side of the instrument panel and pull down on the manual release lever which is located behind the parking brake pedal Pull down on the yellow tab If the parking brake does not release you should have your vehicle towed to your dealer for service Notice Driving with the parking brake on can overheat the brake system and cause premature wear or damage to brake system parts Verify that the parking brake is fully released and the brake warning light is off before driving
318. nd your vehicle Safety Belt Use During Pregnancy Safety belts work for everyone including pregnant women Like all occupants they are more likely to be seriously injured if they do not wear safety belts 26 A pregnant woman should wear a lap shoulder belt and the lap portion should be worn as low as possible below the rounding throughout the pregnancy The best way to protect the fetus is to protect the mother When a safety belt is worn properly it is more likely that the fetus will not be hurt in a crash For pregnant women as for anyone the key to making safety belts effective is wearing them properly Passenger Position To learn how to wear the passenger s safety belt properly see Driver Position on page 18 The passenger s safety belt works the same way as the driver s safety belt except for one thing If you ever pull the shoulder portion of the belt out all the way you will engage the child restraint locking feature If this happens just let the belt go back all the way and start again Safety Belt Pretensioners Your vehicle has safety belt pretensioners for the driver and right front passenger Although you cannot see them they are part of the safety belt assembly They help tighten the safety belts during the early stages of a moderate to severe frontal and near frontal crash if the threshold conditions for pretensioner activation are met And if your vehicle has side impact airbags safety be
319. ndicated on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label you should determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those tires As an added safety feature your vehicle has been equipped with a tire pressure monitoring system TPMS that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when one or more of your tires is significantly under inflated Accordingly when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates you should stop and check your tires as soon as possible and inflate them to the proper pressure Driving on a significantly under inflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure Under inflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life and may affect the vehicle s handling and stopping ability Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire maintenance and it is the driver s responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure even if under inflation has not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate when the system is not operating properly The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire pressure telltale When the system detects a malfunction the telltale will flash for approximately one minute and then remain continuously illuminated This sequence will continue upon subsequent vehicle start ups as long as the malfunction exists
320. ndle sensor while you have the transmitter with you Unlocking a door any other way will set off the alarm If your alarm sounds press the unlock button on the keyless access transmitter to disarm it 86 Valet Lockout Switch The valet lockout switch is located inside the glove box eee Press the switch to ON to disable the use of the trunk and convertible top The trunk cannot be opened except by using the key if the valet lockout is on Press the switch to OFF to enable the use of the trunk and convertible top Locking the glove box with your key will also help to secure your vehicle Starting and Operating Your e Avoid making hard stops for the first 200 miles 322 km or so During this time Vehicle your new brake linings are not yet broken in Hard stops with new linings can New Vehicle Break In mean premature wear and earlier replacement Follow this breaking in Notice Your vehicle does not need an guideline every time you get new brake elaborate break in But it will perform better in linings the long run if you follow these guidelines Following break in engine speed and load can e Keep your speed at 55 mph 88 km h be gradually increased or less for the first 500 miles 805 km e Do not drive at any one constant speed fast or slow for the first 500 miles 805 km Do not make full throitle starts Avoid downshifting to brake or slow the vehicle 87 Ignition Positions Your vehicl
321. ne it replaces If you need to replace any of your wheels wheel bolts or wheel nuts replace them only with new GM original equipment parts This way you will be sure to have the right wheel wheel bolts and wheel nuts for your vehicle A CAUTION Using the wrong replacement wheels wheel bolts or wheel nuts on your vehicle can be dangerous It could affect the braking and handling of your vehicle make your tires lose air and make you lose control You could have a collision in which you or others could be injured Always use the correct wheel wheel bolts and wheel nuts for replacement Notice The wrong wheel can also cause problems with bearing life brake cooling speedometer or odometer calibration headlamp aim bumper height vehicle ground clearance and tire clearance to the body and chassis A CAUTION Rust or dirt on a wheel or on the parts to which it is fastened can make wheel nuts become loose after a time The wheel could come off and cause a crash When you change a wheel remove any rust or dirt from places where the wheel attaches to the vehicle In an emergency you can use a cloth or a paper towel to do this but be sure to use a scraper or wire brush later if you need to to get all the rust or dirt off A CAUTION Never use oil or grease on studs or the threads of the wheel nuts If you do the wheel nuts might come loose and the wheel could fall off causing a crash 433 Tighte
322. nents from working as they should Add on equipment can drain your vehicle s battery even if your vehicle is not operating Your vehicle has an airbag system Before attempting to add anything electrical to your vehicle see Servicing Your Airbag Equipped Vehicle on page 58 452 Windshield Wiper Fuses The windshield wiper motor is protected by an internal circuit breaker If the wiper motor overheats due to heavy snow the wipers will stop until the motor cools and will then restart A fuse powers the wiper motor If the fuse blows there is an electrical problem Be sure to have it fixed Power Windows and Other Power Options Circuit breakers protect the power windows and power seats When the current load is too heavy the circuit breaker opens and closes protecting the circuit until the problem is fixed or goes away Fuses and Circuit Breakers The wiring circuits in your vehicle are protected from short circuits by a combination of fuses and circuit breakers This greatly reduces the chance of fires caused by electrical problems Look at the silver colored band inside the fuse If the band is broken or melted replace the fuse Be sure you replace a bad fuse with a new one of the identical size and rating If a fuse should blow see your dealer for service immediately If you ever have a problem on the road and do not have a spare fuse you can borrow one that has the same amperage Pick some feature
323. ner 282 Problems with Route Guidance 283 If the System Needs Service 00008 283 Ordering Map DVDS ocen 284 Database Coverage Explanations 284 Navigation Audio System 20 285 Six Disc CD Changer seses 302 CD DVD Player esirin conas ioa 305 Radio Personalization with Home and Away Feature sesssssssrirenerrrresrnrrenrrrnens 311 Voice Recognition a 312 231 Overview Navigation System Overview 232 BAND Key See Finding a Station under Navigation Audio System on page 285 CD Key See Navigation Audio System on page 285 or CD DVD Player on page 305 DVD Key See Playing a DVD under CD DVD Player on page 305 TUNE SEEK Key See Playing the Radio under Navigation Audio System on page 285 Audio Adjust Key See Main Audio Menu under Navigation Audio System on page 285 Power Volume Knob See Hard Keys under Using the Navigation System on page 240 Navigation System Screen RPT Repeat Key See Hard Keys under Using the Navigation System on page 240 MAP Key See Hard Keys under Using the Navigation System on page 240 ROUTE Key See Hard Keys under Using the Navigation System on page 240 MENU Key See Hard Keys under Using the Navigation System on page 240 TILT Key See Hard Keys under Using the Navigation System on page 240 233 Getting Started
324. ng and construction type radial and bias belted tires as your vehicle s original tires Vehicles that have a tire pressure monitoring system may give an inaccurate low pressure warning if non TPC spec rated tires are installed on your vehicle Non TPC Spec rated tires may give a low pressure warning that is higher or lower than the proper warning level you would get with TPC Spec rated tires See Tire Pressure Monitor System on page 423 429 Your vehicle s original equipment tires are listed on the Tire and Loading Information label This label is attached to the vehicle s center pillar B pillar See Loading Your Vehicle on page 354 for more information about the Tire and Loading Information label and its location on your vehicle Different Size Tires and Wheels If you add wheels or tires that are a different size than your original equipment wheels and tires this may affect the way your vehicle performs including its braking ride and handling characteristics stability and resistance to rollover Additionally if your vehicle has electronic systems such as anti lock brakes traction control and electronic stability control the performance of these systems can be affected 430 A CAUTION If you add different sized wheels your vehicle may not provide an acceptable level of performance and safety if tires not recommended for those wheels are selected You may increase the chance that you will crash and
325. ng airbag Be sure the airbag is off before using a rear facing child restraint in the passenger s position Even though the passenger sensing system is designed to turn off the passenger s frontal airbag and side impact airbag if equipped if the system detects a rear facing child restraint no system is fail safe and no one can guarantee that an airbag will not deploy under some unusual circumstance even though it is turned off We recommend that CAUTION Continued CAUTION Continued rear facing child restraints be transported in vehicles with a rear seat that will accommodate a rear facing child restraint whenever possible If you need to secure a forward facing child restraint in the passenger s seat always move the passenger s seat as far back as it will go It is better to secure the child restraint in a rear seat The passenger sensing system is designed to turn off the passenger s frontal airbag and side impact airbag if e The passengers seat is unoccupied e The system determines that an infant is present in a rear facing infant seat e The system determines that a small child is present in a forward facing child restraint e The system determines that a small child is present in a booster seat e A passenger takes his her weight off of the seat for a period of time e The passengers seat is occupied by a smaller person such as a child who has outgrown child restraints e Or if there
326. ng fan under the hood can start up even when the engine is not running and can injure you Keep hands clothing and tools away from any underhood electric fan If the coolant inside the coolant surge tank is boiling do not do anything else until it cools down The vehicle should be parked on a level surface A Electric Engine Cooling Fan B Coolant Surge Tank with Pressure Cap 391 A low coolant level should be indicated by a LOW COOLANT message on the Driver Information Center DIC If it is you may have a leak at the pressure cap or in the radiator hoses heater hoses radiator water pump or somewhere else in the cooling system A CAUTION Heater and radiator hoses and other engine parts can be very hot Do not touch them If you do you can be burned Do not run the engine if there is a leak If you run the engine it could lose all coolant That could cause an engine fire and you could be burned Get any leak fixed before you drive the vehicle If there seems to be no leak with the engine on check to see if the electric engine cooling fan is running If the engine is overheating the fan should be running If it is not your vehicle needs service 392 Notice Engine damage from running your engine without coolant is not covered by your warranty See Overheated Engine Protection Operating Mode on page 390 for information on driving to a safe place in an emergency Notice Using coolant other th
327. ng fuel information from the PCM SERVICE RADAR CRUISE If your vehicle has this feature this message displays when the Adaptive Cruise Control ACC system is disabled and needs service See your dealer SERVICE RIDE CONTROL This message displays when there is a problem with the Magnetic Ride Control System Have your vehicle serviced by your dealer SERVICE TRACTION SYS System This message displays when there is a problem with the Traction Control System TCS Have your vehicle serviced by your dealer SERVICE STABILITRAK If this message displays it means there may be a problem with the stability enhancement system If you see this message try to reset the system Stop turn off the engine then start the engine again If this message still comes on it means there is a problem You should see your dealer for service Reduce your speed and drive accordingly A single chime also sounds when this message is displayed SERVICE TRANSMISSION This message displays when there is a problem with the transmission Have your vehicle serviced by your dealer SERVICE VEHICLE SOON This message displays when a non emissions related powertrain malfunction occurs Have your vehicle serviced by your dealer as soon as possible 215 SHIFT TO PARK This message displays if the vehicle is not in PARK P when the engine is being turned off The vehicle will be in accessory mode Once the shift lever is moved to PARK P
328. ng them toward the vehicle This feature may be useful when going through a car wash or a confined space Push the mirrors away from the vehicle to the normal position before driving Outside Automatic Dimming Mirror The driver s side mirror will adjust for the glare of headlamps behind you This feature is controlled by the on and off settings on the inside automatic dimming rearview mirror See Automatic Dimming Rearview Mirror with OnStar on page 104 105 Outside Curb View Assist Mirror The passengers side mirror is also capable of performing the curb view assist feature This feature will cause the mirror to tilt to a factory programmed position when the vehicle is in REVERSE R This feature may be useful in allowing you to view the curb when you are parallel parking If further adjustment is needed after the mirror is tilted the mirror switch may be used The mirror will then return to this new position when the vehicle is shifted into REVERSE R When the vehicle is shifted out of REVERSE R and a five second delay has occurred the passengers side mirror will return to its original position This feature can be enabled disabled through the Driver Information Center DIC See Park Assist under DIC Vehicle Personalization on page 220 for more information 106 Outside Convex Mirror A CAUTION A convex mirror can make things like other vehicles look farther away than they really are If you cu
329. ngs Under the Hood A CAUTION Things that burn can get on hot engine parts and start a fire These include A CAUTION liquids like fuel oil coolant brake fluid windshield washer and other fluids and plastic or rubber You or others could be burned Be careful not to drop or spill things that will burn onto a hot engine An electric fan under the hood can start up and injure you even when the engine is not running Keep hands clothing and tools away from any underhood electric fan 372 Hood Release To lift the hood use the following steps 1 Pull the lever with this symbol on it It is located on the lower left side of the instrument panel 2 Then go to the front of the vehicle and find the secondary hood release lever The lever is located under the hood near the center of the vehicle Move the release lever to the right and raise the hood Before closing the hood be sure all filler caps are on properly Then pull the hood down and close it firmly 373 Engine Compartment Overview When you open the hood on the 4 6L V8 engine here is what you will see 374 Battery See Battery on page 402 Passenger Compartment Air Filter See Passenger Compartment Air Filter on page 184 Underhood Fuse Block See Underhood Fuse Block on page 455 Power Steering Fluid See Power Steering Fluid on page 396 Engine Air Cleaner Filt
330. ning Wheel Lug Nuts A CAUTION Incorrect wheel nuts or improperly tightened wheel nuts can cause the wheel to become loose and even come off This could lead to a crash Be sure to use the correct wheel nuts If you have to replace them be sure to get new GM original equipment wheel nuts Notice Improperly tightened wheel nuts can lead to brake pulsation and rotor damage To avoid expensive brake repairs evenly tighten the wheel nuts in the proper sequence and to the proper torque specification 434 Tighten the wheel lug nuts firmly in a crisscross sequence as ay shown OO Used Replacement Wheels A CAUTION Putting a used wheel on your vehicle is dangerous You cannot know how it has been used or how far it has been driven It could fail suddenly and cause a crash If you have to replace a wheel use a new GM original equipment wheel Tire Chains A CAUTION Do not use tire chains There is not enough clearance Tire chains used on a vehicle without the proper amount of clearance can cause damage to the brakes suspension or other vehicle parts The area damaged by the tire chains could cause you to lose control of your vehicle and you or others may be injured in a crash Use another type of traction device only if its manufacturer recommends it for use on your vehicle and tire size combination and road conditions Follow that manufacturer s instructions To help avoid damage to your
331. not cause harmful interference 2 This device must accept any interference received including interference that may cause undesired operation The FCC Grant of Equipment Authorization Certificate number is CB2SAHL3 This device complies with RSS 210 of Industry Canada Operation is subject to the following two conditions 1 This device may not cause interference 2 This device must accept any interference received including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device The Canadian Registration ID number is 2791021849A Changes or modifications to this system by other than an authorized service facility could void authorization to use this equipment Universal Home Remote System With Three Round LED The Universal Home Remote System provides a way to replace up to three hand held radio frequency RF transmitters used to activate devices such as garage door openers security systems and home lighting This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules Operation is subject to the following two conditions 1 This device may not cause harmful interference 2 This device must accept any interference received including interference that may cause undesired operation The FCC Grant of Equipment Authorization Certificate number is KOBGTVO6A 111 This device complies with RSS 210 of Industry Canada Operation is subject to the following two conditions 1 This device may not cause inte
332. not cause the system to heat or cool any faster If you set the system at the warmest or coldest temperature setting the system will remain in manual mode at that temperature and it will not go into automatic mode In cold weather the system will start at reduced fan speeds to avoid blowing cold air into your vehicle until warmer air is available The system will start out blowing air at the floor but may change modes automatically as the vehicle warms up to maintain the chosen temperature setting The length of time needed for warm up will depend on the outside temperature and the length of time that has elapsed since your vehicle was last driven 3 Wait for the system to regulate This may take from 10 to 30 minutes Then adjust the temperature if necessary You can switch from English to metric units through the Driver Information Center DIC See DIC Controls and Displays on page 204 for more information The air conditioning system removes moisture from the air so you may sometimes notice a small amount of water dripping underneath your vehicle while idling or after turning off the engine This is normal Do not cover the solar sensor located in the center of the instrument panel near the windshield For more information on the solar sensor see Sensors later in this section 179 Manual Operation A PWR V Power Temperature Press the PWR button on the left side of the climate control panel to turn the en
333. not tell if your tires are properly inflated simply by looking at them Radial tires may look properly inflated even when they are underinflated Check the tire s inflation pressure when the tires are cold Cold means your vehicle has been sitting for at least three hours or driven no more than 1 mile 1 6 km Remove the valve cap from the tire valve stem Press the tire gage firmly onto the valve to get a pressure measurement If the cold tire inflation pressure matches the recommended pressure on the Tire and Loading Information label no further adjustment is necessary If the inflation pressure is low add air until you reach the recommended amount If you overfill the tire release air by pushing on the metal stem in the center of the tire valve Recheck the tire pressure with the tire gage Be sure to put the valve caps back on the valve stems They help prevent leaks by keeping out dirt and moisture Tire Pressure Monitor TPM Your vehicle has a Tire Pressure Monitor TPM that sends tire pressure information to the Driver Information Center DIC Using the DIC control buttons the driver is able to check tire pressure levels in all four road tires See Tire Pressure Monitor System on page 423 and DIC Controls and Displays on page 204 for additional information Tire Pressure Monitor System Your vehicle has a Tire Pressure Monitor System TPMS This system uses radio and sensor technology to check tire pressure
334. nt 6 Speed Automatic Air Conditioning Refrigerant R134a All capacities are approximate When adding be sure to fill to the approximate level as recommended in this manual Recheck fluid level after filling 458 Engine Specifications Engine O Vinco Spark Plug Gap 4 4L V8 bf aome 0040 inches 102 mm 4 6L V6 0 050 inches 1 27 mm XLR V Engine Data Engine Horsepower Torque Displacement Compression Ratio 443 hp 330 kW 414 lb ft 561 Nm 6400 rpm 3900 rpm i S0 4 4L V8 V Series 459 4 NOTES 460 Section 7 Maintenance Schedule Maintenance Schedule 0 e 462 Owner Checks and Services na sana 470 IMMOGUCUION sinais eieaa iaa eA 462 At Each Fuel Fill sossut 470 Maintenance Requirements acene 462 At Least Once a Month seese 471 Your Vehicle and the Environment 462 At Least Once a Year ceeccceeeeeeeeeeeeeees 471 Using the Maintenance Schedule 463 Recommended Fluids and Lubricants 473 Scheduled Maintenance n s 465 Normal Maintenance Replacement Parts 475 Additional Required Services 008 467 Engine Drive Belt Routing eee 476 Maintenance Footnotes 0 ceeseeeeeee 469 Maintenance Record ceeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 477 461 Maintenance Schedule Introduction Important Keep engine oil at the proper level and change as recommended Protection Plan H
335. nt no system is fail safe and no one can guarantee that an airbag will not deploy under some unusual circumstance even though it is turned off We recommend that rear facing child restraints be transported in vehicles with a rear seat that will accommodate a rear facing child restraint whenever possible 190 If the word ON or the on symbol is lit on the passenger airbag status indicator it means that the passenger s frontal airbag and side impact airbag are enabled may inflate A CAUTION If the on indicator comes on when you have a rear facing child restraint installed in the passenger s seat it means that the passenger sensing system has not turned off the passenger s frontal airbag and side impact airbag if equipped A child ina rear facing child restraint can be seriously injured or killed if the passenger s airbag inflates This is because the back of the rear facing child restraint would be very close to the inflating airbag Do not use a rear facing child restraint in the passenger s seat if the airbag is turned on If the word OFF or the off symbol is lit on the Charging System Light passenger airbag status indicator it means that the passenger sensing system has turned off When you turn the the passenger s airbags See Passenger Sensing engine on this light will System on page 53 for more on this including come on briefly to important safety information show that the generator If after sever
336. nt which has been stored by selecting the MARK screen button while traveling on a planned route You can also use the scroll feature to plan a destination on the map after reaching the destination or by moving a memory point to a marked point category See Editing Memory Points earlier in this section for more information 253 Previous Destination Memory Each time you select Start from the map screen that destination will be stored as a memory point under PREVIOUS DESTINATION This category will store up to 10 destinations When the Previous Destination category contains more than 10 destinations the system will remove the oldest destination stored and add the most recent one selected to the list If you do not want a previous destination to be lost you must move the destination into a memory point category See Moving Memory Points earlier in this section for more information Home Memory This memory point is stored by selecting Home from the EDIT MEMORY POINT screen See Registering Memory Points earlier in this section and Home under Enter Destination on page 259 for more information 254 Edit Waypoint Waypoints are destinations you can set along the way to your final destination This feature allows you to add edit and delete waypoints 3 13AM 85 F Add Waypoint Edit Waypoint Delete Wa You may set up to five waypoints on the way to your final destination
337. o overloading can shorten the life of your vehicle Tire and Loading Information Label SEE OWNER S MANUAL FOR ADDITIONAL INFORMATION Label Example A vehicle specific Tire and Loading Information label is attached to the center pillar B pillar of your vehicle With the driver s door open you will find the label attached below the door latch This label shows the number of occupant seating positions A and the maximum vehicle capacity weight B in kilograms and pounds The Tire and Loading Information label also shows the size of the original equipment tires C and the recommended cold tire inflation pressures D For more information on tires and inflation see Tires on page 413 and Inflation Tire Pressure on page 422 There is also important loading information on the vehicle Certification label It tells you the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating GVWR and the Gross Axle Weight Rating GAWR for the front and rear axle See Certification Label later in this section Steps for Determining Correct Load Limit 1 Locate the statement The combined weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX kg or XXX Ibs on your vehicle s placard 2 Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will be riding in your vehicle 3 Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX kg or XXX Ibs 355 4 The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo
338. o a related network station for an alert announcement it will return to the original station when the announcement is finished If the CD player is playing the player will stop for the announcement and resume when the announcement is finished 297 XM Satellite Radio Service XM is a satellite radio service that is based in the 48 contiguous United States and in Canada XM offers a large variety of coast to coast channels including music news sports talk weather U S subscribers and children s programming XM provides digital quality audio and text information that includes the channel name and number song title and artist name A service fee is required in order to receive the XM service For more information contact XM in the U S at www xmradio com or call 1 800 852 XMXM 9696 or in Canada at www xmradio ca or call 1 877 GET XMSR 438 9677 298 INFO Information Touch INFO while in XM mode to retrieve various pieces of information related to the current song or channel By touching INFO you may retrieve four different categories of information Artist Name Feature Song Program Title Channel Category and other Additional Information that may be broadcast on that channel Additional Information messages may only be available at certain times or on certain programs If an Additional Information message is being broadcast on the tuned channel INFO will appear on the display
339. o is removed from your vehicle the original VIN in the radio can be used to trace the radio back to your vehicle With THEFTLOCK activated the radio will not operate if stolen Audio Steering Wheel Controls SEEK re Left Side Controls For Left Side Controls For XLR XLR V Some audio controls can be adjusted at the steering wheel They include the following Right Side Controls For Both XLR and XLR V Voice Recognition Your vehicle has the Navigation System Press this button to initiate voice recognition See Voice Recognition in the Navigation System manual for more information SRCE Source Press this button to switch between FM1 FM2 AM or XM1 or XM2 if equipped CD or DVD SEEK Press the seek plus button to go to the next radio station and stay there The system will only seek radio stations with strong frequencies When the seek plus button is pressed and held for two seconds the system will scan the radio stations that are in the selected band If listening to a CD the system will advance to the next track of that particular CD X Mute Press this button to silence the system Press this button again or any other radio button to turn the sound on 227 a Volume Press this button to increase or to decrease the volume 1 6 Preset Stations Press this button to play stations that are programmed on the radio preset pushbuttons The radio will only seek
340. ock Your vehicle is programmed so that when the shift lever is moved into PARK P both doors will unlock With the vehicle in PARK P and the engine running door unlocking can be programmed through prompts displayed on the Driver Information Center DIC These prompts allow the driver to choose various unlock settings For programming information see DIC Vehicle Personalization on page 220 Lockout Protection Your vehicle can be programmed to sound the horn three times and unlock the driver s door when both doors are closed and there is a keyless access transmitter inside the vehicle When the driver s door is opened a reminder chime will sound continuously The vehicle will remain locked only when at least one transmitter has been removed from the vehicle and both doors are closed See DIC Vehicle Personalization on page 220 Trunk A CAUTION It can be dangerous to drive with the trunk lid open because carbon monoxide CO gas can come into your vehicle You cannot see or smell CO It can cause unconsciousness and even death If you must drive with the trunk lid open or if electrical wiring or other cable connections must pass through the seal between the body and the trunk lid e Make sure all other windows are shut e Turn the fan on your heating or cooling system to its highest speed and select the control setting that will force outside air into your vehicle See Climate Control System e If you have air o
341. of the illustration it would mean that the tire s sidewall is 60 percent as high as it is wide D Construction Code A letter code is used to indicate the type of ply construction in the tire The letter R means radial ply construction the letter D means diagonal or bias ply construction and the letter B means belted bias ply construction E Rim Diameter Diameter of the wheel in inches F Service Description These characters represent the load range and speed rating of the tire The load index represents the load carry capacity a tire is certified to carry The load index can range from 1 to 279 The speed rating is the maximum speed a tire is certified to carry a load Speed ratings range from A to Z Tire Terminology and Definitions Air Pressure The amount of air inside the tire pressing outward on each square inch of the tire Air pressure is expressed in pounds per square inch psi or kilopascal kPa Accessory Weight This means the combined weight of optional accessories Some examples of optional accessories are automatic transmission transaxle power steering power brakes power windows power seats and air conditioning Aspect Ratio The relationship of a tire s height to its width Belt A rubber coated layer of cords that is located between the plies and the tread Cords may be made from steel or other reinforcing materials Bead The tire bead contains steel wires wrapped by steel cords
342. of your vehicle that you can get along without like the radio or cigarette lighter and use its fuse if it is the correct amperage Replace it as soon as you can Instrument Panel Fuse Block The panel fuse block is located on the passenger s side of the vehicle under the instrument panel and under the toe board Remove the carpet and toe board covering to access the fuse block by pulling at the top of each corner of the panel Then turn the fuse block door knob counterclockwise and pull the door to access the fuses L ie JCD eS ae wala alae CCC Ce C2 C80 CB Spare Fuse Spare Fuse Spare Fuse 453 Fuses Usage 6 ReverseLamp 8 Parking Brake Solenoid A 9 ReverseLamps _ Seats Windshield Wiper Relays Airbags Adaptive Cruise Control ACC Driver Door Switch Power Tilt Wheel Telescopic Steering Column Memory Seat Driver Seat Switch Retractable Hardtop Switch Ignition Switch Intrusion Sensor 454 Stop Lamp Inside Rearview Mirror Climate Control System Column Lock Power Sounder Instrument Panel Cluster Head Up Display HUD Radio S Band CD Changer Tap Up Tap Down Switch 29 Climate Control System Power Sounder 30 Rear Fog Lamps Diagnostic Link Connector Power Folding Mirror Solenoid B 39 Steering Wheel Control Button Lights Passenger s Side Heated Seat Driver s Side Heated Seat 43 NotUsed o Retractable Hardtop
343. ome things you need to know to help your vehicle pass an inspection Your vehicle will not pass this inspection if the check engine light is on or not working properly To perform a check engine light bulb check with the keyless ignition make sure the transmitter fob is in the passenger compartment See Ignition Positions on page 88 Press the bottom of the Acc button on the instrument panel and hold the button down for five seconds The instrument panel including the check engine light will light up and the ignition will be on but the engine will not start if you press the bottom of the Acc button only briefly less than five seconds the accessory power mode will be turned on but not the ignition After the bulb check be sure to press and release the Acc button again to turn the ignition off and avoid draining the vehicle s battery 199 Your vehicle will not pass this inspection if the OBD on board diagnostic system determines that critical emission control systems have not been completely diagnosed by the system The vehicle would be considered not ready for inspection This can happen if you have recently replaced the battery or if the battery has run down The diagnostic system is designed to evaluate critical emission control systems during normal driving This may take several days of routine driving If you have done this and your vehicle still does not pass the inspection for lack of OBD system readiness your
344. omment See Enter Destination on page 259 for more information If you are traveling in or to Canada and you cross the regional border the only map scale views available are 4 mi 8 mi 31 mi and 128 mi 8 km 16 km 64 km and 256 km Change the selected search area region when you get closer to the area you are traveling to See Setting the Search Area under Maps on page 271 for more information Keyless Access System When the engine is started Driver 1 or Driver 2 will display on the screen A message will not appear on the screen if the driver is unknown The number on the back of the transmitter corresponds to driver 1 or driver 2 The navigation system can store memory points for drivers 1 and 2 individually See Keyless Access System on page 67 for more information OnStar System When using the OnStar system the audio system will be muted and the navigation voice prompts will be disabled during the call The volume of the OnStar call can be adjusted by using the steering wheel volume controls See OnStar System on page 107 for more information Global Positioning System GPS The Navigation System determines the position of your vehicle by using satellite signals various vehicle signals and map data At times other interferences such as the satellite condition road configuration the condition of the vehicle and or other circumstances can interfere with the Navigation s ability to determine
345. omplete message has been displayed MSG will disappear from the display until another new message is received MSG will remain available to allow you to display the entire message again 296 PTY PTY allows you to seek only stations with types of programs you want to listen to This button is used to turn on and off Program Type PTY features With RDS on touch RDS followed by PTY The PTY display will turn on Touch RDS followed by this button again to turn the PTY display off Select PTY Select Program Type With RDS and PTY on touch RDS then SEL PTY The PTY menu will appear Use the up and down arrows to select a PTY Touch your PTY selection and the system will return you to the screen with the preset stations shown See Steps 1 through 7 under Preset Station Menu to store the selected PTYs The selected PTY is then stored on the preset You can now touch the PTY preset to recall your settings When the PTY display is on press TUNE SEEK and SCAN to find radio stations of the PTY selected The last PTY selected will be used for seek and scan modes If a station with the selected PTY is not found NONE FOUND will appear on the display If both PTY and TA are on the audio system will search for stations with traffic announcements and the selected PTY PTY Program Type Presets The six presets let you return to your favorite PTYs These presets have factory PTY preset stations See RDS Program Type PTY Sel
346. on With RDS the radio can do the following e Seek to stations broadcasting the selected type of programming e Receive announcements concerning local and national emergencies e Display messages from radio stations e Seek to stations with traffic announcements RDS Touch RDS to use alternate RDS functions located in the preset menu When you touch RDS you will only have about five seconds to choose RDS ON OFF TA MSG PTY or SEL PTY If you do not make a selection the system will return to the previous menu If you are tuned to a station broadcasting RDS information the station s Program Service PS and Program Type PTY will replace the station s frequency on the status line at the top of the display After about five seconds if available the PTY will be replaced on the display by the station s PTY name The PTY and PTY name may be the same or different If the audio system is tuned to a station that is not broadcasting RDS information the station s frequency will remain on the display While RDS is on the audio system will search for a stronger station in the network if a station gets too weak for listening The RDS feature relies upon receiving specific information from RDS stations These features will only work when RDS information is available TA Traffic Touch TA to receive traffic announcements The audio system will turn on the TA display TA will appear on the display if the current station broadc
347. on to begin playing a CD RANDOM DISC Touch this button to hear the tracks in random rather than sequential order on the disc selected Press the TUNE SEEK hard key to randomly seek through the tracks on this disc Touch RANDOM DISC again to turn off random play mode SCAN TRACKS Touch this button to hear the first 10 seconds of each track on the selected disc Touch this button again to stop scanning The CD will mute while scanning 4 Rewind Touch this button to rewind quickly through a track selection EJECT Touch this button once to eject the chosen CD The chosen CD may be selected by first touching one of the numbered buttons from 1 to 6 Repeat this procedure for ejecting up to six discs from the changer If you press and hold the EJECT button until a beep is heard The system will begin to eject all of the discs from the player Once the CD is removed the next will come out until they are all ejected 303 Il Pause Touch this button to pause CD play Touch it again to resume play or touch the play button RANDOM ALL Touch this button to hear the tracks on all of the discs in the CD changer in random rather than sequential order Press the TUNE SEEK hard key while RANDOM ALL is on to randomly seek within that disc Touch RANDOM ALL again to turn off random mode SCAN DISCS Touch this button to hear the first 10 seconds of first track on each disc Touch this button again to stop scanning The CD wil
348. ong time to operate automatic rerouting during high speed driving Automatic rerouting may display a route returning to the set waypoint if you are heading for a destination without passing through a set waypoint e The route prohibits the entry of a vehicle due to a regulation by time or season or any other regulation which may be given e Some routes may not be searched e The route to the destination may not be shown if there are new roads if roads have recently changed or if certain roads are not listed on the map DVD See Ordering Map DVDs on page 284 To recalibrate the vehicle s position on the map see your dealer If the System Needs Service If your system needs service and you have followed the steps listed here and still are experiencing problems see your dealer for assistance 283 Ordering Map DVDs You will receive two free DVD map disc updates with the purchase of your new vehicle Updates are necessary to make sure that your vehicle s navigation system has the most accurate information available about streets roads points of interest and business locations The updates are provided by the GM Nav Disc Center at the first and second anniversary dates of your vehicle s delivery date About four to six weeks before those anniversary dates you will receive a post card from the GM Nav Disc Center reminding you that a free update is available The center will request confirmation of your mailing addr
349. ort Canada Road Safety Branch 2780 Sheffield Road Ottawa Ontario K1B 3V9 Reporting Safety Defects to General Motors In addition to notifying NHTSA or Transport Canada in a situation like this we certainly hope you will notify us Please call us at 1 800 458 8006 or write Cadillac Customer Assistance Center Cadillac Motor Car Division P O Box 33169 Detroit MI 48232 5169 In Canada please call us at 1 888 446 2000 Or write Canadian Cadillac Customer Communication Centre CA1 163 005 General Motors of Canada Limited 1908 Colonel Sam Drive Oshawa Ontario L1H 8P7 Service Publications Ordering Information Service Manuals Service Manuals have the diagnosis and repair information on engines transmission axle suspension brakes electrical steering body etc Transmission Transaxle Transfer Case Unit Repair Manual This manual provides information on unit repair service procedures adjustments and specifications for GM transmissions transaxles and transfer cases Service Bulletins Service Bulletins give technical service information needed to knowledgeably service General Motors cars and trucks Each bulletin contains instructions to assist in the diagnosis and service of your vehicle In Canada information pertaining to Product Service Bulletins can be obtained by contacting your General Motors dealer or by calling 1 800 GM DRIVE 1 800 463 7483 497 Owner s Information Owner p
350. ough the DIC you will also find e AVERAGE XX X MPG Average Miles Per Gallon The fuel economy calculated for the last 20 gallons 76 L of fuel used or since you last reset the display e INST XX X MPG Instantaneous Miles Per Gallon The fuel economy calculated for your current driving conditions e RANGE XXX MI The approximate distance you can drive before refueling See DIC Controls and Displays on page 204 for more information You should reset the fuel information display every time you refuel To reset AVERAGE use the information up or down button to scroll to AVE FUEL ECON and hold the reset button RANGE will automatically reset Driver Information Center DIC This display gives you the status of many of your vehicle s systems The DIC is also used to display driver personalization features and warning status messages All messages will appear in the DIC display located at the bottom of the instrument panel cluster 203 DIC Controls and Displays The Driver Information Center DIC buttons are located to the right of the steering wheel on the instrument panel near the air outlets OPTIONS RESET A 1 v Information Press the top or bottom of this button to scroll through the available features which include the odometer trip odometers fuel range miles per gallon average speed timer tire pressure and remaining oil life XS Interior Lamps Press this button to turn the interior
351. oving vehicle It will then adjust your speed to follow the vehicle in front at the selected follow distance Your speed will increase or decrease to follow the vehicle in front of you but will not exceed the set speed The system may apply limited braking if necessary When braking is active your brake lights will come on It may feel or sound different than if you were applying the brakes yourself This is normal Stationary or Very Slow Moving Objects A CAUTION Adaptive Cruise Control may not detect and react to stationary or slow moving vehicles or other objects ahead of you You could crash into an object ahead of you Do not use Adaptive Cruise Control when approaching stationary or slow moving vehicles or other objects A CAUTION Adaptive Cruise Control may not detect and react to stationary or slow moving vehicles or other objects ahead of you Your vehicle may accelerate toward objects such as a stopped vehicle that suddenly appears after the lead vehicle changes lanes Your complete attention is always required while driving and you should be ready to take action and apply the brakes Low Speed Deactivation If your speed falls below 20 mph 32 km h while following a vehicle ahead Adaptive Cruise Control will begin to disengage The driver alert symbol on the HUD will flash and the warning beep will sound The driver must take action since Adaptive Cruise Control will not slow the vehicle to a stop
352. peed than if the vehicle goes straight into the object Frontal airbags driver and right front passenger are not intended to inflate during vehicle rollovers rear impacts or in many side impacts 50 The side impact airbags are intended to inflate in moderate to severe side crashes A side impact airbag will inflate if the crash severity is above the system s designed threshold level The threshold level can vary with specific vehicle design Side impact airbags are not intended to inflate in frontal or near frontal impacts rollovers or rear impacts A side impact airbag is intended to deploy on the side of the vehicle that is struck Your vehicle also has seat position sensors which enables the sensing system to monitor the position of the driver s and passengers seats The seat position sensor provides information which is used to determine if the airbags should deploy at a reduced level or at full deployment In any particular crash no one can say whether an airbag should have inflated simply because of the damage to a vehicle or because of what the repair costs were For frontal airbags inflation is determined by what the vehicle hits the angle of the impact and how quickly the vehicle slows down For side impact airbags inflation is determined by the location and severity of the impact What Makes an Airbag Inflate In an impact of sufficient severity the airbag sensing system detects that the vehicle i
353. phone poles or other vehicles and raindrops dimple the waters surface there could be hydroplaning Hydroplaning usually happens at higher speeds There just is not a hard and fast rule about hydroplaning The best advice is to slow down when it is raining 341 Driving Through Deep Standing Water Notice If you drive too quickly through deep puddles or standing water water can come in through your engine s air intake and badly damage your engine Never drive through water that is slightly lower than the underbody of your vehicle If you cannot avoid deep puddles or standing water drive through them very slowly Driving Through Flowing Water A CAUTION Flowing or rushing water creates strong forces If you try to drive through flowing water as you might at a low water crossing your vehicle can be carried away As little as six inches of flowing water can carry away a smaller vehicle CAUTION Continued 342 CAUTION Continued If this happens you and other vehicle occupants could drown Do not ignore police warning signs and otherwise be very cautious about trying to drive through flowing water Some Other Rainy Weather Tips e Besides slowing down allow some extra following distance And be especially careful when you pass another vehicle Allow yourself more clear room ahead and be prepared to have your view restricted by road spray e Have good tires with proper tread depth See Tir
354. play Presets on the Map With this feature on your audio system presets for the current audio source will be displayed on the left of the map screen Touch ON to turn this feature on You may also choose to turn this feature off With this feature on you can recall your preset radio stations from the map screen You cannot store preset stations from the map screen You must do this from the audio screen See Preset Station Menu later in this section for more information on storing presets Automatic Volume Control AVC The system has Bose AudioPilot noise compensation technology AudioPilot monitors the level of noise in the vehicle and automatically increases or decreases the level of audio to keep it audible above the noise To use AudioPilot press the ON screen button To turn it off press the OFF screen button This feature is most effective at lower volume settings where background noise can affect how well you hear the music being played through your vehicle s audio system At higher volume settings where the music is much louder than the background noise there may be little or no adjustments by AudioPilot For additional information on AudioPilot please visit www bose com 3 Clock Touch this screen button to get to the CLOCK ADJUST menu See Clock Adjust Menu later in this section for more information SCREEN ADJUST To adjust the brightness or contrast of the screen touch SCREEN ADJUST
355. portant to slow down on slippery surfaces because stopping distance will be longer and vehicle control more limited While driving on a surface with reduced traction try your best to avoid sudden steering acceleration or braking including reducing vehicle speed by shifting to a lower gear Any sudden changes could cause the tires to slide You may not realize the surface is slippery until your vehicle is skidding Learn to recognize warning clues such as enough water ice or packed snow on the road to make a mirrored surface and slow down when you have any doubt Remember Any Anti Lock Brake System ABS helps avoid only the braking skid 338 Racing or Other Competitive Driving XLR V See your warranty book before using your vehicle for racing or other competitive driving Notice If you use your vehicle for racing or other competitive driving the engine may use more oil than it would with normal use Low oil levels can damage the engine Be sure to check the oil level often during racing or other competitive driving and keep the level at or near 2 quarts 2 L above the upper mark that shows the proper operating range on the engine oil dipstick For information on how to add oil see Engine Oil on page 377 After the competitive driving remove excess oil so that the level on the dipstick is not above the upper mark that shows the proper operating range Driving at Night Night driving is more dangerous t
356. preset stations with a strong signal that are in the selected band When a CD is playing press this button to go to the next track Radio Reception You may experience frequency interference and static during normal radio reception if items such as cellphone chargers vehicle convenience accessories and external electronic devices are plugged into the accessory power outlet If there is interference or static unplug the item from the accessory power outlet 228 AM The range for most AM stations is greater than for FM especially at night The longer range can cause station frequencies to interfere with each other For better radio reception most AM radio stations will boost the power levels during the day and then reduce these levels during the night Static can also occur when things like storms and power lines interfere with radio reception When this happens try reducing the treble on your radio FM Stereo FM stereo will give the best sound but FM signals will reach only about 10 to 40 miles 16 to 65 km Tall buildings or hills can interfere with FM signals causing the sound to fade in and out XM Satellite Radio Service XM Satellite Radio Service gives digital radio reception from coast to coast in the 48 contiguous United States and in Canada Just as with FM tall buildings or hills can interfere with satellite radio signals causing the sound to fade in and out In addition traveling or st
357. provide cleaner air all gasolines in the United States are now required to contain additives that will help prevent engine and fuel system deposits from forming allowing your emission control system to work properly In most cases you should not have to add anything to your fuel However some gasolines contain only the minimum amount of additive required to meet U S Environmental Protection Agency regulations To help keep fuel injectors and intake valves clean or if your vehicle experiences problems due to dirty injectors or valves look for gasoline that is advertised as TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Also your dealer has additives that will help correct and prevent most deposit related problems 367 Gasolines containing oxygenates such as ethers and ethanol and reformulated gasolines may be available in your area General Motors recommends that you use these gasolines if they comply with the specifications described earlier However E85 85 ethanol and other fuels containing more than 10 ethanol must not be used in vehicles that were not designed for those fuels Notice Your vehicle was not designed for fuel that contains methanol Do not use fuel containing methanol It can corrode metal parts in your fuel system and also damage the plastic and rubber parts That damage would not be covered under your warranty 368 Some gasolines that are not reformulated for low emissions may contain an octane enhancing additiv
358. ps The ignition must be on for the fog lamps to operate The fog lamps will turn off when the ignition is turned off Some localities have laws that require the headlamps to be on along with the fog lamps 168 Twilight Sentinel Twilight Sentinel can turn your lamps on and off for you A light sensor on top of the instrument panel makes the Twilight Sentinel work so be sure it is not covered With Twilight Sentinel you will see the following happen e When it is dark enough outside the front turn signal lamps DRL will go off and the headlamps and parking lamps will come on The other lamps that come on with headlamps will also come on e When it is bright enough outside the headlamps will go off and the front turn signal lamps DRL will come on as long as the exterior lamp switch is in the AUTO position If you start your vehicle in a dark garage the automatic headlamp system will come on immediately Once you leave the garage it will take about one minute for the automatic headlamp system to change to DRL if it is light outside During that delay your instrument panel cluster may not be as bright as usual Make sure your instrument panel brightness control is in full bright position See nstrument Panel Brightness on page 170 for more information You can idle the vehicle with the lamps off even when it is dark outside After starting the vehicle turn the exterior lamp control band to off t
359. ptable levels for the life of the vehicle helping to produce a cleaner environment The check engine light comes on to indicate that there is a problem and service is required Malfunctions often will be indicated by the system before any problem is apparent This may prevent more serious damage to your vehicle This system is also designed to assist your service technician in correctly diagnosing any malfunction Notice f you keep driving your vehicle with this light on after awhile your emission controls may not work as well your fuel economy may not be as good and your engine may not run as smoothly This could lead to costly repairs that may not be covered by your warranty Notice Modifications made to the engine transmission exhaust intake or fuel system of your vehicle or the replacement of the original tires with other than those of the same Tire Performance Criteria TPC can affect your vehicle s emission controls and may cause this light to come on Modifications to these systems could lead to costly repairs not covered by your warranty This may also result in a failure to pass a required Emission Inspection Maintenance test See Accessories and Modifications on page 363 This light should come on briefly as a check to show you it is working as you start the engine If the light does not come on have it repaired This light will also come on during a malfunction in one of two ways e Light Flashing
360. r The body takes about an hour to rid itself of the alcohol in one drink No amount of coffee or number of cold showers will speed that up I will be careful is not the right answer What if there is an emergency a need to take sudden action as when a child darts into the street A person with even a moderate BAC might not be able to react quickly enough to avoid the collision There is something else about drinking and driving that many people do not know Medical research shows that alcohol in a person s system can make crash injuries worse especially injuries to the brain spinal cord or heart This means that when anyone who has been drinking driver or passenger is in a crash that person s chance of being killed or permanently disabled is higher than if the person had not been drinking A CAUTION Drinking and then driving is very dangerous Your reflexes perceptions attentiveness and judgment can be affected by even a small amount of alcohol You can have a serious or even fatal collision if you drive after drinking Please do not drink and drive or ride with a driver who has been drinking Ride home in a cab or if you are with a group designate a driver who will not drink 325 Control of a Vehicle You have three systems that make your vehicle go where you want it to go They are the brakes the steering and the accelerator All three systems have to do their work at the places w
361. r engine oil filter could lead to filter failure and result in severe engine damage Damage caused by use of the wrong engine oil filter would not be covered by your new vehicle warranty When the system has calculated that oil life has been diminished it will indicate that an oil change is necessary A CHANGE OIL NOW message in the DIC will come on See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 206 Change your oil as soon as possible within the next 600 miles 1 000 km It is possible that if you are driving under the best conditions the oil life system may not indicate that an oil change is necessary for over a year However your engine oil and filter must be changed at least once a year and at this time the system must be reset Your dealer has GM trained service people who will perform this work using genuine GM parts and reset the system It is also important to check your oil regularly and keep it at the proper level If the system is ever reset accidentally you must change your oil at 3 000 miles 5 000 km since your last oil change Remember to reset the oil life system whenever the oil is changed How to Reset the Engine Oil Life System and the Oil Life Indicator The Engine Oil Life System calculates when to change your engine oil and filter based on vehicle use Anytime your oil is changed reset the system so it can calculate when the next oil change is required If a situation occurs where you change your oil prior to
362. r specific information about your vehicle s capacity weight and seating positions The combined weight of the driver passengers and cargo should never exceed your vehicle s capacity weight 357 Certification Label MFD BY GENERAL MOTORS CORP GAWR FRT THIS VEHICLE CONFORMS TO ALL gip L Na OTOR VEHICLE SAFETY BUMPER NTION STANDARDS IN EFFECT ON THE D FM WN ABOVE 2000 ASS CAR GM m DATE GVWR a A vehicle specific Certification label is attached to the rear edge of the driver s door It tells you the gross weight capacity of your vehicle called the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating GVWR The GVWR includes the weight of the vehicle all occupants fuel and cargo Never exceed the GVWR for your vehicle or the Gross Axle Weight Rating GAWR for either the front or rear axle And if you do have a heavy load you should spread it out 358 A CAUTION Do not load your vehicle any heavier than the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating GVWR or either the maximum front or rear Gross Axle Weight Rating GAWR If you do parts on your vehicle can break and it can change the way your vehicle handles These could cause you to lose control and crash Also overloading can shorten the life of your vehicle Notice Overloading your vehicle may cause damage Repairs would not be covered by your warranty Do not overload your vehicle If you put things inside your ve
363. rakes Brake Fluid Your brake master DOT 3 cylinder reservoir is filled with DOT 3 brake fluid See Engine Compartment Overview on page 374 for the location of the reservoir AR There are only two reasons why the brake fluid level in the reservoir might go down The first is that the brake fluid goes down to an acceptable level during normal brake lining wear When new linings are put in the fluid level goes back up The other reason is that fluid is leaking out of the brake system If it is you should have your brake system fixed since a leak means that sooner or later your brakes will not work well or will not work at all So it is not a good idea to top off your brake fluid Adding brake fluid will not correct a leak If you add fluid when your linings are worn then you will have too much fluid when you get new brake linings You should add or remove brake fluid as necessary only when work is done on the brake hydraulic system A CAUTION If you have too much brake fluid it can spill on the engine The fluid will burn if the engine is hot enough You or others could be burned and your vehicle could be damaged Add brake fluid only when work is done on the brake hydraulic system See Checking Brake Fluid in this section Refer to the Maintenance Schedule to determine when to check your brake fluid See Scheduled Maintenance on page 465 399 Checking Brake Fluid You can check the brake flui
364. read WAIT 10 MINUTES and will count down to zero one minute at a time The DIC will display OFF ACC TO LEARN again Press the Acc button The DIC will read WAIT 10 MINUTES and will count down to zero one minute at a time The DIC will display OFF ACC TO LEARN again 13 Press the Acc button 14 The DIC will read WAIT 10 MINUTES and will count down to zero one minute at a time 15 A beep will sound and the DIC will read READY FOR FOB 1 At this time all previously known transmitters have been erased 16 Once the transmitter is recognized and programmed a beep will sound and the DIC will display READY FOR FOB 2 If you have additional transmitters to program take transmitter 1 out of the transmitter pocket and place transmitter 2 in the pocket This can be done repeatedly until up to four transmitters have been programmed The DIC will then display MAX FOBS LEARNED and will exit the programming mode When you are done programming transmitters press the Acc button 71 Battery Replacement Under normal use the battery in your keyless access transmitter should last about three years You can tell the battery is weak if the transmitter will not work at the normal range in any location If you have to get close to your vehicle before the transmitter works it is probably time to change the battery A weak battery may also cause the DIC to display NO FOB DETECTED when you try to start the vehic
365. rface 7 Locate the vertical headlamp aiming screws which are under the hood near each headlamp assembly The adjustment screw can be turned with a 6 mm male hex 8 Turn the vertical aiming screw until the headlamp beam is aimed to the horizontal tape line 9 The top edge of the cut off should be positioned at the bottom edge of the horizontal tape line Make sure that the light from the headlamp is positioned at the bottom edge of the horizontal tape line The lamp on the left A shows the correct headlamp aim The lamp on the right B shows the incorrect headlamp aim Repeat Steps 7 through 9 for the opposite headlamp 411 Bulb Replacement It is recommended that all bulbs be replaced by your dealer Windshield Replacement Keep in mind that your windshield is part of the Head Up Display HUD system If you ever have to get your windshield replaced be sure to get one that is designed for HUD or your HUD image may look blurred or out of focus Windshield Wiper Blade Replacement Windshield wiper blades should be inspected for wear or cracking See Scheduled Maintenance on page 465 It is a good idea to clean or replace the wiper blade assembly on a regular basis or when worn For proper windshield wiper blade length and type see Normal Maintenance Replacement Parts on page 475 412 To replace the wiper blade assembly do the following 1 Place the vehicle in accessory mode and tur
366. rference 2 This device must accept any interference received including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device The Canadian Registration ID number is 3521A GTVO6A Changes or modifications to this system by other than an authorized service facility could void authorization to use this equipment 112 Universal Home Remote System Operation With Three Round LED Your vehicle may have the Universal Home Remote System If there are three round Light Emitting Diode LED above the Universal Home Remote System buttons follow the instructions below If there is one triangular LED above the Universal Home Remote System buttons follow the instructions under Universal Home Remote System Operation with one triangular LED This system provides a way to replace up to three remote control transmitters used to activate devices such as garage door openers security systems and home lighting Do not use the this system with any garage door opener that does not have the stop and reverse feature This includes any garage door opener model manufactured before April 1 1982 Read the instructions completely before attempting to program the transmitter Because of the steps involved it may be helpful to have another person available to assist you in programming the transmitter Be sure to keep the original remote control transmitter for use in other vehicles as well as for future programming You only need
367. rk plugs An Emission Control Service Engine cooling system service or every five years whichever occurs first An Emission Control Service See footnote g 4 4L Supercharged Engine Intercooler system service or every five years whichever occurs first See footnote k Inspect engine accessory drive belt An Emission Control Service See footnote j 468 Maintenance Footnotes a A fluid loss in any vehicle system could indicate a problem Have the system inspected and repaired and the fluid level checked Add fluid if needed b Visually inspect wiper blades for wear or cracking Replace wiper blades that appear worn or damaged or that streak or miss areas of the windshield c Make sure the safety belt reminder light and all your belts buckles latch plates retractors and anchorages are working properly Look for any other loose or damaged safety belt system parts If you see anything that might keep a safety belt system from doing its job have it repaired Have any torn or frayed safety belts replaced Also look for any opened or broken airbag coverings and have them repaired or replaced The airbag system does not need regular maintenance d Lubricate the trunk key lock cylinder Lubricate all body door hinges Lubricate all hinges and latches including those for the hood trunk console door and any folding seat hardware More frequent lubrication may be required when exposed to a cor
368. rnate between the CD player and the six disc CD changer if CDs are loaded gt Play Touch this button to begin playing a CD RANDOM Touch this button to hear the tracks in random rather than sequential order on the disc Touch RANDOM again to turn off random mode SCAN TRACKS Touch this button to hear the first 10 seconds of each track on the disc Touch this button again to stop scanning The CD will mute while scanning REPEAT TRACK Touch this button to repeat the selected track 4 Rewind Touch this button to rewind quickly through a track selection Il Pause Touch this button to pause CD play Touch it again to resume play or touch the play button Forward Touch this button to fast forward quickly through a track selection A TUNE SEEK v Touch the up arrow on the TUNE SEEK hard key to seek to the next selection on the compact disc If playing the last track of the disc touching the up arrow will seek to the first track of the disc Touch the down arrow to seek to the previous selection on the compact disc If playing the first track of the disc touching the down arrow will seek to the last track of the disc The sound will mute while seeking DVD Player To use the player as a video DVD player you must first remove the navigation map DVD or music CD While playing a video DVD the navigation system is not available The message The disc installed is not a map DVD will appear on the
369. rning light Under important warning conditions the CHECK GAGES message will display in the HUD View your Driver Information Center DIC for more information 172 The HUD controls are located to the left of the steering wheel X Brightness This button is used to adjust the brightness of the HUD and the instrument panel cluster DIMMER This button is used to select the HUD or the instrument panel cluster to adjust the brightness HUD This button is used to adjust the vertical position of the HUD display To adjust the HUD so you can see it properly do the following 1 Adjust the seat to a comfortable driving position If you change your seat position later you may have to re adjust your HUD 2 Start your engine and press the top or bottom of the HUD button to center the HUD image in your view The HUD image can only be adjusted up and down not side to side 3 Press the DIMMER button until the DIC reads HUD DIMMING Then use the brightness button to adjust the desired intensity The brightness of the HUD image is determined by the light conditions in the direction your vehicle is facing and where you have the HUD set If you are facing a dark object or a heavily shaded area your HUD may anticipate that you are entering a dark area and may begin to dim To turn off the HUD press the brightness button down until the image disappears Polarized sunglasses could make the HUD image harder to see
370. rnings and Messages on page 206 for more information After being in Acc for about 20 minutes the vehicle will automatically enter RAP or will turn off depending on if the doors are opened or closed Retained Accessory Power RAP The following accessories on your vehicle may be used for up to 10 minutes after the engine is turned off e Radio e Power Windows e Audio Steering Wheel Controls Power to these accessories stops after 10 minutes or if a door is opened If you want power for another 10 minutes close all the doors and press the Acc button to place the vehicle in accessory mode Press the button again and the vehicle will return to RAP Starting the Engine Move the shift lever to PARK P or NEUTRAL N To restart when you are already moving use NEUTRAL N Notice Do not try to shift to PARK P if your vehicle is moving If you do you could damage the transmission Shift to PARK P only when your vehicle is stopped The keyless access transmitter must be inside the vehicle for the ignition to work Cell phone chargers can interfere with the operation of the Keyless Access System Battery chargers should not be plugged in when starting or turning off the engine 89 To start you vehicle do the following 1 90 With your foot on the brake pedal press the START button located on the instrument panel If there is not a keyless access transmitter in the vehicle or if there is something cau
371. rosive environment Applying silicone grease on weatherstrips with a clean cloth will make them last longer seal better and not stick or squeak e If you drive regularly under dusty conditions the filter may require replacement more often f Change automatic transmission fluid and filter if the vehicle is mainly driven under one or more of these conditions In heavy city traffic where the outside temperature regularly reaches 90 F 32 C or higher In hilly or mountainous terrain Uses such as high performance operation g Drain flush and refill cooling system This service can be complex you should have your dealer perform this service See Engine Coolant on page 385 for what to use Inspect hoses Clean radiator condenser pressure cap and filler neck Pressure test the cooling system and pressure cap 469 h If you drive regularly under dusty conditions inspect the filter at each engine oil change j Visually inspect belt for fraying excessive cracks or obvious damage Replace belt if necessary k Drain flush and refill intercooler system This service can be complex you should have your dealer perform this service See Engine Coolant on page 385 for what to use Inspect hoses Clean pressure cap and filler neck Pressure test the system and pressure cap I For supercharged engines only Have your dealer check the supercharger oil level and add the proper supercharger oil as
372. rque Lock If you are parking on a hill and you do not shift your transmission into PARK P properly the weight of the vehicle may put too much force on the parking pawl in the transmission You may find it difficult to pull the shift lever out of PARK P This is called torque lock To prevent torque lock set the parking brake and then shift into PARK P properly before you leave the driver s seat To find out how see Shifting Into PARK P listed previously in this section When you are ready to drive move the shift lever out of PARK P before you release the parking brake If torque lock does occur you may need to have another vehicle push yours a little uphill to take some of the pressure from the parking pawl in the transmission so you can pull the shift lever out of PARK P 100 Shifting Out of Park P Your vehicle has an automatic transmission shift lock control system You have to fully apply your regular brake before you can shift from PARK P when the vehicle is running See Automatic Transmission Operation on page 92 If you cannot shift out of PARK P ease pressure on the shift lever push the shift lever all the way into PARK P and release the shift lever button as you maintain brake application Then press the shift lever button and move the shift lever into the gear desired If you ever hold the brake pedal down but still cannot shift out of PARK P try this 1 Press th
373. rs or rotate your vehicle s tires the identification codes will need to be matched to the new tire wheel position The sensors are matched to the tire wheel positions in the following order driver s side front tire passenger s side front tire passenger s side rear tire and drivers side rear tire using a TPMS diagnostic tool See your dealer for service Federal Communications Commission FCC and Industry and Science Canada The Tire Pressure Monitor System TPMS operates on a radio frequency and complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules Operation is subject to the following two conditions 1 This device may not cause harmful interference 2 This device must accept any interference received including interference that may cause undesired operation 426 The Tire Pressure Monitor System TPMS operates on a radio frequency and complies with RSS 210 of Industry and Science Canada Operation is subject to the following two conditions 1 This device may not cause interference 2 This device must accept any interference received including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device Changes or modifications to this system by other than an authorized service facility could void authorization to use this equipment Tire Inspection and Rotation The tires on your vehicle should be inspected regularly for wear Also check for damaged tires or wheels See When It Is Time for New Tires on page 42
374. ruise Control do the following 1 Make sure the Head Up Display HUD is on and properly adjusted See Head Up Display HUD on page 171 for more information 2 Move the switch to on 153 3 Get up to the speed you want 4 Press in the set button at the end of the lever and release it 5 Take your foot off the accelerator pedal Once Adaptive Cruise Control is set it may immediately apply the brakes if it detects a vehicle ahead is too close or moving slower than your vehicle RS See Head Up Display HUD on page 171 for more information Make sure the set speed is visible on the HUD so you know the speed your vehicle will accelerate to if a vehicle is not detected in your path Keep in mind speed limits surrounding traffic speeds and weather conditions when adjusting your set speed This symbol will appear on the Head Up Display HUD to indicate that Adaptive Cruise Control is active 154 If your vehicle is in Adaptive Cruise Control when the traction control system begins to limit wheel spin the Adaptive Cruise Control will automatically disengage See Traction Control System TCS on page 329 and StabiliTrak System on page 331 When road conditions allow you to safely use it again you may turn the Adaptive Cruise Control back on Increasing Set Speed While Using Adaptive Cruise Control There are two ways to increase the set speed e Use the accelerator to get to the higher speed Press
375. ry and disable your vehicle 192 Brake System Warning Light Your vehicle s hydraulic brake system is divided into two parts If one part is not working the other part can still work and stop you For good braking though you need both parts working well O Canada BRAKE United States This light should come on when you start the engine If it does not come on then have it fixed so it will be ready to warn you if there is a problem If this warning light stays on after you start the engine the parking brake may still be set or there could be a brake problem Refer to Parking Brake on page 97 to see if it is set If the parking brake is not set have your brake system inspected right away If the light comes on while you are driving and you have a LOW BRAKE FLUID message showing on the DIC pull off the road and stop carefully You may notice that the pedal is harder to push Or the pedal may go closer to the floor It may take longer to stop If the light is still on have the vehicle towed for service See Towing Your Vehicle on page 359 A CAUTION Your brake system may not be working properly if the brake system warning light is on Driving with the brake system warning light on can lead to an accident If the light is still on after you have pulled off the road and stopped carefully have the vehicle towed for service Anti Lock Brake System Warning Light With the Anti Lock Brake System ABS
376. ry to move the shift lever out of PARK P with normal effort If the shift lever moves out of PARK P contact your GM Goodwrench dealer for service 472 Parking Brake and Transmission Park P Mechanism Check A CAUTION When you are doing this check your vehicle could begin to move You or others could be injured and property could be damaged Make sure there is room in front of your vehicle in case it begins to roll Be ready to apply the regular brake at once should the vehicle begin to move Park on a fairly steep hill with the vehicle facing downhill Keeping your foot on the regular brake set the parking brake e To check the parking brake s holding ability With the engine running and transmission in NEUTRAL N slowly remove foot pressure from the regular brake pedal Do this until the vehicle is held by the parking brake only e To check the PARK P mechanism s holding ability With the engine running shift to PARK P Then release the parking brake followed by the regular brake Contact your GM Goodwrench dealer if service is required Underbody Flushing Service At least every spring use plain water to flush any corrosive materials from the underbody Take care to clean thoroughly any areas where mud and other debris can collect Recommended Fluids and Lubricants Fluids and lubricants identified below by name part number or specification may be obtained from your dealer
377. s After a very minor collision nothing may be necessary But if the belts were stretched as they would be if worn during a more severe crash then you need new parts If belts are cut or damaged replace them Collision damage also may mean you will need to have safety belt or seat parts repaired or replaced New parts and repairs may be necessary even if the belt was not being used at the time of the collision If an airbag inflates you will need to replace airbag system parts See the part on the airbag system earlier in this section If the frontal airbags inflate you will also need to replace the drivers and passenger s safety belt buckle assembly Be sure to do so Then the new buckle assembly will be there to help protect you in a collision After a crash you may need to replace the driver and front passenger s safety belt buckle assemblies even if the frontal airbags have not deployed The driver and front passenger s safety belt buckle assemblies contain the safety belt pretensioners Have your safety belt pretensioners checked if your vehicle has been in a collision or if your airbag readiness light stays on after you start your vehicle or while you are driving See Airbag Readiness Light on page 188 61 4 NOTES 62 Section 2 Features and Controls KO YS ss f i caanecetiah he ce ty etcoetcdaseeeetasacanaedeayedtertente 65 Keyless Access System n 67 Keyless Access System Operation
378. s in a crash The sensing system triggers a release of gas from the inflator which inflates the airbag The inflator the airbag and related hardware are all part of the airbag modules Frontal airbag modules are located inside the steering wheel and instrument panel For seating positions with side impact airbags there are also airbag modules in the side of the seatbacks closest to the door How Does an Airbag Restrain In moderate to severe frontal or near frontal collisions even belted occupants can contact the steering wheel or the instrument panel In moderate to severe side collisions even belted occupants can contact the inside of the vehicle Airbags supplement the protection provided by safety belts Airbags distribute the force of the impact more evenly over the occupant s upper body stopping the occupant more gradually But the frontal airbags would not help you in many types of collisions including rollovers rear impacts and many side impacts primarily because an occupant s motion is not toward the airbag Side impact airbags would not help you in many types of collisions including many frontal or near frontal collisions rollovers and rear impacts Airbags should never be regarded as anything more than a supplement to safety belts and then only in moderate to severe frontal or near frontal collisions for the driver s and right front passenger s frontal airbags and only in moderate to severe side colli
379. s oo 47 Power Reclining Seatbacks cceeeeeee 11 When Should an Airbag Inflate c 49 Safety Belts ccceeceeeeeeeteeeeeeeeeeeeeees 13 What Makes an Airbag Inflate 51 Safety Belts They Are for Everyone 13 How Does an Airbag Restrain 51 Questions and Answers About What Will You See After an Airbag Safety Belts sepantas aena Aaaa 17 IIOS nyia a 52 How to Wear Safety Belts Properly 18 Passenger Sensing System ccececeeeee 53 Driver POSItION eee cee ee cece eeeeeeeeeneeeeeeeaneees 18 Servicing Your Airbag Equipped Vehicle 58 Safety Belt Use During Pregnancy 26 Adding Equipment to Your Passenger Position o c 27 Airbag Equipped Vehicle ocene 59 Safety Belt Pretensioners u 27 Restraint System Check cccceeeeeee 60 Dalety Belt EMGMIel ozs casduivnacsuncmcdedeoamnes 27 Checking the Restraint Systems 0 60 Child Restraints 0 ccceceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 28 Replacing Restraint System Parts Older Children praradimai 28 After a Crash cececeeeeeeeeeeeeeteeeeeeeeeeees 61 Infants and Young Children 31 Child Restraint Systems eeeeeeeeeees 35 Front Seats Power Seats The power seat controls are located on the outboard side of the seat cushions aw e Move the seat forward or rearward by sliding the horizontal control forward or rearward e Raise or
380. s accident See Loading Your Vehicle on page 354 CAUTION Continued 413 Low Profile Tires XLR V Notice If your vehicle has P235 45R19 or P255 40R19 size tires they are classified as low profile tires Low profile tires are more susceptible to damage from road hazards or curb impact than standard profile tires Tire and or wheel assembly damage can occur when coming into contact with road hazards like potholes or sharp edged objects or when sliding into a curb Your GM warranty does not cover this type of damage Keep tires set to the correct inflation pressure and when possible avoid contact with curbs potholes and other road hazards Winter Tires XLR V If you expect to drive on snow or ice covered roads often you may want to get winter tires for your vehicle All season tires provide good overall performance on most surfaces but they may not offer the traction you would like or the same level of performance as winter tires on snow or ice covered roads 414 Winter tires in general are designed for increased traction on snow and ice covered roads With winter tires there may be decreased dry road traction increased road noise and shorter tread life After switching to winter tires be alert for changes in vehicle handling and braking See your dealer for details regarding winter tire availability and proper tire selection Also see Buying New Tires on page 428 If you choose to use winter tires
381. s been set for the English language If you wish to change the language you must do so through the Driver Information Center DIC See Driver Information Center DIC on page 203 for more information If the language is changed from English a majority of the voice guidance prompts and screen text will change to the selected language Remember the menu screens will not match word for word as they appear in this manual Playing the Radio PWR VOL Power Volume Press this knob to turn the audio and navigation systems on and off Turn the knob to increase or decrease the volume to the audio system A TUNE SEEK v Press the up or down arrow to go to the next or previous station and stay there BAND Press this key to switch between AM FM1 FM2 XM1 XM 2 or WX if equipped If you are on a map screen and press this key the screen will not change but the audio source will 289 Finding a Station FM1 98 1 MHz 12 05PM 85 F oo mma FM1 audio source shown other sources similar Press the BAND key to switch between AM FM1 FM2 XM1 XM2 or WX if equipped Touch the desired audio source to select it 290 Preset Station Menu Up to 36 stations 6 AM 6 FM 1 6 FM 2 6 XM 1 6 XM 2 and 6 WX if equipped can be programmed for home and for away To store presets do the following 1 Turn the audio system on 2 Touch AM FM XM or WX if equipped to display the desired source Th
382. s near curves warn that you should adjust your speed Of course the posted speeds are based on good weather and road conditions Under less favorable conditions you will want to go slower 333 If you need to reduce your speed as you approach a curve do it before you enter the curve while the front wheels are straight ahead Try to adjust your speed so you can drive through the curve Maintain a reasonable steady speed Wait to accelerate until you are out of the curve and then accelerate gently into the straightaway Adding non GM accessories can affect your vehicle s performance See Accessories and Modifications on page 363 Steering in Emergencies There are times when steering can be more effective than braking For example you come over a hill and find a truck stopped in your lane or a car suddenly pulls out from nowhere or a child darts out from between parked cars and stops right in front of you You can avoid these problems by braking if you can stop in time But sometimes you cannot there is not room That is the time for evasive action steering around the problem Your vehicle can perform very well in emergencies like these First apply your brakes 334 See Braking on page 326 It is better to remove as much speed as you can from a possible collision Then steer around the problem to the left or right depending on the space available An emergency like this requires close at
383. s the DVD key to play a DVD The DVD screen will be displayed See CD DVD Player on page 305 A TUNE SEEK V Press the TUNE SEEK up or down arrows to go to the next or previous radio station and stay there See Finding a Station under Navigation Audio System on page 285 2 L Press the audio adjust key to view the main audio menu See Main Audio Menu under Navigation Audio System on page 285 PWR VOL Power Volume Knob Press the power volume knob to turn the audio and navigation systems on and off Turn the knob to increase or decrease the volume to the audio system The following hard keys are located to the right of the navigation screen RPT Press the repeat key to repeat the current voice guidance navigation prompt MAP Press the MAP key to view the map screen showing current vehicle position The map screen can also display the following information e North or Heading Up symbol See Symbols on page 275 e Map scale See Maps on page 271 e Distance to destination e GPS symbol if GPS signal is not being received See Global Positioning System GPS on page 281 e Options you have selected for reaching your current destination e Driver Information e Radio band and presets ROUTE Press the ROUTE key to display the PLAN ROUTE menu See Plan Route on page 249 MENU Press the MENU key to display the SETUP MENU See Setup Menu on page 243 TILT Press the TILT key to open the navigatio
384. s the steering column outside mirrors and the driver s seat to automatically move to the current driver s set position when the engine starts The DIC will display AUTO RECALL OFF or AUTO RECALL ON Press the OPTIONS button to change the setting Auto Exit Recall This feature allows the steering column and driver s seat to automatically move to the current driver s exit position when one of the following occurs e The vehicle is turned off or in RAP or accessory mode and the driver s door is opened e The vehicle is turned off or in RAP and the unlock button on the keyless access transmitter is pressed The DIC will display AUTO EXIT RECALL OFF or AUTO EXIT RECALL ON Press the OPTIONS button to change the setting Approach Lights This feature activates the parking lamps front fog lamps and back up lamps during low light periods when the unlock button on the keyless access transmitter is pressed both doors are closed and the vehicle is off or in RAP The lamps remain on for 20 seconds or until a door is opened the lock button on the keyless access transmitter is pressed or the vehicle is no longer off or in RAP The DIC will display APPROACH LIGHTS OFF or APPROACH LIGHTS ON Press the OPTIONS button to change the setting Exit Lights This feature activates the parking lamps and front fog lamps for 15 30 or 90 seconds This will occur when the vehicle is off or in RAP and the headlamps are on due to the automa
385. s you will need to know to drive safely and economically The instrument panel cluster indicator warning lights gages and DIC messages are explained on the following pages United States Base Cluster shown Canada and Uplevel similar 186 Speedometer and Odometer Your speedometer lets you see your speed in either miles per hour mph or kilometers per hour km h There is only one scale for mph and km h Use the Driver Information Center DIC controls to switch between mph and km h See DIC Controls and Displays on page 204 for more information The cluster will calculate the proper speed and move the needle to the correct position Either the MPH or the km h telltale will illuminate depending on which measurement you choose The odometer is part of the Driver Information Center DIC See DIC Controls and Displays on page 204 for more information Trip Odometer The trip odometer is part of the Driver Information Center DIC See DIC Controls and Displays on page 204 for more information Tachometer The tachometer displays the engine speed in thousands of revolutions per minute rpm Fuel will shut off at about 6700 rpm If you continue to drive your vehicle at the fuel shut off rpm you could damage your engine Be sure to operate your vehicle below the fuel shut off rom or reduce your rpm quickly when the fuel shuts off Safety Belt Reminder Light When the ignition button is pressed to START a c
386. se their vehicles maintenance needs vary You may need more frequent checks and replacements So please read the following and note how you drive If you have any questions on how to keep your vehicle in good condition see your GM Goodwrench dealer This schedule is for vehicles that e carry passengers and cargo within recommended limits You will find these limits on the Tire and Loading Information label See Loading Your Vehicle on page 354 e are driven on reasonable road surfaces within legal driving limits e use the recommended fuel See Gasoline Octane on page 366 The services in Scheduled Maintenance on page 465 should be performed when indicated See Additional Required Services on page 467 and Maintenance Footnotes on page 469 for further information 463 A CAUTION Performing maintenance work on a vehicle can be dangerous In trying to do some jobs you can be seriously injured Do your own maintenance work only if you have the required know how and the proper tools and equipment for the job If you have any doubt see your GM Goodwrench dealer to have a qualified technician do the work Some maintenance services can be complex So unless you are technically qualified and have the necessary equipment you should have your GM Goodwrench dealer do these jobs 464 When you go to your GM Goodwrench dealer for your service needs you will know that GM trained and supported service technic
387. sh an infant in a rear facing seat settles into the restraint so the crash forces can be distributed across the strongest part of an infant s body the back and shoulders Infants always should be secured in appropriate infant restraints A CAUTION The body structure of a young child is quite unlike that of an adult or older child for whom the safety belts are designed A young child s hip bones are still so small that the vehicle s regular safety belt may not remain low on the hip bones as it should Instead it may settle up around the child s abdomen In a crash the belt would apply force on a body area that is unprotected by any bony structure This alone could cause serious or fatal injuries Young children always should be secured in appropriate child restraints Child Restraint Systems A rear facing infant seat B provides restraint with the seating surface against the back of the An infant car bed A a special bed made for use infant The harness system holds the infant in in a motor vehicle is an infant restraint system place and in a crash acts to keep the infant designed to restrain or position a child on a positioned in the restraint continuous flat surface Make sure that the infant s head rests toward the center of the vehicle 35 A forward facing child seat C E provides restraint for the child s body with the harness and also sometimes with surfaces such as T shaped or shel
388. sing interference with it the DIC will display NO FOB DETECTED See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 206 for more information When the engine begins cranking let go of the button and the engine cranks automatically until it starts If the battery in the keyless access transmitter is weak the DIC displays FOB BATTERY LOW You can still drive the vehicle See Battery Replacement under Keyless Access System Operation on page 68 for more information If the fob battery is dead you need to insert the fob into the fob slot to enable engine starting See No Fobs Detected under DIC Warnings and Messages on page 206 3 Do not race the engine immediately after starting it Operate the engine and transmission gently until the oil warms up and lubricates all moving parts If the engine does not start and no DIC message is displayed wait 15 seconds before trying again to let the cranking motor cool down If the engine does not start after 5 10 seconds especially in very cold weather below 0 F or 18 C it could be flooded with too much gasoline Try pushing the accelerator pedal all the way to the floor while cranking for up to 15 seconds maximum Wait at least 15 seconds between each try to allow the cranking motor to cool down When the engine starts let go of the accelerator If the vehicle starts briefly but then stops again do the same thing This clears the extra gasoline from the engine
389. sion has not shifted gears Some automatic downshifts can occur to maintain minimum engine speed This only happens if the vehicle is left in too high of a gear for the vehicle s speed For example if you have been driving in sixth gear range and come to a stop without manually downshifting the transmission automatically downshifts to first gear and displays first gear on the HUD As you begin to drive and accelerate the transmission remains in first gear until the driver selects a downshift 96 DSC can be used while using cruise control but transmission shifting is different while the cruise control is on This is not a malfunction and is necessary to let proper operation of the cruise control To return to fully automatic operation move the shift lever to the right and back into DRIVE D When accelerating your vehicle from a stop in snowy and icy conditions you may want to shift into second gear A higher gear lets you gain more traction on slippery surfaces In higher gears on the XLR only an automatic downshift occurs if you press the accelerator pedal to the floor This feature provides adequate acceleration capabilities if you forget to downshift manually Tap the shifter forward and the vehicle upshifts Parking Brake The parking brake pedal is located to the left of the regular brake pedal near the driver s door To set the parking brake hold the regular brake pedal down with your right foot a
390. sions for vehicles with side impact airbags 51 What Will You See After an Airbag Inflates After an airbag inflates it quickly deflates so quickly that some people may not even realize the airbag inflated Some components of the airbag module the steering wheel hub for the drivers frontal airbag the instrument panel for the right front passenger s frontal airbag and for seating positions with side impact airbags the side of the seatback closest to the door may be hot for a short time The parts of the airbag that come into contact with you may be warm but not too hot to touch There may be some smoke and dust coming from the vents in the deflated airbags Airbag inflation does not prevent the driver from seeing out of the windshield or being able to steer the vehicle nor does it prevent people from leaving the vehicle 52 A CAUTION When an airbag inflates there may be dust in the air This dust could cause breathing problems for people with a history of asthma or other breathing trouble To avoid this everyone in the vehicle should get out as soon as it is safe to do so If you have breathing problems but cannot get out of the vehicle after an airbag inflates then get fresh air by opening a window or a door If you experience breathing problems following an airbag deployment you should seek medical attention Your vehicle has a feature that may automatically unlock the doors turn the interior la
391. sitions These positions allow you to signal a turn or a lane change To signal a turn move the multifunction lever all the way up or down When the turn is finished the lever will return automatically An arrow on the instrument panel cluster will flash in the direction of the turn or lane change 142 To signal a lane change just raise or lower the lever until the arrow starts to flash Hold it there until you complete your lane change The lever will return by itself when you release it If you signal a turn or a lane change and the arrows flash faster than normal a signal bulb may be burned out Other drivers will not see the turn signal Replace burned out bulbs to help avoid possible accidents If the arrows do not go on at all when you signal a turn check the fuses and check for burned out bulbs See Fuses and Circuit Breakers on page 453 Turn Signal on Chime A chime will remind you if you leave the turn signal on for more than 3 4 mile 1 2 km of driving If you need to leave the turn signal on for more than 3 4 mile 1 2 km turn off the signal and then turn it back on Headlamp High Low Beam Changer To change the headlamps from low beam to high push the turn signal lever all the way forward When the high beams are on this light on the instrument panel cluster will also be on To change the headlamps from high to low pull the lever rearward Flash to Pass This feature lets you use
392. smitter e Press the trunk close button on the underside of the trunk lid To begin opening the trunk from the stopped position use any of the methods above except pressing the trunk close button To resume closing the power trunk lid press the trunk close button on the underside of the trunk lid If the vehicle has lost battery power you can still open the trunk using the key iS Sa The key cylinder is located behind a cover on the lower rear fascia on the drivers side of the vehicle Open the door to access the key cylinder The key is located inside the keyless access transmitter See Keys on page 65 for more information 79 Emergency Trunk Release Handle 80 Notice Do not use the emergency trunk release handle as a tie down or anchor point when securing items in the trunk as it could damage the handle The emergency trunk release handle is only intended to aid a person trapped in a latched trunk enabling them to open the trunk from the inside There is a glow in the dark emergency trunk release handle located inside the trunk near the latch This handle will glow following exposure to light Pull the release handle and push up on the trunk lid to release the latch from the inside Windows A CAUTION Leaving children helpless adults or pets Lip in a vehicle with the windows closed is y j iz extreme heat and suffer permanent injuries or even death from heat stroke Never leave
393. stance to adapt to the changing traffic conditions Do not use cruise control when visibility is low Some of the Adaptive Cruise controls are located on the end of the multifunction lever Off This position turns the system off On This position turns the system on Resume Increase Push the switch to this symbol to make the vehicle resume to a previously set speed or to increase the set speed when Adaptive Cruise Control is already active Set Decrease Press this button to set the speed or to decrease the set speed when Adaptive Cruise Control is already active Engaging Adaptive Cruise Control With the Set Button A CAUTION If you leave your Adaptive Cruise Control switch on when you are not using cruise you might hit a button and go into cruise when you do not want to You could be startled and even lose control Keep the Adaptive Cruise Control switch off until you want to use cruise control A CAUTION If you operate Adaptive Cruise Control without your Head up Display HUD on and properly adjusted your Adaptive Cruise Control settings will not be visible You could forget your settings and be startled by Adaptive Cruise Control response and even lose control Keep your HUD on and properly adjusted when using Adaptive Cruise Control The set speed is selected by the driver This is the speed you will travel if there is not a vehicle detected in your path To set Adaptive C
394. stem TCS Your vehicle has a traction control system that limits wheel spin This is especially useful in slippery road conditions The system operates only if it senses that one or both of the rear wheels are spinning or beginning to lose traction When this happens the system works the rear brakes and reduces engine power to limit wheel spin The TRAC SYSTEM ACTIVE message will display on the Driver Information Center DIC when the traction control system is limiting wheel spin See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 206 You may feel or hear the system working but this is normal If your vehicle is in cruise control when the traction control system begins to limit wheel spin the cruise control will automatically disengage When road conditions allow you to safely use it again you may reengage the cruise control See Adaptive Cruise Control on page 150 or Cruise Control on page 147 for more information 329 This warning light will come on to let you know if there is a problem with your traction control system See Traction Control System TCS Warning Light on page 194 When this warning light is on the system will not limit wheel spin Adjust your driving accordingly The traction control system automatically comes on whenever you start your vehicle To limit wheel spin especially in slippery road conditions you should always leave the system on But you can turn the traction control system off if you ever need
395. stem off could allow dangerous exhaust into your vehicle See the earlier caution under Engine Exhaust on page 102 Also idling in a closed in place can let deadly carbon monoxide CO into your vehicle even if the climate control fan is at the highest setting One place this can happen is a garage Exhaust with A CAUTION It can be dangerous to get out of your vehicle if the shift lever is not fully in PARK P with the parking brake firmly set Your vehicle can roll Do not leave your vehicle when the engine is running unless you have to If you have left the engine running the vehicle can move suddenly You or others could be injured To be sure your vehicle will not move even when you are on fairly level ground always set your parking brake and move the shift lever to PARK P CO can come in easily NEVER park in Follow the proper steps to be sure your vehicle a garage with the engine running will not move See Shifting Into Park P on page 99 Another closed in place can be a blizzard See Winter Driving on page 349 103 Mirrors Automatic Dimming Rearview Mirror with OnStar Your vehicle has an automatic dimming inside rearview mirror The mirror also contains OnStar controls For more information about OnStar see OnStar System on page 107 cb On Off This button located on the lower left side of the mirror is for the automatic dimming functions 104 Mirror Operation The a
396. straints which are purchased by Children who are up against or very close the vehicle s owner are available in four basic to any airbag when it inflates can be types Selection of a particular restraint should seriously injured or killed Airbags plus take into consideration not only the child s lap shoulder belts offer protection for weight height and age but also whether or not adults and older children but not for the restraint will be compatible with the motor young children and infants Neither the vehicle in which it will be used vehicle s safety belt system nor its airbag For most basic types of child restraints there system is designed for them Young are many different models available When children and infants need the protection purchasing a child restraint be sure it is that a child restraint system can provide designed to be used in a motor vehicle If it is the restraint will have a label saying that it meets federal motor vehicle safety standards 33 The restraint manufacturer s instructions that come with the restraint state the weight and height limitations for a particular child restraint In addition there are many kinds of restraints available for children with special needs A CAUTION Newborn infants need complete support including support for the head and neck This is necessary because a newborn infant s neck is weak and its head weighs so much compared with the rest of its body In a cra
397. street address do the following 1 Press the PWR VOL knob to turn the system on 2 Insert the DVD map disc See Regional Maps under Maps on page 271 for more information 3 A notice may appear Touch the AGREE screen button to proceed If the radio is already on with a map disc inserted press the ROUTE hard key 4 Press the Enter Destination screen button Verify that the selected Search Area is correct 5 Press the Address screen button 237 6 10 Press the Street screen button then enter the street name using the alpha keypad on the screen Do not enter directional information or street type and use the space screen button between street or city names For example the street name N Royal Oak Rd should be entered as royal oak Use the backspace X screen button if an incorrect character has been entered Select the desired street name with the correct designation Dr Ln St etc from the list If there is more than one city the system will display the list of cities that have that street name Select a city from the list or select the City screen button to input the city name Enter the house number using the numeric keypad on the screen and touch the Enter screen button The system will list the house number range that is available for the street Press the Enter screen button to plan your route See Address under Enter Destination on page 259 for more infor
398. suffer serious injury Only use GM specific wheel and tire systems developed for your vehicle and have them properly installed by a GM certified technician See Buying New Tires on page 428 and Accessories and Modifications on page 363 for additional information Uniform Tire Quality Grading Quality grades can be found where applicable on the tire sidewall between tread shoulder and maximum section width For example Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature A The following information relates to the system developed by the United States National Highway Traffic Safety Administration NHTSA which grades tires by treadwear traction and temperature performance This applies only to vehicles sold in the United States The grades are molded on the sidewalls of most passenger car tires The Uniform Tire Quality Grading UTQG system does not apply to deep tread winter type snow tires space saver or temporary use spare tires tires with nominal rim diameters of 10 to 12 inches 25 to 30 cm or to some limited production tires While the tires available on General Motors passenger cars and light trucks may vary with respect to these grades they must also conform to federal safety requirements and additional General Motors Tire Performance Criteria TPC standards Treadwear The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified government tes
399. t e Weather Forecasts What is the weather be aware that it can happen outlook along your route Should you Then here are some tips delay your trip a short time to avoid a major storm system e Maps Do you have up to date maps e Make sure your vehicle is well ventilated with a comfortably cool interior e Keep your eyes moving Scan the road ahead and to the sides Check your rearview mirrors and your instruments frequently Highway Hypnosis Is there actually such a condition as highway e f you get sleepy pull off the road into a rest hypnosis Or is it just plain falling asleep at the service or parking area and take a nap get wheel Call it highway hypnosis lack of some exercise or both For safety treat awareness or whatever drowsiness on the highway as an emergency There is something about an easy stretch of road with the same scenery along with the hum of the tires on the road the drone of the engine and the rush of the wind against the vehicle that can make 346 Hill and Mountain Roads If you drive regularly in steep country or if you are planning to visit there here are some tips that can make your trips safer and more enjoyable e Keep your vehicle in good shape Check all fluid levels and also the brakes tires cooling system and transmission These parts can work hard on mountain roads A CAUTION If you do not shift down your brakes could get so hot that they would not work well Yo
400. t Stop These commands will cause the system to display rest area POI icons Tourist Information This command will cause the system to display tourist information POI icons 320 Historical Monument This command will cause the system to display historical monument POI icons Performing Arts This command will cause the system to display performing arts POI icons Museum This command will cause the system to display museum POI icons Bank This command will cause the system to display bank POI icons School This command will cause the system to display school POI icons ATM This command will cause the system to display ATM POI icons Higher Education University College These commands will cause the system to display higher education POI icons Business Facility This command will cause the system to display business facility POI icons City Center This command will cause the system to display city center POI icons POI Off This command will cause the system to turn off POls so they do not appear on the map screen Section 5 Your Driving the Road and Your Vehicle wiccnccciseccsecctperaseveennteenenniess 322 Defensive Driving cccseeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 322 Drunken Driving eccess 323 Control of a Vehicle 326 Braking cones cone d ennrain isase entas rarer EE 326 Anti Lock Brake System ABS 008 327 Braking in Emergencies eeeeseeeeees 329 Traction Control S
401. t course For example a tire graded 150 would wear one and a half 1 5 times as well on the government course as a tire graded 100 The relative performance of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use however and may depart significantly from the norm due to variations in driving habits service practices and differences in road characteristics and climate Traction AA A B C The traction grades from highest to lowest are AA A B and C Those grades represent the tire s ability to stop on wet pavement as measured under controlled conditions on specified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete A tire marked C may have poor traction performance Warning The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on straight ahead braking traction tests and does not include acceleration cornering hydroplaning or peak traction characteristics 431 Temperature A B C The temperature grades are A the highest B and C representing the tire s resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure The grade C corresponds to a level of performance which all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No
402. t too sharply into the right lane you could hit a vehicle on your right Check your inside mirror or glance over your shoulder before changing lanes The passenger side mirror is convex A convex mirror s surface is curved so more can be seen from the driver s seat It also makes things look farther away than they really are OnStar System e OnStar uses several innovative technologies and live advisors to provide you with a wide range of Safety security information and convenience services If your airbags deploy the system is designed to make an automatic call to OnStar Emergency advisors who can request emergency services be sent to your location If you lock your keys in the vehicle call OnStar at 1 888 4 ONSTAR and they can send a signal to unlock your doors If you need roadside assistance press the OnStar button and they can contact Roadside Service for you OnStar service is provided to you subject to the OnStar Terms and Conditions You may cancel your OnStar service at any time by contacting OnStar as provided below A complete OnStar Owners Guide and the OnStar Terms and Conditions are included in the vehicle s OnStar Subscriber glove box literature For more information visit onstar com or onstar ca contact OnStar at 1 888 4 ONSTAR 1 888 466 7827 or TTY 1 877 248 2080 or press the OnStar button to speak with an OnStar advisor 24 hours a day 7 days a week
403. t your vehicle may not have all of them For example more than one entertainment system may be offered or your vehicle may have been ordered without a front passenger or rear seats Keep this manual in the vehicle so it will be there if it is needed while you are on the road If the vehicle is sold leave this manual in the vehicle Canadian Owners A French language copy of this manual can be obtained from your dealer or from Helm Incorporated P O Box 07130 Detroit MI 48207 2006 General Motors Corporation All Rights Reserved How to Use This Manual Many people read the owner manual from beginning to end when they first receive their new vehicle If this is done it can help you learn about the features and controls for the vehicle Pictures and words work together in the owner manual to explain things Index A good place to quickly locate information about the vehicle is the Index in the back of the manual It is an alphabetical list of what is in the manual and the page number where it can be found Safety Warnings and Symbols There are a number of safety cautions in this book We use a box and the word CAUTION to tell about things that could hurt you if you were to ignore the warning A CAUTION These mean there is something that could hurt you or other people In the caution area we tell you what the hazard is Then we tell you what to do to help avoid or reduce the hazard Please read these
404. tains from carpets vinyl and cloth upholstery Odorless spray odor Odor Eliminator eliminator used on fabrics vinyl leather and carpet Finish Enhancer Wash Wax Concentrate Spot Lifter Vehicle Identification Vehicle Identification Number VIN SAMPLE4UX1M07267 This is the legal identifier for your vehicle It appears on a plate in the front corner of the instrument panel on the driver s side You can see it if you look through the windshield from outside your vehicle The VIN also appears on the Vehicle Certification and Service Parts labels and the certificates of title and registration Engine Identification The eighth character in the VIN is the engine code This code will help you identify your vehicle s engine specifications and replacement parts Service Parts Identification Label You will find this label on the rear compartment cover in the trunk It is very helpful if you ever need to order parts On this label you will find the following e VIN e Model designation e Paint information e Production options and special equipment Do not remove this label from the vehicle 451 Electrical System Add On Electrical Equipment Notice Do not add anything electrical to your vehicle unless you check with your dealer first Some electrical equipment can damage your vehicle and the damage would not be covered by your warranty Some add on electrical equipment can keep other compo
405. te and your device should activate when the Universal Home Remote button is pressed and released To program the remaining two Universal Home Remote buttons begin with Step 2 under Programming Universal Home Remote Do not repeat Step 1 as this will erase all of the programmed channels If the indicator light blinks rapidly for two seconds and then turns to a constant light continue with Steps 6 through 8 following to complete the programming of a rolling code equipped device most commonly a garage door opener 119 6 Locate in the garage the garage door opener receiver motor head unit Locate the Learn or Smart button This can usually be found where the hanging antenna wire is attached to the motor head unit 7 Firmly press and release the Learn or Smart button The name and color of the button may vary by manufacturer You will have 30 seconds to start Step 8 8 Return to the vehicle Firmly press and hold the programmed Universal Home Remote button for two seconds then release it Immediately press and hold the same button a second time for two seconds then release it Immediately press and hold the same button a third time for two seconds then release The Universal Home Remote should now activate your rolling code equipped device To program the remaining two Universal Home Remote buttons begin with Step 2 of Programming Universal Home Remote You do not want to rep
406. teeeeeees 396 Windshield Washer Fluid o ae 397 Brakas sevicusactsesuinveveentetesnstunaplesvideudgenentadeese 399 BARON aneren 402 JUMP Starting sissisodan aaeain 403 Rear AXle eso coos dences reer n ena 407 Headlamp Aiming a ees 408 Headlamp Vertical Aiming ceecee 410 Bulb Replacement 0 ceeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 412 Windshield Replacement 0 0 412 Windshield Wiper Blade Replacement 412 MS cetacean cone sR ede ee 413 Winter Tires XLR V ceeceeeeeeeeeeeeeeee 414 Tire Sidewall Labeling ceeseeeeeee 415 Tire Terminology and Definitions 417 Run Flat TOS sorata o tevordeans 420 Inflation Tire Pressure csere 422 Tire Pressure Monitor System 008 423 Tire Inspection and Rotation ee 426 Section 6 Service and Appearance Care When It Is Time for New Tires 00 428 Windshield and Wiper Blades 447 Buying NeW Tires cseeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 428 Aluminum or Chrome Plated Wheels 448 Different Size Tires and Wheels 430 TIES adiccadiduiees tines a EEEa 449 Uniform Tire Quality Grading 0 00 431 Sheet Metal Damage ecce 449 Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance 432 Finish Damage cccccseeeeeeeeeeeeeeseeeeees 449 Wheel Replacement ceeeeeeeeeeeeeee 432 Underbody Maintenance n e 449 Tire Chains asencasstdessscnseerssncnscandeue
407. tention and a quick decision If you are holding the steering wheel at the recommended 9 and 3 o clock positions you can turn it a full 180 degrees very quickly without removing either hand But you have to act fast steer quickly and just as quickly straighten the wheel once you have avoided the object The fact that such emergency situations are always possible is a good reason to practice defensive driving at all times and wear safety belts properly Off Road Recovery You may find that your right wheels have dropped off the edge of a road onto the shoulder while you are driving If the level of the shoulder is only slightly below the pavement recovery should be fairly easy Ease off the accelerator and then if there is nothing in the way steer so that your vehicle straddles the edge of the pavement You can turn the steering wheel up to one quarter turn until the right front tire contacts the pavement edge Then turn your steering wheel to go straight down the roadway Passing The driver of a vehicle about to pass another on a two lane highway waits for just the right moment accelerates moves around the vehicle ahead then goes back into the right lane again A simple maneuver Not necessarily Passing another vehicle on a two lane highway is a potentially dangerous move since the passing vehicle occupies the same lane as oncoming traffic for several seconds A miscalculation an error in judgment or a bri
408. ter If TITLE is available this button will allow you to navigate through chapters or the DVD features Once the appropriate title or track has been selected press the Return button then the IMAGE button on the DVD menu to view the movie in full screen 310 SETTING Touch this button to adjust the following e LANGUAGE PREFERENCES e PARENTAL LOCK Under LANGUAGE PREFERENCES you can select different languages for AUDIO SUBTITLE and DVD MENUS 1 To change languages first select the option you wish to change 2 Select a language from the list given 3 Touch RETURN to end out the menu Your language is now saved Under PARENTAL LOCK you can select SET RATING LIMIT and SET PIN To SET RATING first touch the button Then make your selection Touch RETURN to end out the menu Your selection is now saved To use PARENTAL LOCK first touch the button Then enter a four digit numeric password Touch RETURN to end out the menu SEARCH Touch this button to search to a certain scene on the DVD Depending on the type of DVD you are using this button may or may not be available 4 Rewind Touch this button to rewind through a scene during playback gt Resume Touch this button to resume playing a DVD E Stop Touch this button to stop the DVD Il Pause Touch this button to pause the DVD Forward Touch this button to advance rapidly during playback I gt Frame Advance Touch this but
409. th it We hope you will go to your dealer for all your service needs You will get genuine GM parts and GM trained and supported service people We hope you will want to keep your GM vehicle all GM Genuine GM parts have one of these marks ACVelco E parts GM Goodwrench E Accessories Accessories and Modifications When you add non GM accessories to your vehicle they can affect your vehicle s performance and safety including such things as airbags braking stability ride and handling emissions systems aerodynamics durability and electronic systems like anti lock brakes traction control and stability control Some of these accessories may even cause malfunction or damage not covered by warranty GM Accessories are designed to complement and function with other systems on your vehicle Your GM dealer can accessorize your vehicle using genuine GM Accessories When you go to your GM dealer and ask for GM Accessories you will know that GM trained and supported service technicians will perform the work using genuine GM Accessories 363 California Proposition 65 Warning Most motor vehicles including this one contain and or emit chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm Engine exhaust many parts and systems including some inside the vehicle many fluids and some component wear by products contain and or emit these chemicals 364
410. th this feature on the estimated travel time to destination will display along with the distance to destination Quick POI Point of Interest Selection Setting the Quick POI Menu This menu allows you to choose a point of To set the Quick POI list displayed on the map interest POI such as gas stations restaurants screen do the following hotels etc to be displayed on the map screen 1 Select the category you would like to replace You can also set a destination to a specific POI 2 Select a Quick POI category from the Quick POI selection menu list The system will return to the Quick POI selection screen when a POI is selected 3 Touch Return to save the setting and return to previous menu Displaying Quick POI Icons To display POI icons of a category on the map screen do the following 1 Touch the map screen once 2 Touch the POI button The Quick POI Selection list will be displayed 3 Select a category type or touch List Categories Or All Local POls to display the icons of the selected category on the map screen 245 Removing Quick POI Icons To remove POI icons from the map screen do the following 1 Touch the map screen once 2 Touch the POI OFF screen button The current POI icons will be removed from the map screen Setting a Destination Using Quick POI This feature will allow you to choose a POI as your destination To set a destination using a POI do the following 1 Touch
411. that hold the tire onto the rim Bias Ply Tire A pneumatic tire in which the plies are laid at alternate angles less than 90 degrees to the centerline of the tread Cold Tire Pressure The amount of air pressure in a tire measured in pounds per square inch psi or kilopascals kPa before a tire has built up heat from driving See Inflation Tire Pressure on page 422 Curb Weight This means the weight of a motor vehicle with standard and optional equipment including the maximum capacity of fuel oil and coolant but without passengers and cargo 417 DOT Markings A code molded into the sidewall of a tire signifying that the tire is in compliance with the U S Department of Transportation DOT motor vehicle safety standards The DOT code includes the Tire Identification Number TIN an alphanumeric designator which can also identify the tire manufacturer production plant brand and date of production GVWR Gross Vehicle Weight Rating See Loading Your Vehicle on page 354 GAWR FRT Gross Axle Weight Rating for the front axle See Loading Your Vehicle on page 354 GAWR RR Gross Axle Weight Rating for the rear axle See Loading Your Vehicle on page 354 Intended Outboard Sidewall The side of an asymmetrical tire that must always face outward when mounted on a vehicle Kilopascal kPa The metric unit for air pressure 418 Light Truck LT Metric Tire A tire used on light duty trucks and some multipurpos
412. the POI icon on the map screen that you wish to set as a destination The selected icon will be surrounded by a blinking box and the name of the icon will be displayed You may also touch INFO to view the POI name address city and phone number if available 246 2 Touch the ENT DEST screen button If a final destination has already been entered you can add the POI as a waypoint See Edit Waypoint on page 254 for more information 3 Touch Enter to start planning your route 4 To start route guidance touch Start or begin driving the vehicle Route guidance will automatically begin after a short distance If you wish to cancel the route you have just set do the following 1 Press the ROUTE hard key 2 Touch the Route Preference screen button 3 Touch the Cancel Route screen button 4 Select YES to cancel or NO to continue Guidance Appearance This menu allows you to set the guidance appearance screen options This screen is displayed on the map while on a planned route The current settings will appear as light blue 3 List Split Map Select this feature to display the guidance screen on the map at all times Full Screen Select this feature to display the guidance screen on the map when approaching a maneuver Turn List Select this feature to have the guidance screen display several upcoming turns Directional arrows street name and distance to the next turn will be displ
413. the amount of brake force applied Avoid needless heavy braking Some people drive in spurts heavy acceleration followed by heavy braking rather than keeping pace with traffic This is a mistake The brakes may not have time to cool between hard stops The brakes will wear out much faster if you do a lot of heavy braking If you keep pace with the traffic and allow realistic following distances you will eliminate a lot of unnecessary braking That means better braking and longer brake life If your vehicle s engine ever stops while you are driving brake normally but do not pump the brakes If you do the pedal may get harder to push down If the engine stops you will still have some power brake assist But you will use it when you brake Once the power assist is used up it may take longer to stop and the brake pedal will be harder to push Adding non GM accessories can affect your vehicle s performance See Accessories and Modifications on page 363 Anti Lock Brake System ABS Your vehicle has the Anti Lock Brake System ABS an advanced electronic braking system that will help prevent a braking skid When you start your engine and begin to drive away ABS will check itself You may hear a momentary motor or clicking noise while this test is going on and you may even notice that your brake pedal moves a little This is normal If there is a problem with ABS this warning light will stay on See Anti Lo
414. the instructions restraint must be secured in the vehicle Child for the restraint You may find these restraint systems must be secured in vehicle seats instructions on the restraint itself or in a by lap belts or the lap belt portion of a lap shoulder booklet or both belt A child can be endangered in a crash if the child restraint is not properly secured in the vehicle 37 When securing an add on child restraint refer to the instructions that come with the restraint which may be on the restraint itself or in a booklet or both and to this manual The child restraint instructions are important so if they are not available obtain a replacement copy from the manufacturer Keep in mind that an unsecured child restraint can move around in a collision or sudden stop and injure people in the vehicle Be sure to properly secure any child restraint in your vehicle even when no child is in it Securing the Child Within the Child Restraint There are several systems for securing the child within the child restraint One system the three point harness has straps that come down over each of the infant s shoulders and buckle together at the crotch The five point harness system has two shoulder straps two hip straps and a crotch strap A shield may take the place of hip straps A T shaped shield has shoulder straps that are attached to a flat pad which rests low against 38 the child s body A shelf or armrest type shield
415. the memory point 2 Select the item you want to edit 3 Touch the NAME screen button and use the alpha keypad to edit the name Names may contain up to 15 alpha and or numeric characters 4 Touch Return to go to the previous screen Moving Memory Points To move a memory point from one category to another do the following 1 Select the category of the memory point 2 Select the memory point you want to edit 3 Touch CATEGORY A list of categories will appear The current category for the item will be highlighted and cannot be selected 4 Touch the screen button for the category you want the memory point placed in A pop up window will appear displaying the change in category 5 Touch Return to go back to the previous screen 251 Adjusting a Memory Point To relocate a memory point s location do the following 1 Select the category of the memory point 2 Select the memory point you want to edit 3 Touch POSITION A map screen with the position of this memory point will appear 4 Touch anywhere on the screen to activate the scroll feature and relocate the memory point See Maps on page 271 5 Touch Enter to save the memory point s new location 6 Touch Return to go back to the previous screen Changing the Phone Number of a Memory Point To edit or add the phone number of a memory point do the following 1 Select the category of the memory point 2 Select the memory point you want to
416. the set button at the end of the lever then release the button and the accelerator pedal You will now cruise at the higher speed e Move the Adaptive Cruise Control switch from on to resume increase Hold it there until the desired set speed is displayed in the HUD then release the switch To increase your set speed in very small amounts move the switch briefly to resume increase Each time you do this your vehicle set speed will increase by 1 mph 1 6 km h Your vehicle will not reach the set speed until the system determines there is not a vehicle in front of you At that point your vehicle speed will increase to the set speed Decreasing Set Speed While Using Adaptive Cruise Control Press in the set decrease button on the end of the lever until you reach the lower speed you want then release it To slow down in very small amounts briefly press the set decrease button Each time you do this your set speed will be 1 mph 1 6 km h slower Resuming a Set Speed Suppose you set your Adaptive Cruise Control at a desired speed and then you apply the brake This will disengage the Adaptive Cruise Control But you do not need to reset it Once you are going about 25 mph 40 km h or more you can move the Adaptive Cruise Control switch briefly from on to resume increase Adaptive Cruise Control will be engaged with the previously chosen set speed Selecting the Follow Distance GAP When the system detects a slower mo
417. the visor or mirror cover Always return the visor to the center mount or lower the cover on the visor vanity mirror before raising or lowering the retractable hardtop Swing down the visor to block out glare It can also be detached from the center mount and moved to the side Lighted Visor Vanity Mirrors Swing the visor down and lift the cover The lamp will automatically come on when the cover is opened 84 Theft Deterrent Systems Vehicle theft is big business especially in some cities Although your vehicle has a number of theft deterrent features we know that nothing we put on it can make it impossible to steal Theft Deterrent System Your vehicle is equipped with a theft deterrent alarm system With this system the security light will flash when the door is open and locked with the power door lock switch f If this light is on continuously while the engine is running your vehicle needs service Arming the System Use one of the three following items listed here to arm the system e Press the lock button on the keyless access transmitter e Open the door Lock the door with the power door lock switch The security light should flash Remove the keyless access transmitter from the interior of the vehicle and close the door The security light will stop flashing and stay on After 30 seconds the light should turn off e The vehicle can be programmed to automatically lock the doors and arm
418. ther reduce the list of available items The system will display a list of the intersecting streets if the number of intersecting streets is five or less 4 Select the first street 5 Now enter the second street name 6 Select the second street name from the list of intersecting streets To view a list of choices touch List or continue to spell the name to further reduce the list of available items The system will display a list of intersecting streets if the number of intersecting streets is five or less If there are multiple intersections with the same two roads the system will display a list of cities to choose from Choose a city from this list A map with the intersections for that city will appear 7 Touch Enter to plan your route Route Preference To change your planning options use the following instructions 4 06AM 85 F Calculate Route Cancel Route 1 Press the ROUTE key 2 Touch Route Preference The following options will be available from the ROUTE PREFERENCE menu Detour This feature allows you to choose a distance in miles kilometers to detour Select the detour distance desired for residential roads and freeways 95 3 MHz 4 18PM 85 F DETOUR Residential The system will retain these settings for the next time you use Detour unless you change them You may also touch Alternate to provide a new route that does not use previously stored detour settings
419. this A CAUTION You can be seriously injured if your belt is buckled in the wrong place like this In a crash the belt would go up over your abdomen The belt forces would be there not at the pelvic bones This could cause serious internal injuries Always buckle your belt into the buckle nearest you A The belt is buckled in the wrong place 23 Q What is wrong with this A CAUTION You can be seriously injured if you wear the shoulder belt under your arm Ina crash your body would move too far forward which would increase the chance of head and neck injury Also the belt would apply too much force to the ribs which are not as strong as shoulder bones You could also severely injure internal organs like your liver or spleen A The shoulder belt is worn under the arm It should be worn over the shoulder at all times 24 Q What is wrong with this a A CAUTION You can be seriously injured by a twisted belt In a crash you would not have the full width of the belt to spread impact forces If a belt is twisted make it straight so it can work properly or ask your dealer to fix it A The belt is twisted across the body 25 To unlatch the belt push the button on the buckle The belt should go back out of the way Before you close the door be sure the belt is out of the way If you slam the door on it you can damage both the belt a
420. tic headlamp system The parking lamps and front fog lamps will remain on until the driver selected time period expires the exterior lamp control is activated or the vehicle is no longer off or in RAP The DIC will display EXIT LIGHTS OFF EXIT LIGHTS 15 SEC EXIT LIGHTS 30 SEC or EXIT LIGHTS 90 SEC Press the OPTIONS button to change the setting 221 Flash at Unlock This feature activates the front and rear turn signals for two short flashes when the unlock or trunk button on the keyless access transmitter is pressed This will only occur when the vehicle is off The DIC will display NO FLASH AT UNLOCK or FLASH AT UNLOCK Press the OPTIONS button to change the setting Flash at Lock This feature activates the front and rear turn signals for one long flash when the lock button on the keyless access transmitter is pressed This will only occur when the vehicle is off If the lock button is pressed again within five seconds the horn will sound regardless of which setting you have selected The DIC will display NO FLASH AT LOCK or FLASH AT LOCK Press the OPTIONS button to change the setting 222 FOB Reminder This feature sounds the horn three times when the driver door is closed and there is a keyless access transmitter inside the interior of the vehicle This will only occur when the vehicle is off The DIC will display FOB REMINDER OFF or FOB REMINDER HORN Press the OPTIONS button to change the setting
421. ting the battery you must press the unlock button on the keyless access transmitter Failure to follow this procedure may result in the alarm sounding Pressing unlock on the keyless access transmitter would stop the alarm Jump Starting If your vehicle s battery has run down you may want to use another vehicle and some jumper cables to start your vehicle Be sure to use the following steps to do it safely A CAUTION Batteries can hurt you They can be dangerous because e They contain acid that can burn you e They contain gas that can explode or ignite e They contain enough electricity to burn you If you do not follow these steps exactly some or all of these things can hurt you Notice If you try to start your vehicle by pushing or pulling it you could damage your vehicle Do not push or pull your vehicle to start it instead use the jump starting procedure in this manual to start your vehicle when the battery has run down 1 Check the other vehicle It must have a 12 volt battery with a negative ground system Notice If the other vehicle s system is not a 12 volt system with a negative ground both vehicles can be damaged Only use vehicles with 12 volt systems with negative grounds to jump start your vehicle 2 Get the vehicles close enough so the jumper cables can reach but be sure the vehicles are not touching each other If they are it could cause a ground connection you do not want
422. tire climate control system on or off Press the up or down arrow on the switch to manually increase or decrease the temperature inside the vehicle Press the PWR button on the right side of the climate control panel to turn the passenger s climate control system on or off Press the up or down arrow on the switch to manually increase or decrease the temperature for the passenger If the passengers PWR button is off the driver s temperature switch controls the temperature for the entire vehicle A amp v Fan Press this switch to increase or decrease the fan speed Pressing this switch cancels automatic operation and places the system in manual mode Press AUTO to return to automatic operation If the airflow seems low when the fan speed is at the highest setting the passenger compartment air filter may need to be replaced For more 180 information see Passenger Compartment Air Filter on page 184 and Scheduled Maintenance on page 465 V 4A Mode Pressing the switch and changing the mode cancels automatic operation and places the system in manual mode Press the AUTO button to return to automatic operation To change the current mode select one of the following 74 Vent This mode directs air to the instrument panel outlets 4 4 Bi Level This mode directs about half of the air to the instrument panel outlets and then directs most of the remaining air to the floor outlets In automatic operation cooler
423. to cause an expensive repair or replacement Paying attention to your warning lights and gages could also save you or others from injury Warning lights come on when there may be or is a problem with one of your vehicle s functions As you will see in the details on the next few pages some warning lights come on briefly when you start the engine just to let you know they are working If you are familiar with this section you should not be alarmed when this happens Gages can indicate when there may be or is a problem with one of your vehicle s functions Often gages and warning lights work together to let you know when there is a problem with your vehicle When one of the warning lights comes on and stays on when you are driving or when one of the gages shows there may be a problem check the section that tells you what to do about it Please follow this manual s advice Waiting to do repairs can be costly and even dangerous So please get to know your warning lights and gages They are a big help Your vehicle has a Driver Information Center that works along with the warning lights and gages See Driver Information Center DIC on page 203 for more information 185 Instrument Panel Cluster Your instrument panel cluster and Driver Information Center DIC are designed to let you know at a glance how the vehicle is running You will know how fast you are going about how much fuel you have left and many other thing
424. together with the following e Sidemarker Lamps e Taillamps e License Plate Lamps e Instrument Panel Lights The parking brake indicator light will come on and stay on when the parking lamps are on with the engine off and the ignition to Acc ZD Headlamps Turning the control to this position turns on the headlamps together with the previously listed lamps and lights 165 Wiper Activated Headlamps This feature activates the headlamps and parking lamps after the windshield wipers have been in use for approximately six seconds and the multifunction lever is in the AUTO position See Exterior Lamps on page 164 When the exterior lamp control has been turned off or is in the parking lamp position and the wiper control is on delay low speed or high speed the HEADLAMPS SUGGESTED message will appear on the Driver Information Center DIC When the ignition is turned off the wiper activated headlamps will immediately turn off Headlamps on Reminder A warning chime will sound if the exterior lamp control is left on in either the headlamp or parking lamp position and the driver s door is opened with the ignition off 166 Daytime Running Lamps DRL Daytime Running Lamps DRL can make it easier for others to see the front of your vehicle during the day DRL can be helpful in many different driving conditions but they can be especially helpful in the short periods after dawn and before sunset Fully functional
425. ton to advance by chapter during playback Radio Personalization with Home and Away Feature With this feature you can recall the latest audio system settings as adjusted the last time your vehicle was operated This feature allows two different drivers to store and recall their own audio system settings The settings recalled by the audio system are determined by which transmitter 1 or 2 was used to enter the vehicle The number on the back of the transmitter corresponds to driver 1 or to driver 2 The audio system settings will automatically adjust to where they were last set by the identified driver The settings can also be recalled by briefly pressing the MEMORY seat switches 1 or 2 located on the driver s door Your audio system can store HOME and AWAY preset stations HOME and AWAY preset stations allow you to use one set of preset radio settings in the area where you live and another set when you go out of town That way you will not need to reprogram your preset stations every time you travel 311 To select HOME and AWAY preset stations do the following 1 With the audio system on touch the Audio hard key and turn the audio system off 2 Touch the HOME or AWAY button from the main audio screen The next time the audio system is turned on the system will recall the last active preset selection When battery power is removed and later applied you will not have to reset your home audio system preset stat
426. tor If you are using a forward facing child restraint you may find it helpful to use your knee to push down on the child restraint as you tighten the belt You should not be able to pull more of the belt from the retractor once the lock has been set 7 Push and pull the child restraint in different directions to be sure it is secure 8 If the airbag is off the off indicator in the inside rearview mirror will be lit and stay lit when the vehicle is started If a child restraint has been installed and the on indicator is lit turn the vehicle off Remove the child restraint from the vehicle and reinstall the child restraint If after reinstalling the child restraint and restarting the vehicle the on indicator is still lit check to make sure that the vehicle s seatback is not pressing the child restraint into the seat cushion If this happens slightly recline the vehicle s seatback and adjust the seat cushion if possible If the on indicator is still lit do not secure a child restraint in this vehicle and check with your dealer To remove the child restraint just unbuckle the vehicle s safety belt and let it go back all the way The safety belt will move freely again and be ready to work for an adult or larger child passenger 43 Airbag System Here are the most important things to know about the airbag system Your vehicle has a frontal airbag for the driver a frontal airbag for the passenger a side impact
427. tside of the scroll symbol to scroll in that direction The map will continue to scroll until you remove your finger If your vehicle is in PARK P the system will initially scroll at a slower rate The rate will increase if you continue to touch the map screen If your vehicle is in motion there is one scroll speed and a limited distance to scroll You must keep touching the map screen to scroll a longer distance If your vehicle icon becomes lost while scrolling press the MAP key to show the vehicle s current location You may also use the scroll feature to set a destination See Set by Map under Enter Destination on page 259 Symbols The following symbols are the most common that appear on a map screen Your vehicle is shown as this symbol It indicates the current position and heading direction of your vehicle on the map This symbol will appear on the map to show your destination after a route has been planned See Enter Destination on page 259 for more information on planning a route z You will see this type of symbol on the map when a waypoint has been planned The waypoint symbol will be numbered from 1 through 5 depending on how many waypoints have been set See Edit Waypoint on page 254 for more information on adding waypoints MLS This symbol indicates the distance to your final destination 275 This symbol indicates the distance and estimated travel time to your fi
428. tting Diode LED above the Universal Home Remote buttons follow the instructions below If your vehicle has three round LED above the Universal Home Remote buttons follow the instructions under Universal Home Remote System Operation With three round LED Do not use the Universal Home Remote with any garage door opener that does not have the stop and reverse feature This includes any garage door opener model manufactured before April 1 1982 If you have a newer garage door opener with rolling codes please be sure to follow Steps 6 through 8 to complete the programming of your Universal Home Remote Transmitter 118 Read the instructions completely before attempting to program the Universal Home Remote Because of the steps involved it may be helpful to have another person available to assist you in the programming steps Keep the original hand held transmitter for use in other vehicles as well as for future Universal Home Remote programming It is also recommended that upon the sale of the vehicle the programmed Universal Home Remote buttons should be erased for security purposes See Erasing Universal Home Remote Buttons later in this section or for assistance see Customer Assistance Offices on page 485 Be sure that people and objects are clear of the garage door or gate operator you are programming When programming a garage door it is advised to park outside of the garage It is recommended that a new batt
429. tton Select a method for entering a destination See Enter Destination on page 259 for more information Press the Enter screen button to store the Home destination The ff Home icon will be highlighted on the DESTINATION screen See Using Your Home or Previous Destinations next to use the home or previous destinations as a route Using Your Home or Previous Destinations These destinations are available for selection while driving 1 2 6 Press the power volume knob to turn the system on Insert the DVD map disc See Regional Maps under Maps on page 271 for more information Anotice may appear Touch the AGREE screen button to proceed If the radio is already on with a map disc inserted press the ROUTE hard key Press the Enter Destination screen button Verify that the selected Search Area is correct Select the ff Home symbol or the Previous Destination screen button If the Previous Destination screen button is selected a list of the last 10 previous destinations will appear Select the screen button next to the desired destination Press the Enter screen button to plan your route See Home and Previous Destination under Enter Destination on page 259 for more information 239 Canceling Your Current Route Guidance will be canceled once you arrive at your final destination To cancel the current route prior to arrival at the final destination do th
430. u would then have poor braking or even none going down a hill You could crash Shift down to let your engine assist your brakes on a steep downhill slope Driving on steep hills or mountains is different from driving in flat or rolling terrain 347 A CAUTION Coasting downhill in NEUTRAL N or with the ignition off is dangerous Your brakes will have to do all the work of slowing down They could get so hot that they would not work well You would then have poor braking or even none going down a hill You could crash Always have your engine running and your vehicle in gear when you go downhill e Know how to go down hills The most important thing to know is this let your engine do some of the slowing down Shift to a lower gear when you go down a steep or long hill e Know how to go uphill You may want to shift down to a lower gear The lower gears help cool your engine and transmission and you can climb the hill better 348 e Stay in your own lane when driving on two lane roads in hills or mountains Do not swing wide or cut across the center of the road Drive at speeds that let you stay in your own lane e As you go over the top of a hill be alert There could be something in your lane like a stalled car or an accident e You may see highway signs on mountains that warn of special problems Examples are long grades passing or no passing zones a falling rocks area or winding roads Be alert to these
431. ublications are written specifically for owners and intended to provide basic operational information about the vehicle The owner s manual will include the Maintenance Schedule for all models In Portfolio Includes a Portfolio Owner s Manual and Warranty Booklet RETAIL SELL PRICE 35 00 Without Portfolio Owner s Manual only RETAIL SELL PRICE 25 00 Current and Past Model Order Forms Technical Service Bulletins and Manuals are available for current and past model GM vehicles To request an order form please specify year and model name of the vehicle 498 ORDER TOLL FREE 1 800 551 4123 Monday Friday 8 00 AM 6 00 PM Eastern Time For Credit Card Orders Only VISA MasterCard Discover visit Helm Inc on the World Wide Web at www helminc com Or you can write to Helm Incorporated P O Box 07130 Detroit MI 48207 Prices are subject to change without notice and without incurring obligation Allow ample time for delivery Note to Canadian Customers All listed prices are quoted in U S funds Canadian residents are to make checks payable in U S funds A Accessories and Modifications 00 363 Accessory Power Outlet S 0 ccceceeeceee 177 Adaptive Cruise Control 0 cceeereeeeeee 150 Adaptive Forward Lighting System 167 Adding Equipment to Your Airbag Equipped VOVICIS E cus E E E 59 Additives Fuel ccccccecceeceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeneees 367 Add On
432. unctions can be performed while driving as long as you can do so without diverting too much of your attention from your driving A CAUTION This system provides you with a far greater access to audio stations and song listings Giving extended attention to entertainment tasks while driving can cause a crash and you or others can be injured or killed Always keep your eyes on the road and your mind on the drive avoid engaging in extended searching while driving A CAUTION Looking at the moving map on the navigation screen frequently or for too long while driving can cause a crash and you or others can be injured or killed Keep your eyes and mind on the road and avoid looking too long or too often at the moving map on the navigation screen Use the voice guidance directions whenever possible The navigation system allows you to do the following e Plan a route with provided turn by turn route and map guidance with voice prompts See Plan Route on page 249 for more information e Select a destination using various methods and choices e Receive broadcast announcements on traffic and emergency alert communications The information in the system may not always be complete Road conditions such as prohibited turns detours and construction zones change frequently It is important to consider whether you can follow the directions given by the system for the current conditions When getting started you may set
433. until programming is complete 5 Press and release the button again The garage door should move confirming that programming is successful and complete To program another device such as an additional garage door opener a security device or home lighting repeat Steps 1 6 choosing a different function button in Step 4 than what you used for the garage door opener Using Universal Home Remote Press and hold the appropriate button for at least half of a second The indicator light will come on while the signal is being transmitted Reprogramming Universal Home Remote Buttons You can reprogram any of the three buttons by repeating the instructions Erasing Universal Home Remote Buttons You should erase the programmed buttons when you sell the vehicle or terminate your lease To erase either rolling code or fixed code on the Universal Home Remote device do the following 1 Press and hold the two outside buttons at the same time for approximately 20 seconds until the indicator lights located directly above the buttons begin to blink rapidly 2 Once the indicator lights begin to blink release both buttons The codes from all button will be erased For additional information on Universal Home Remote see Customer Assistance Offices on page 485 117 Universal Home Remote System Operation With One Triangular LED Your vehicle may have the Universal Home Remote System If there is one triangular Light Emi
434. ur vehicle slows down In addition your vehicle has dual stage frontal airbags which adjust the restraint according to crash severity Your vehicle has electronic frontal sensors which help the sensing system distinguish between a moderate frontal impact and a more severe frontal impact For moderate frontal impacts these airbags inflate at a level less than full deployment For more severe frontal impacts full deployment occurs If the front of your vehicle goes straight into a wall that does not move or deform the threshold level for the reduced deployment is about 12 to 16 mph 19 to 26 km h and the threshold level for a full deployment is about 18 to 24 mph 29 to 38 5 km h The threshold level can vary however with specific vehicle design so that it can be somewhat above or below this range 49 Frontal airbags may inflate at different crash speeds For example e If the vehicle hits a stationary object the airbags could inflate at a different crash speed than if the vehicle hits a moving object e If the vehicle hits an object that deforms the airbags could inflate at a different crash speed than if the vehicle hits an object that does not deform e lf the vehicle hits a narrow object like a pole the airbags could inflate at a different crash speed than if the vehicle hits a wide object like a wall e If the vehicle goes into an object at an angle the airbags could inflate at a different crash s
435. ur vehicle To help keep your engine clean and maintain optimum vehicle performance GM recommends the use of gasoline advertised as TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline The 8th digit of your Vehicle Identification Number VIN shows the code letter or number that identifies your engine You will find the VIN at the top left of the instrument panel See Vehicle Identification Number VIN on page 451 365 Gasoline Octane If your vehicle has the 4 6L V8 engine VIN Code A use premium unleaded gasoline with a posted octane rating of 91 or higher You may also use regular unleaded gasoline rated at 87 octane or higher but your vehicle s acceleration may be slightly reduced and you may notice a slight audible knocking noise commonly referred to as spark knock If the octane is less than 87 you may notice a heavy knocking noise when you drive If this occurs use a gasoline rated at 87 octane or higher as soon as possible Otherwise you might damage your engine If you are using gasoline rated at 87 octane or higher and you hear heavy knocking your engine needs service If your vehicle has the 4 4L V8 engine VIN Code D use premium unleaded gasoline with a posted octane rating of 91 or higher For best performance use premium unleaded gasoline with a posted octane rating of 93 In an emergency 366 you can use regular unleaded gasoline with an octane rating of 87 or higher If 87 octane fuel is used do not perform any a
436. ust position is the lowest sensitivity setting level one This allows more rain or snow to collect on the windshield between wipes Turning the delay adjust band away from you to the higher sensitivity levels allows less rain or snow to collect on the windshield between wipes The top position is the highest sensitivity setting level five A single wipe will occur each time you turn the delay adjust band to a higher sensitivity level to indicate that the sensitivity level has been increased Notice Going through an automatic car wash with the wipers on can damage them Turn the wipers off when going through an automatic car wash The mist and wash cycles operate as normal and are not affected by the Rainsense function The Rainsense system can be overridden at any time by manually changing the wiper control to low or high speed 145 When Rainsense is active the headlamps will turn on automatically If it is dark they will remain on See Wiper Activated Headlamps under Exterior Lamps on page 164 for more information Notice Do not place stickers or other items on the exterior glass surface directly in front of the moisture sensor Doing this could cause the moisture sensor to malfunction Windshield Washer W Washer Fluid The lever on the right side of the steering column also controls the windshield washer There is a button at the end of the lever To spray washer fluid on the windshield press t
437. ut 10 minutes If the warning does not come back on you can drive normally If the warning continues pull over stop and park your vehicle right away If there is still no sign of steam idle the engine for three minutes while you are parked If you still have the warning turn off the engine and get everyone out of the vehicle until it cools down Also see Overheated Engine Protection Operating Mode later in this section You may decide not to lift the hood but to get service help right away 390 Overheated Engine Protection Operating Mode This operating mode allows your vehicle to be driven to a safe place in an emergency situation If an overheated engine condition exists and the DIC message ENGINE HOT STOP ENGINE is displayed an overheat protection mode which alternates firing groups of cylinders helps prevent engine damage In this mode you will notice a significant loss in power and engine performance Driving extended miles km in the overheat protection mode should be avoided Notice After driving in the overheated engine protection operating mode to avoid engine damage allow the engine to cool before attempting any repair The engine oil will be severely degraded Repair the cause of coolant loss change the oil and reset the oil life system See Engine Oil on page 377 Cooling System When you decide it is safe to lift the hood here is A CAUTION what you will see An electric engine cooli
438. utlets on or under the instrument panel open them all the way See Engine Exhaust on page 102 77 Trunk Lock Release A CAUTION Moving parts of the powered trunk lid can be dangerous You or others could be injured Keep yourself and others away from the trunk lid and its mechanism while it is closing The trunk lock release button is located to the left of the steering wheel on the instrument panel Press the button to open the trunk To use this feature your vehicle must be in PARK P or NEUTRAL N and the valet lockout switch must be off You can also press the button with the trunk symbol on the keyless access transmitter to open the trunk To disable this feature see Valet Lockout Switch under Theft Deterrent Systems on page 84 You may passively enter the trunk when you squeeze the trunk release sensor located on the rear of the trunk lid under the emblem as long as you have your transmitter with you The vehicle must be in PARK P and the valet lockout switch must be off See Valet Lockout Switch on page 86 To close the trunk press the button on the underside of the trunk lid To stop the trunk lid while it is closing do one of the following e Press the trunk lock release button located on the instrument panel e Use the vehicle key e Squeeze the trunk release sensor located on the rear of the trunk lid e Press the button with the trunk symbol on the keyless access tran
439. utomatic dimming feature is active each time the vehicle is started To turn the automatic dimming feature on or off press and release the on off button The indicator light will illuminate when this feature is active Cleaning the Mirror When cleaning the mirror use a paper towel or similar material dampened with glass cleaner Do not spray glass cleaner directly on the mirror as that may cause the liquid cleaner to enter the mirror housing Outside Power Heated Mirrors The controls for the outside power mirrors are located is on the drivers door armrest Move the selector switch located below the four way control pad to the left or the right to choose the driver s side or passenger s side mirror Use the arrows located on the four way control pad to adjust the position of the mirror Adjust each outside mirror so that a little of the vehicle and the area behind it can be seen while sitting in a comfortable driving position Keep the selector switch in the center position when not adjusting either outside mirror Both mirrors have a heated feature to rid them of snow ice or condensation They will heat when the rear window defogger is turned on See Rear Window Defogger under Dual Climate Control System on page 178 If the vehicle has the memory option the preferred mirror position can be stored See Memory Seat Mirrors and Steering Wheel on page 10 Both mirrors can be manually folded inward by pulli
440. vehicle If you need more power for passing and you are e Going less than about 35 mph 56 km h push the accelerator pedal about halfway down e Going about 35 mph 56km h or more push the accelerator all the way down Downshifting the transmission in slippery road conditions could result in skidding see Skidding under Loss of Control on page 337 Notice Spinning the tires or holding the vehicle in one place on a hill using only the accelerator pedal may damage the transmission The repair will not be covered by your warranty If you are stuck do not spin the tires When stopping on a hill use the brakes to hold the vehicle in place Maximum engine speed is limited to protect driveline components from improper operation 94 Driver Shift Control DSC The Driver Shift Control DSC feature lets you manually control over the operation of the transmission To use this feature move the shift lever from the DRIVE D position to the left and into the driver shift control gate The Sport Automatic Mode is selected by moving the shift lever into the DSC area without shifting towards the plus or minus symbols While in the Sport Automatic Mode the transmission computer determines when the vehicle is being driven in a competitive manner It then selects and holds the transmission in lower gears giving more noticeable upshifts for a sportier vehicle performance Once you shift to the plus or
441. ves your ability to accelerate when driving on a slippery road Even though your vehicle has the Traction Control System TCS you will want to slow down and adjust your driving to the road conditions Under certain conditions you may want to turn the TCS off such as when driving through deep snow and loose gravel to help maintain vehicle motion at lower speeds See Traction Control System TCS on page 329 The StabiliTrak System may also activate See StabiliTrak System on page 331 The Anti Lock Brake System ABS improves your If You Are Caught in a Blizzard vehicle s stability when you make a hard stop on a slippery road Even though you have ABS If you are stopped by heavy snow you could be in you will want to begin stopping sooner than a serious situation You should probably stay you would on dry pavement See Anti Lock Brake with your vehicle unless you know for sure that you System ABS on page 327 are near help and you can hike through the snow Here are some things to do to summon help and keep yourself and your passengers safe e Turn on your hazard flashers e Allow greater following distance on any slippery road e Watch for slippery spots The road might be fine until you hit a spot that is covered with ice On an otherwise clear road ice patches may appear in shaded areas where the sun cannot reach such as around clumps of trees behind buildings or under bridges Sometimes the surface of a curv
442. ving vehicle it will adjust your vehicle s speed and maintain the follow distance gap you select Use the GAP button on the steering wheel to adjust the follow distance Press the top of the button to increase the distance or the bottom of the button to decrease the distance The first button press will show you the current follow distance setting on the HUD Your current follow distance setting will be maintained until you change it 155 There are six follow distances to choose from The follow distance selection ranges from near to far 1 second to 2 seconds follow time The distance maintained for a selected follow distance will vary based on vehicle speed The faster the vehicle speed the further back you will follow Consider traffic and weather conditions when selecting the follow distance The range of selectable distances may not be appropriate for all drivers and driving conditions If you choose to travel at a distance farther than Adaptive Cruise Control allows disengage the system and drive manually 156 20 b an MPH FOLLOW DISTANCE voy 1Y A graphic on the HUD indicates the selected follow distance This picture shows a maximum follow distance The vehicles will move closer as you select a smaller follow distance Alerting the Driver e A temporary condition prohibits Adaptive Cruise Control from operating See DIC The alert symbol will Warnings and Messages on page 206 for more flash on the H
443. w Exhaust OI ees E E ten detach E EES Oil Life System ccceeeeeeteeeeeeeeeeeees Oil Pressure Gage ceceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees Overheated Protection Operating Mode Engine cont Overheating cccceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaeeeeeeeeeees 388 SUAMMING erne eannan aeaa 89 Supercharger Oil aseeseen 382 Enter Destination ssrisesssriisrssuare iia 259 Entry Exit Lighting seiasneneenni eien 170 Event Data Recorders EDR ccce 491 Extender Safety Belt ccccccccseeeeeeeeeeeees 27 Exterior LAMPS ssssissrirrrrssesarinsisnnrninnnsiranianesi 164 Exterior Lighting Battery Saver 004 169 F Filter Engine Air Cleaner s 382 Finish Damage asssssesssssnrrrrssrrrrinerrresernrens 449 Flashers Hazard Warning a s 140 PlaSh t0 PaSS ssccasutaccctenaetacstaiavest cavedseaiadas 143 lab TG assisia a a a 440 Floor Mats en yaniestisindheacects 122 Fluid Automatic Transmission a e 384 Power Steering e er 396 Windshield Washer cseeeeeeeeeeeeeees 397 Fog Lamp Light ceeecsseeeeeeeneeeeeeeeneeees 201 FOG Lamps iscsi ec ctsiins reste svGdueavistes ecatetnedearh ee 168 PUG rea a E 365 AOGIIVES eierne i 367 California Fuel ccccccccececeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaes 367 Filling a Portable Fuel Container 371 Filling Your TANK cadsccststsrsstedtvsnaiaswecsndes 369 Fuels in Foreign Countries 0 0 00 368 GAG Cease cad ah ahs oepucaccec
444. water and mild soap Care of Safety Belts Keep belts clean and dry A CAUTION Do not bleach or dye safety belts If you do it may severely weaken them In a crash they might not be able to provide adequate protection Clean safety belts only with mild soap and lukewarm water Weatherstrips Silicone grease on weatherstrips will make them last longer seal better and not stick or squeak Apply silicone grease with a clean cloth During very cold damp weather frequent application may be required See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 473 445 Washing Your Vehicle The paint finish on the vehicle provides beauty depth of color gloss retention and durability The best way to preserve the vehicle s finish is to keep it clean by washing it often with lukewarm or cold water Do not wash the vehicle in the direct rays of the sun Use a car washing soap Do not use strong soaps or chemical detergents Be sure to rinse the vehicle well removing all soap residue completely GM approved cleaning products can be obtained from your dealer See Vehicle Care Appearance Materials on page 450 Do not use cleaning agents that are petroleum based or that contain acid or abrasives All cleaning agents should be flushed promptly and not allowed to dry on the surface or they could stain Dry the finish with a soft clean chamois or an all cotton towel to avoid surface scratches and water spotting 446 Notice If
445. when the shifter is moved to REVERSE R This can help you to see the curb while backing up If you adjust the mirror while in REVERSE R the new position will be saved as the park assist position The DIC will display PARK ASSIST OFF or PARK ASSIST ON Language This feature allows you to select the language the DIC and Head Up Display HUD uses to display messages The DIC will display ENGLISH FRENCH GERMAN ITALIAN JAPANESE or SPANISH Press the OPTIONS button to change the setting 224 If you become stuck in a language that you do not understand hold the OPTIONS and RESET buttons for five seconds The DIC will scroll through all available languages for as long as the buttons are held Each language option will display in its own language For example English will be displayed as ENGLISH Spanish as ESPANOL etc When the desired language is available release the buttons and the DIC will set to this language Trip Computer Oil Life Indicator This feature lets you know when to change the engine oil It is based on the engine oil temperatures and your driving patterns To see the display press the information button several times until OIL LIFE appears If you see 99 OIL LIFE 99 percent of your current oil life remains The DIC may display a CHANGE OIL NOW message If you see CHANGE OIL NOW it means the oil life is gone For more information see Scheduled Maintenance on page 465 and Engine Oil on page
446. y 406 To disconnect the jumper cables from both vehicles do the following 1 Disconnect the black negative cable from the vehicle that had the dead battery 2 Disconnect the black negative cable from the vehicle with the good battery 3 Disconnect the red positive cable from the vehicle with the good battery 4 Disconnect the red positive cable from the other vehicle Perform Power Window Initialize steps under Power Windows on page 82 if the vehicle has experienced power loss Rear Axle When to Check Lubricant It is not necessary to regularly check rear axle fluid unless you suspect there is a leak or you hear an unusual noise A fluid loss could indicate a problem Have it inspected and repaired How to Check Lubricant To get an accurate reading the vehicle should be on a level surface If the level is below the bottom of the filler plug hole you will need to add some lubricant Add enough lubricant to raise the level to the bottom of the filler plug hole 407 What to Use To add lubricant when the level is low use SAE 75W 90 Synthetic Gear Lubricant GM Part No 89021677 or equivalent meeting GM Specification 9986115 To completely refill after draining add 4 ounces 118 ml of Limited Slip Differential Lubricant Additive GM Part No 1052358 or equivalent Then fill to the bottom of the filler plug hole with the Synthetic Gear Lubricant 408 Headlamp A
447. y Driveway Receive service reminders and helpful advice on owning and maintaining your vehicle My Preferences Manage your profile subscribe to E News and use tools and forms with greater ease To sign up to My GM Canada visit the My GM Canada section within www gmcanada com Customer Assistance for Text Telephone TTY Users To assist customers who are deaf hard of hearing or speech impaired and who use Text Telephones TTYs Cadillac has TTY equipment available at its Customer Assistance Center Any TTY user can communicate with Cadillac by dialing 1 800 833 CMCC 2622 TTY users in Canada can dial 1 800 263 3830 Customer Assistance Offices Cadillac encourages customers to call the toll free number for assistance However if a customer wishes to write or e mail Cadillac refer to the addresses below United States Customer Assistance Cadillac Customer Assistance Center Cadillac Motor Car Division P O Box 33169 Detroit MI 48232 5169 www Cadillac com 1 800 458 8006 1 800 833 2622 For Text Telephone devices TTYs Roadside Assistance 1 800 882 1112 Fax Number 313 381 0022 From Puerto Rico 1 800 496 9992 English 1 800 496 9993 Spanish Fax Number 313 381 0022 From U S Virgin Islands 1 800 496 9994 Fax Number 313 381 0022 485 Canada Customer Assistance General Motors of Canada Limited Canadian Cadillac Customer Communication Centre CA1 163 005 1908 Colonel Sam
448. y name the List option will become available 3 Touch List to view the list of available name choices or continue to spell the name to further reduce the list of available items The system will supply a list of names when the choice is five or less If you are unsuccessful when inputting a name the name may need to be input differently the map DVD database may not contain this information or the name may be misspelled 4 Select a freeway from the list 5 The ENTRANCE or EXIT options will appear Choose ENTRANCE to select the entrance to the freeway or EXIT to select the exit ramp of the freeway When either button is touched it will give an alphabetical list of freeway entrance and exit ramps on the freeway you entered You may touch DIST SORT to sort the list by distance from your current location or NAME SORT to sort the list by name Select the desired freeway entrance or exit from the list A map will appear with the destination shown Touch Enter to plan your route 267 Intersection This destination entry method allows you to select a destination by inputting the intersecting roads you wish to travel to Go 3 08AM 85 F U To enter an intersection do the following 1 Touch the Intersection symbol 2 Using the alpha keypad enter the name of the first street in the intersection 268 3 To view a list of choices touch List or continue to spell the name to fur
449. ystem TCS a 329 Magnetic Ride Control eec 331 Limited Slip Rear Axle ccce 331 StabiliTrak System ccccccescsecseeeees 331 Steri aisen ipasara anaa eaei 333 Off Road Recovery ssssesssisseeessrrsrrrersee 335 PASSING aera E AE 335 LOSS Of COMTO cc ccsecccctunagssesnionsnnemenieeenenes 337 Racing or Other Competitive Driving XLR occ cnccesaeneteetierescauctusencatyes 338 Driving Your Vehicle Driving at Night ec eeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaeeeees 339 Driving in Rain and on Wet Roads 340 City DIVING ici nccitinnieraii ities 343 Freeway Driving cceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaeeeees 344 Before Leaving on a Long Trip 345 Highway Hypnosis 346 Hill and Mountain Roads 347 Winter Driving nansa an 349 If Your Vehicle is Stuck in Sand Mud lce OF SNOW siorse e ara 353 Rocking Your Vehicle to Get It Out 354 Loading Your Vehicle neseser 354 TOWING E E 359 Towing Your Vehicle ceee 359 Recreational Vehicle Towing 0 359 TOWING a Traila casevssecacceveteares ventmasewsawane says 359 321 Your Driving the Road and Your Vehicle A CAUTION Defensive Driving Defensive driving really means Be ready for anything On city streets rural roads The best advice anyone can give about driving is or expressways it means Always expect Drive defensively the unexpected Assume that pedestrians Please start with a very important safety device
Download Pdf Manuals
Related Search
Related Contents
Tableau de bord High Definition Digital Video Camera User`s Manual Copyright © All rights reserved.
Failed to retrieve file